Contract 0x2437b41252B5ACc774146cEFDE4D055115641675

 
Txn Hash Method
Block
From
To
Value [Txn Fee]
0x2fb13277e0c6c5b4bc6f9f0e6ee67eed484ea1eae861216ee610d202a9927f790x60c0604076823132021-05-24 7:59:20152 days 9 hrs agoACryptoS: Deployer IN  Contract Creation0 BNB0.004384225
[ Download CSV Export 
Parent Txn Hash Block From To Value
Loading

Contract Source Code Verified (Exact Match)

Contract Name:
BalancerHelpers

Compiler Version
v0.7.1+commit.f4a555be

Optimization Enabled:
Yes with 9999 runs

Other Settings:
default evmVersion, None license

Contract Source Code (Solidity Standard Json-Input format)

File 1 of 86 : AssetHelpers.sol
// SPDX-License-Identifier: GPL-3.0-or-later
// This program is free software: you can redistribute it and/or modify
// it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
// the Free Software Foundation, either version 3 of the License, or
// (at your option) any later version.

// This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
// but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
// MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE.  See the
// GNU General Public License for more details.

// You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
// along with this program.  If not, see <http://www.gnu.org/licenses/>.

pragma solidity ^0.7.0;

import "../openzeppelin/IERC20.sol";

import "../../vault/interfaces/IAsset.sol";
import "../../vault/interfaces/IWETH.sol";

abstract contract AssetHelpers {
    // solhint-disable-next-line var-name-mixedcase
    IWETH private immutable _weth;

    // Sentinel value used to indicate WETH with wrapping/unwrapping semantics. The zero address is a good choice for
    // multiple reasons: it is cheap to pass as a calldata argument, it is a known invalid token and non-contract, and
    // it is an address Pools cannot register as a token.
    address private constant _ETH = address(0);

    constructor(IWETH weth) {
        _weth = weth;
    }

    // solhint-disable-next-line func-name-mixedcase
    function _WETH() internal view returns (IWETH) {
        return _weth;
    }

    /**
     * @dev Returns true if `asset` is the sentinel value that represents ETH.
     */
    function _isETH(IAsset asset) internal pure returns (bool) {
        return address(asset) == _ETH;
    }

    /**
     * @dev Translates `asset` into an equivalent IERC20 token address. If `asset` represents ETH, it will be translated
     * to the WETH contract.
     */
    function _translateToIERC20(IAsset asset) internal view returns (IERC20) {
        return _isETH(asset) ? _WETH() : _asIERC20(asset);
    }

    /**
     * @dev Same as `_translateToIERC20(IAsset)`, but for an entire array.
     */
    function _translateToIERC20(IAsset[] memory assets) internal view returns (IERC20[] memory) {
        IERC20[] memory tokens = new IERC20[](assets.length);
        for (uint256 i = 0; i < assets.length; ++i) {
            tokens[i] = _translateToIERC20(assets[i]);
        }
        return tokens;
    }

    /**
     * @dev Interprets `asset` as an IERC20 token. This function should only be called on `asset` if `_isETH` previously
     * returned false for it, that is, if `asset` is guaranteed not to be the ETH sentinel value.
     */
    function _asIERC20(IAsset asset) internal pure returns (IERC20) {
        return IERC20(address(asset));
    }
}

File 2 of 86 : IERC20.sol
// SPDX-License-Identifier: MIT

pragma solidity ^0.7.0;

/**
 * @dev Interface of the ERC20 standard as defined in the EIP.
 */
interface IERC20 {
    /**
     * @dev Returns the amount of tokens in existence.
     */
    function totalSupply() external view returns (uint256);

    /**
     * @dev Returns the amount of tokens owned by `account`.
     */
    function balanceOf(address account) external view returns (uint256);

    /**
     * @dev Moves `amount` tokens from the caller's account to `recipient`.
     *
     * Returns a boolean value indicating whether the operation succeeded.
     *
     * Emits a {Transfer} event.
     */
    function transfer(address recipient, uint256 amount) external returns (bool);

    /**
     * @dev Returns the remaining number of tokens that `spender` will be
     * allowed to spend on behalf of `owner` through {transferFrom}. This is
     * zero by default.
     *
     * This value changes when {approve} or {transferFrom} are called.
     */
    function allowance(address owner, address spender) external view returns (uint256);

    /**
     * @dev Sets `amount` as the allowance of `spender` over the caller's tokens.
     *
     * Returns a boolean value indicating whether the operation succeeded.
     *
     * IMPORTANT: Beware that changing an allowance with this method brings the risk
     * that someone may use both the old and the new allowance by unfortunate
     * transaction ordering. One possible solution to mitigate this race
     * condition is to first reduce the spender's allowance to 0 and set the
     * desired value afterwards:
     * https://github.com/ethereum/EIPs/issues/20#issuecomment-263524729
     *
     * Emits an {Approval} event.
     */
    function approve(address spender, uint256 amount) external returns (bool);

    /**
     * @dev Moves `amount` tokens from `sender` to `recipient` using the
     * allowance mechanism. `amount` is then deducted from the caller's
     * allowance.
     *
     * Returns a boolean value indicating whether the operation succeeded.
     *
     * Emits a {Transfer} event.
     */
    function transferFrom(
        address sender,
        address recipient,
        uint256 amount
    ) external returns (bool);

    /**
     * @dev Emitted when `value` tokens are moved from one account (`from`) to
     * another (`to`).
     *
     * Note that `value` may be zero.
     */
    event Transfer(address indexed from, address indexed to, uint256 value);

    /**
     * @dev Emitted when the allowance of a `spender` for an `owner` is set by
     * a call to {approve}. `value` is the new allowance.
     */
    event Approval(address indexed owner, address indexed spender, uint256 value);
}

File 3 of 86 : IAsset.sol
// SPDX-License-Identifier: GPL-3.0-or-later
// This program is free software: you can redistribute it and/or modify
// it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
// the Free Software Foundation, either version 3 of the License, or
// (at your option) any later version.

// This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
// but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
// MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE.  See the
// GNU General Public License for more details.

// You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
// along with this program.  If not, see <http://www.gnu.org/licenses/>.

pragma solidity ^0.7.0;

/**
 * @dev This is an empty interface used to represent either ERC20-conforming token contracts or ETH (using the zero
 * address sentinel value). We're just relying on the fact that `interface` can be used to declare new address-like
 * types.
 *
 * This concept is unrelated to a Pool's Asset Managers.
 */
interface IAsset {
    // solhint-disable-previous-line no-empty-blocks
}

File 4 of 86 : IWETH.sol
// SPDX-License-Identifier: GPL-3.0-or-later
// This program is free software: you can redistribute it and/or modify
// it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
// the Free Software Foundation, either version 3 of the License, or
// (at your option) any later version.

// This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
// but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
// MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE.  See the
// GNU General Public License for more details.

// You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
// along with this program.  If not, see <http://www.gnu.org/licenses/>.

pragma solidity ^0.7.0;

import "../../lib/openzeppelin/IERC20.sol";

/**
 * @dev Interface for the WETH token contract used internally for wrapping and unwrapping, to support
 * sending and receiving ETH in joins, swaps, and internal balance deposits and withdrawals.
 */
interface IWETH is IERC20 {
    function deposit() external payable;

    function withdraw(uint256 amount) external;
}

File 5 of 86 : AssetTransfersHandler.sol
// SPDX-License-Identifier: GPL-3.0-or-later
// This program is free software: you can redistribute it and/or modify
// it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
// the Free Software Foundation, either version 3 of the License, or
// (at your option) any later version.

// This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
// but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
// MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE.  See the
// GNU General Public License for more details.

// You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
// along with this program.  If not, see <http://www.gnu.org/licenses/>.

pragma solidity ^0.7.0;
pragma experimental ABIEncoderV2;

import "../lib/math/Math.sol";
import "../lib/helpers/BalancerErrors.sol";
import "../lib/openzeppelin/IERC20.sol";
import "../lib/helpers/AssetHelpers.sol";
import "../lib/openzeppelin/SafeERC20.sol";
import "../lib/openzeppelin/Address.sol";

import "./interfaces/IWETH.sol";
import "./interfaces/IAsset.sol";
import "./interfaces/IVault.sol";

abstract contract AssetTransfersHandler is AssetHelpers {
    using SafeERC20 for IERC20;
    using Address for address payable;

    /**
     * @dev Receives `amount` of `asset` from `sender`. If `fromInternalBalance` is true, it first withdraws as much
     * as possible from Internal Balance, then transfers any remaining amount.
     *
     * If `asset` is ETH, `fromInternalBalance` must be false (as ETH cannot be held as internal balance), and the funds
     * will be wrapped into WETH.
     *
     * WARNING: this function does not check that the contract caller has actually supplied any ETH - it is up to the
     * caller of this function to check that this is true to prevent the Vault from using its own ETH (though the Vault
     * typically doesn't hold any).
     */
    function _receiveAsset(
        IAsset asset,
        uint256 amount,
        address sender,
        bool fromInternalBalance
    ) internal {
        if (amount == 0) {
            return;
        }

        if (_isETH(asset)) {
            _require(!fromInternalBalance, Errors.INVALID_ETH_INTERNAL_BALANCE);

            // The ETH amount to receive is deposited into the WETH contract, which will in turn mint WETH for
            // the Vault at a 1:1 ratio.

            // A check for this condition is also introduced by the compiler, but this one provides a revert reason.
            // Note we're checking for the Vault's total balance, *not* ETH sent in this transaction.
            _require(address(this).balance >= amount, Errors.INSUFFICIENT_ETH);
            _WETH().deposit{ value: amount }();
        } else {
            IERC20 token = _asIERC20(asset);

            if (fromInternalBalance) {
                // We take as many tokens from Internal Balance as possible: any remaining amounts will be transferred.
                uint256 deductedBalance = _decreaseInternalBalance(sender, token, amount, true);
                // Because `deductedBalance` will be always the lesser of the current internal balance
                // and the amount to decrease, it is safe to perform unchecked arithmetic.
                amount -= deductedBalance;
            }

            if (amount > 0) {
                token.safeTransferFrom(sender, address(this), amount);
            }
        }
    }

    /**
     * @dev Sends `amount` of `asset` to `recipient`. If `toInternalBalance` is true, the asset is deposited as Internal
     * Balance instead of being transferred.
     *
     * If `asset` is ETH, `toInternalBalance` must be false (as ETH cannot be held as internal balance), and the funds
     * are instead sent directly after unwrapping WETH.
     */
    function _sendAsset(
        IAsset asset,
        uint256 amount,
        address payable recipient,
        bool toInternalBalance
    ) internal {
        if (amount == 0) {
            return;
        }

        if (_isETH(asset)) {
            // Sending ETH is not as involved as receiving it: the only special behavior is it cannot be
            // deposited to Internal Balance.
            _require(!toInternalBalance, Errors.INVALID_ETH_INTERNAL_BALANCE);

            // First, the Vault withdraws deposited ETH from the WETH contract, by burning the same amount of WETH
            // from the Vault. This receipt will be handled by the Vault's `receive`.
            _WETH().withdraw(amount);

            // Then, the withdrawn ETH is sent to the recipient.
            recipient.sendValue(amount);
        } else {
            IERC20 token = _asIERC20(asset);
            if (toInternalBalance) {
                _increaseInternalBalance(recipient, token, amount);
            } else {
                token.safeTransfer(recipient, amount);
            }
        }
    }

    /**
     * @dev Returns excess ETH back to the contract caller, assuming `amountUsed` has been spent. Reverts
     * if the caller sent less ETH than `amountUsed`.
     *
     * Because the caller might not know exactly how much ETH a Vault action will require, they may send extra.
     * Note that this excess value is returned *to the contract caller* (msg.sender). If caller and e.g. swap sender are
     * not the same (because the caller is a relayer for the sender), then it is up to the caller to manage this
     * returned ETH.
     */
    function _handleRemainingEth(uint256 amountUsed) internal {
        _require(msg.value >= amountUsed, Errors.INSUFFICIENT_ETH);

        uint256 excess = msg.value - amountUsed;
        if (excess > 0) {
            msg.sender.sendValue(excess);
        }
    }

    /**
     * @dev Enables the Vault to receive ETH. This is required for it to be able to unwrap WETH, which sends ETH to the
     * caller.
     *
     * Any ETH sent to the Vault outside of the WETH unwrapping mechanism would be forever locked inside the Vault, so
     * we prevent that from happening. Other mechanisms used to send ETH to the Vault (such as being the recipient of an
     * ETH swap, Pool exit or withdrawal, contract self-destruction, or receiving the block mining reward) will result
     * in locked funds, but are not otherwise a security or soundness issue. This check only exists as an attempt to
     * prevent user error.
     */
    receive() external payable {
        _require(msg.sender == address(_WETH()), Errors.ETH_TRANSFER);
    }

    // This contract uses virtual internal functions instead of inheriting from the modules that implement them (in
    // this case UserBalance) in order to decouple it from the rest of the system and enable standalone testing by
    // implementing these with mocks.

    function _increaseInternalBalance(
        address account,
        IERC20 token,
        uint256 amount
    ) internal virtual;

    function _decreaseInternalBalance(
        address account,
        IERC20 token,
        uint256 amount,
        bool capped
    ) internal virtual returns (uint256);
}

File 6 of 86 : Math.sol
// SPDX-License-Identifier: MIT

pragma solidity ^0.7.0;

import "../helpers/BalancerErrors.sol";

/**
 * @dev Wrappers over Solidity's arithmetic operations with added overflow checks.
 * Adapted from OpenZeppelin's SafeMath library
 */
library Math {
    /**
     * @dev Returns the addition of two unsigned integers of 256 bits, reverting on overflow.
     */
    function add(uint256 a, uint256 b) internal pure returns (uint256) {
        uint256 c = a + b;
        _require(c >= a, Errors.ADD_OVERFLOW);
        return c;
    }

    /**
     * @dev Returns the addition of two signed integers, reverting on overflow.
     */
    function add(int256 a, int256 b) internal pure returns (int256) {
        int256 c = a + b;
        _require((b >= 0 && c >= a) || (b < 0 && c < a), Errors.ADD_OVERFLOW);
        return c;
    }

    /**
     * @dev Returns the subtraction of two unsigned integers of 256 bits, reverting on overflow.
     */
    function sub(uint256 a, uint256 b) internal pure returns (uint256) {
        _require(b <= a, Errors.SUB_OVERFLOW);
        uint256 c = a - b;
        return c;
    }

    /**
     * @dev Returns the subtraction of two signed integers, reverting on overflow.
     */
    function sub(int256 a, int256 b) internal pure returns (int256) {
        int256 c = a - b;
        _require((b >= 0 && c <= a) || (b < 0 && c > a), Errors.SUB_OVERFLOW);
        return c;
    }

    /**
     * @dev Returns the largest of two numbers of 256 bits.
     */
    function max(uint256 a, uint256 b) internal pure returns (uint256) {
        return a >= b ? a : b;
    }

    /**
     * @dev Returns the smallest of two numbers of 256 bits.
     */
    function min(uint256 a, uint256 b) internal pure returns (uint256) {
        return a < b ? a : b;
    }

    function mul(uint256 a, uint256 b) internal pure returns (uint256) {
        uint256 c = a * b;
        _require(a == 0 || c / a == b, Errors.MUL_OVERFLOW);
        return c;
    }

    function divDown(uint256 a, uint256 b) internal pure returns (uint256) {
        _require(b != 0, Errors.ZERO_DIVISION);
        return a / b;
    }

    function divUp(uint256 a, uint256 b) internal pure returns (uint256) {
        _require(b != 0, Errors.ZERO_DIVISION);

        if (a == 0) {
            return 0;
        } else {
            return 1 + (a - 1) / b;
        }
    }
}

File 7 of 86 : BalancerErrors.sol
// SPDX-License-Identifier: GPL-3.0-or-later
// This program is free software: you can redistribute it and/or modify
// it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
// the Free Software Foundation, either version 3 of the License, or
// (at your option) any later version.

// This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
// but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
// MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE.  See the
// GNU General Public License for more details.

// You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
// along with this program.  If not, see <http://www.gnu.org/licenses/>.

pragma solidity ^0.7.0;

// solhint-disable

/**
 * @dev Reverts if `condition` is false, with a revert reason containing `errorCode`. Only codes up to 999 are
 * supported.
 */
function _require(bool condition, uint256 errorCode) pure {
    if (!condition) _revert(errorCode);
}

/**
 * @dev Reverts with a revert reason containing `errorCode`. Only codes up to 999 are supported.
 */
function _revert(uint256 errorCode) pure {
    // We're going to dynamically create a revert string based on the error code, with the following format:
    // 'BAL#{errorCode}'
    // where the code is left-padded with zeroes to three digits (so they range from 000 to 999).
    //
    // We don't have revert strings embedded in the contract to save bytecode size: it takes much less space to store a
    // number (8 to 16 bits) than the individual string characters.
    //
    // The dynamic string creation algorithm that follows could be implemented in Solidity, but assembly allows for a
    // much denser implementation, again saving bytecode size. Given this function unconditionally reverts, this is a
    // safe place to rely on it without worrying about how its usage might affect e.g. memory contents.
    assembly {
        // First, we need to compute the ASCII representation of the error code. We assume that it is in the 0-999
        // range, so we only need to convert three digits. To convert the digits to ASCII, we add 0x30, the value for
        // the '0' character.

        let units := add(mod(errorCode, 10), 0x30)

        errorCode := div(errorCode, 10)
        let tenths := add(mod(errorCode, 10), 0x30)

        errorCode := div(errorCode, 10)
        let hundreds := add(mod(errorCode, 10), 0x30)

        // With the individual characters, we can now construct the full string. The "BAL#" part is a known constant
        // (0x42414c23): we simply shift this by 24 (to provide space for the 3 bytes of the error code), and add the
        // characters to it, each shifted by a multiple of 8.
        // The revert reason is then shifted left by 200 bits (256 minus the length of the string, 7 characters * 8 bits
        // per character = 56) to locate it in the most significant part of the 256 slot (the beginning of a byte
        // array).

        let revertReason := shl(200, add(0x42414c23000000, add(add(units, shl(8, tenths)), shl(16, hundreds))))

        // We can now encode the reason in memory, which can be safely overwritten as we're about to revert. The encoded
        // message will have the following layout:
        // [ revert reason identifier ] [ string location offset ] [ string length ] [ string contents ]

        // The Solidity revert reason identifier is 0x08c739a0, the function selector of the Error(string) function. We
        // also write zeroes to the next 28 bytes of memory, but those are about to be overwritten.
        mstore(0x0, 0x08c379a000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000)
        // Next is the offset to the location of the string, which will be placed immediately after (20 bytes away).
        mstore(0x04, 0x0000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000020)
        // The string length is fixed: 7 characters.
        mstore(0x24, 7)
        // Finally, the string itself is stored.
        mstore(0x44, revertReason)

        // Even if the string is only 7 bytes long, we need to return a full 32 byte slot containing it. The length of
        // the encoded message is therefore 4 + 32 + 32 + 32 = 100.
        revert(0, 100)
    }
}

library Errors {
    // Math
    uint256 internal constant ADD_OVERFLOW = 0;
    uint256 internal constant SUB_OVERFLOW = 1;
    uint256 internal constant SUB_UNDERFLOW = 2;
    uint256 internal constant MUL_OVERFLOW = 3;
    uint256 internal constant ZERO_DIVISION = 4;
    uint256 internal constant DIV_INTERNAL = 5;
    uint256 internal constant X_OUT_OF_BOUNDS = 6;
    uint256 internal constant Y_OUT_OF_BOUNDS = 7;
    uint256 internal constant PRODUCT_OUT_OF_BOUNDS = 8;
    uint256 internal constant INVALID_EXPONENT = 9;

    // Input
    uint256 internal constant OUT_OF_BOUNDS = 100;
    uint256 internal constant UNSORTED_ARRAY = 101;
    uint256 internal constant UNSORTED_TOKENS = 102;
    uint256 internal constant INPUT_LENGTH_MISMATCH = 103;
    uint256 internal constant ZERO_TOKEN = 104;

    // Shared pools
    uint256 internal constant MIN_TOKENS = 200;
    uint256 internal constant MAX_TOKENS = 201;
    uint256 internal constant MAX_SWAP_FEE_PERCENTAGE = 202;
    uint256 internal constant MIN_SWAP_FEE_PERCENTAGE = 203;
    uint256 internal constant MINIMUM_BPT = 204;
    uint256 internal constant CALLER_NOT_VAULT = 205;
    uint256 internal constant UNINITIALIZED = 206;
    uint256 internal constant BPT_IN_MAX_AMOUNT = 207;
    uint256 internal constant BPT_OUT_MIN_AMOUNT = 208;
    uint256 internal constant EXPIRED_PERMIT = 209;

    // Pools
    uint256 internal constant MIN_AMP = 300;
    uint256 internal constant MAX_AMP = 301;
    uint256 internal constant MIN_WEIGHT = 302;
    uint256 internal constant MAX_STABLE_TOKENS = 303;
    uint256 internal constant MAX_IN_RATIO = 304;
    uint256 internal constant MAX_OUT_RATIO = 305;
    uint256 internal constant MIN_BPT_IN_FOR_TOKEN_OUT = 306;
    uint256 internal constant MAX_OUT_BPT_FOR_TOKEN_IN = 307;
    uint256 internal constant NORMALIZED_WEIGHT_INVARIANT = 308;
    uint256 internal constant INVALID_TOKEN = 309;
    uint256 internal constant UNHANDLED_JOIN_KIND = 310;
    uint256 internal constant ZERO_INVARIANT = 311;

    // Lib
    uint256 internal constant REENTRANCY = 400;
    uint256 internal constant SENDER_NOT_ALLOWED = 401;
    uint256 internal constant PAUSED = 402;
    uint256 internal constant PAUSE_WINDOW_EXPIRED = 403;
    uint256 internal constant MAX_PAUSE_WINDOW_DURATION = 404;
    uint256 internal constant MAX_BUFFER_PERIOD_DURATION = 405;
    uint256 internal constant INSUFFICIENT_BALANCE = 406;
    uint256 internal constant INSUFFICIENT_ALLOWANCE = 407;
    uint256 internal constant ERC20_TRANSFER_FROM_ZERO_ADDRESS = 408;
    uint256 internal constant ERC20_TRANSFER_TO_ZERO_ADDRESS = 409;
    uint256 internal constant ERC20_MINT_TO_ZERO_ADDRESS = 410;
    uint256 internal constant ERC20_BURN_FROM_ZERO_ADDRESS = 411;
    uint256 internal constant ERC20_APPROVE_FROM_ZERO_ADDRESS = 412;
    uint256 internal constant ERC20_APPROVE_TO_ZERO_ADDRESS = 413;
    uint256 internal constant ERC20_TRANSFER_EXCEEDS_ALLOWANCE = 414;
    uint256 internal constant ERC20_DECREASED_ALLOWANCE_BELOW_ZERO = 415;
    uint256 internal constant ERC20_TRANSFER_EXCEEDS_BALANCE = 416;
    uint256 internal constant ERC20_BURN_EXCEEDS_ALLOWANCE = 417;
    uint256 internal constant SAFE_ERC20_CALL_FAILED = 418;
    uint256 internal constant ADDRESS_INSUFFICIENT_BALANCE = 419;
    uint256 internal constant ADDRESS_CANNOT_SEND_VALUE = 420;
    uint256 internal constant SAFE_CAST_VALUE_CANT_FIT_INT256 = 421;
    uint256 internal constant GRANT_SENDER_NOT_ADMIN = 422;
    uint256 internal constant REVOKE_SENDER_NOT_ADMIN = 423;
    uint256 internal constant RENOUNCE_SENDER_NOT_ALLOWED = 424;
    uint256 internal constant BUFFER_PERIOD_EXPIRED = 425;

    // Vault
    uint256 internal constant INVALID_POOL_ID = 500;
    uint256 internal constant CALLER_NOT_POOL = 501;
    uint256 internal constant SENDER_NOT_ASSET_MANAGER = 502;
    uint256 internal constant USER_DOESNT_ALLOW_RELAYER = 503;
    uint256 internal constant INVALID_SIGNATURE = 504;
    uint256 internal constant EXIT_BELOW_MIN = 505;
    uint256 internal constant JOIN_ABOVE_MAX = 506;
    uint256 internal constant SWAP_LIMIT = 507;
    uint256 internal constant SWAP_DEADLINE = 508;
    uint256 internal constant CANNOT_SWAP_SAME_TOKEN = 509;
    uint256 internal constant UNKNOWN_AMOUNT_IN_FIRST_SWAP = 510;
    uint256 internal constant MALCONSTRUCTED_MULTIHOP_SWAP = 511;
    uint256 internal constant INTERNAL_BALANCE_OVERFLOW = 512;
    uint256 internal constant INSUFFICIENT_INTERNAL_BALANCE = 513;
    uint256 internal constant INVALID_ETH_INTERNAL_BALANCE = 514;
    uint256 internal constant INVALID_POST_LOAN_BALANCE = 515;
    uint256 internal constant INSUFFICIENT_ETH = 516;
    uint256 internal constant UNALLOCATED_ETH = 517;
    uint256 internal constant ETH_TRANSFER = 518;
    uint256 internal constant CANNOT_USE_ETH_SENTINEL = 519;
    uint256 internal constant TOKENS_MISMATCH = 520;
    uint256 internal constant TOKEN_NOT_REGISTERED = 521;
    uint256 internal constant TOKEN_ALREADY_REGISTERED = 522;
    uint256 internal constant TOKENS_ALREADY_SET = 523;
    uint256 internal constant TOKENS_LENGTH_MUST_BE_2 = 524;
    uint256 internal constant NONZERO_TOKEN_BALANCE = 525;
    uint256 internal constant BALANCE_TOTAL_OVERFLOW = 526;
    uint256 internal constant POOL_NO_TOKENS = 527;
    uint256 internal constant INSUFFICIENT_FLASH_LOAN_BALANCE = 528;

    // Fees
    uint256 internal constant SWAP_FEE_PERCENTAGE_TOO_HIGH = 600;
    uint256 internal constant FLASH_LOAN_FEE_PERCENTAGE_TOO_HIGH = 601;
    uint256 internal constant INSUFFICIENT_FLASH_LOAN_FEE_AMOUNT = 602;
}

File 8 of 86 : SafeERC20.sol
// SPDX-License-Identifier: MIT

pragma solidity ^0.7.0;

import "../helpers/BalancerErrors.sol";

import "./IERC20.sol";

/**
 * @title SafeERC20
 * @dev Wrappers around ERC20 operations that throw on failure (when the token
 * contract returns false). Tokens that return no value (and instead revert or
 * throw on failure) are also supported, non-reverting calls are assumed to be
 * successful.
 * To use this library you can add a `using SafeERC20 for IERC20;` statement to your contract,
 * which allows you to call the safe operations as `token.safeTransfer(...)`, etc.
 */
library SafeERC20 {
    function safeTransfer(
        IERC20 token,
        address to,
        uint256 value
    ) internal {
        _callOptionalReturn(address(token), abi.encodeWithSelector(token.transfer.selector, to, value));
    }

    function safeTransferFrom(
        IERC20 token,
        address from,
        address to,
        uint256 value
    ) internal {
        _callOptionalReturn(address(token), abi.encodeWithSelector(token.transferFrom.selector, from, to, value));
    }

    /**
     * @dev Imitates a Solidity high-level call (i.e. a regular function call to a contract), relaxing the requirement
     * on the return value: the return value is optional (but if data is returned, it must not be false).
     *
     * WARNING: `token` is assumed to be a contract: calls to EOAs will *not* revert.
     */
    function _callOptionalReturn(address token, bytes memory data) private {
        // We need to perform a low level call here, to bypass Solidity's return data size checking mechanism, since
        // we're implementing it ourselves.
        (bool success, bytes memory returndata) = token.call(data);

        // If the low-level call didn't succeed we return whatever was returned from it.
        assembly {
            if eq(success, 0) {
                returndatacopy(0, 0, returndatasize())
                revert(0, returndatasize())
            }
        }

        // Finally we check the returndata size is either zero or true - note that this check will always pass for EOAs
        _require(returndata.length == 0 || abi.decode(returndata, (bool)), Errors.SAFE_ERC20_CALL_FAILED);
    }
}

File 9 of 86 : Address.sol
// SPDX-License-Identifier: MIT

pragma solidity ^0.7.0;

import "../helpers/BalancerErrors.sol";

/**
 * @dev Collection of functions related to the address type
 */
library Address {
    /**
     * @dev Returns true if `account` is a contract.
     *
     * [IMPORTANT]
     * ====
     * It is unsafe to assume that an address for which this function returns
     * false is an externally-owned account (EOA) and not a contract.
     *
     * Among others, `isContract` will return false for the following
     * types of addresses:
     *
     *  - an externally-owned account
     *  - a contract in construction
     *  - an address where a contract will be created
     *  - an address where a contract lived, but was destroyed
     * ====
     */
    function isContract(address account) internal view returns (bool) {
        // This method relies on extcodesize, which returns 0 for contracts in
        // construction, since the code is only stored at the end of the
        // constructor execution.

        uint256 size;
        // solhint-disable-next-line no-inline-assembly
        assembly {
            size := extcodesize(account)
        }
        return size > 0;
    }

    /**
     * @dev Replacement for Solidity's `transfer`: sends `amount` wei to
     * `recipient`, forwarding all available gas and reverting on errors.
     *
     * https://eips.ethereum.org/EIPS/eip-1884[EIP1884] increases the gas cost
     * of certain opcodes, possibly making contracts go over the 2300 gas limit
     * imposed by `transfer`, making them unable to receive funds via
     * `transfer`. {sendValue} removes this limitation.
     *
     * https://diligence.consensys.net/posts/2019/09/stop-using-soliditys-transfer-now/[Learn more].
     *
     * IMPORTANT: because control is transferred to `recipient`, care must be
     * taken to not create reentrancy vulnerabilities. Consider using
     * {ReentrancyGuard} or the
     * https://solidity.readthedocs.io/en/v0.5.11/security-considerations.html#use-the-checks-effects-interactions-pattern[checks-effects-interactions pattern].
     */
    function sendValue(address payable recipient, uint256 amount) internal {
        _require(address(this).balance >= amount, Errors.ADDRESS_INSUFFICIENT_BALANCE);

        // solhint-disable-next-line avoid-low-level-calls, avoid-call-value
        (bool success, ) = recipient.call{ value: amount }("");
        _require(success, Errors.ADDRESS_CANNOT_SEND_VALUE);
    }
}

File 10 of 86 : IVault.sol
// SPDX-License-Identifier: GPL-3.0-or-later
// This program is free software: you can redistribute it and/or modify
// it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
// the Free Software Foundation, either version 3 of the License, or
// (at your option) any later version.

// This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
// but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
// MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE.  See the
// GNU General Public License for more details.

// You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
// along with this program.  If not, see <http://www.gnu.org/licenses/>.

pragma experimental ABIEncoderV2;

import "../../lib/openzeppelin/IERC20.sol";

import "./IWETH.sol";
import "./IAsset.sol";
import "./IAuthorizer.sol";
import "./IFlashLoanRecipient.sol";
import "../ProtocolFeesCollector.sol";

import "../../lib/helpers/ISignaturesValidator.sol";
import "../../lib/helpers/ITemporarilyPausable.sol";

pragma solidity ^0.7.0;

/**
 * @dev Full external interface for the Vault core contract - no external or public methods exist in the contract that
 * don't override one of these declarations.
 */
interface IVault is ISignaturesValidator, ITemporarilyPausable {
    // Generalities about the Vault:
    //
    // - Whenever documentation refers to 'tokens', it strictly refers to ERC20-compliant token contracts. Tokens are
    // transferred out of the Vault by calling the `IERC20.transfer` function, and transferred in by calling
    // `IERC20.transferFrom`. In these cases, the sender must have previously allowed the Vault to use their tokens by
    // calling `IERC20.approve`. The only deviation from the ERC20 standard that is supported is functions not returning
    // a boolean value: in these scenarios, a non-reverting call is assumed to be successful.
    //
    // - All non-view functions in the Vault are non-reentrant: calling them while another one is mid-execution (e.g.
    // while execution control is transferred to a token contract during a swap) will result in a revert. View
    // functions can be called in a re-reentrant way, but doing so might cause them to return inconsistent results.
    // Contracts calling view functions in the Vault must make sure the Vault has not already been entered.
    //
    // - View functions revert if referring to either unregistered Pools, or unregistered tokens for registered Pools.

    // Authorizer
    //
    // Some system actions are permissioned, like setting and collecting protocol fees. This permissioning system exists
    // outside of the Vault in the Authorizer contract: the Vault simply calls the Authorizer to check if the caller
    // can perform a given action.

    /**
     * @dev Returns the Vault's Authorizer.
     */
    function getAuthorizer() external view returns (IAuthorizer);

    /**
     * @dev Sets a new Authorizer for the Vault. The caller must be allowed by the current Authorizer to do this.
     *
     * Emits an `AuthorizerChanged` event.
     */
    function setAuthorizer(IAuthorizer newAuthorizer) external;

    /**
     * @dev Emitted when a new authorizer is set by `setAuthorizer`.
     */
    event AuthorizerChanged(IAuthorizer indexed newAuthorizer);

    // Relayers
    //
    // Additionally, it is possible for an account to perform certain actions on behalf of another one, using their
    // Vault ERC20 allowance and Internal Balance. These accounts are said to be 'relayers' for these Vault functions,
    // and are expected to be smart contracts with sound authentication mechanisms. For an account to be able to wield
    // this power, two things must occur:
    //  - The Authorizer must grant the account the permission to be a relayer for the relevant Vault function. This
    //    means that Balancer governance must approve each individual contract to act as a relayer for the intended
    //    functions.
    //  - Each user must approve the relayer to act on their behalf.
    // This double protection means users cannot be tricked into approving malicious relayers (because they will not
    // have been allowed by the Authorizer via governance), nor can malicious relayers approved by a compromised
    // Authorizer or governance drain user funds, since they would also need to be approved by each individual user.

    /**
     * @dev Returns true if `user` has approved `relayer` to act as a relayer for them.
     */
    function hasApprovedRelayer(address user, address relayer) external view returns (bool);

    /**
     * @dev Allows `relayer` to act as a relayer for `sender` if `approved` is true, and disallows it otherwise.
     *
     * Emits a `RelayerApprovalChanged` event.
     */
    function setRelayerApproval(
        address sender,
        address relayer,
        bool approved
    ) external;

    /**
     * @dev Emitted every time a relayer is approved or disapproved by `setRelayerApproval`.
     */
    event RelayerApprovalChanged(address indexed relayer, address indexed sender, bool approved);

    // Internal Balance
    //
    // Users can deposit tokens into the Vault, where they are allocated to their Internal Balance, and later
    // transferred or withdrawn. It can also be used as a source of tokens when joining Pools, as a destination
    // when exiting them, and as either when performing swaps. This usage of Internal Balance results in greatly reduced
    // gas costs when compared to relying on plain ERC20 transfers, leading to large savings for frequent users.
    //
    // Internal Balance management features batching, which means a single contract call can be used to perform multiple
    // operations of different kinds, with different senders and recipients, at once.

    /**
     * @dev Returns `user`'s Internal Balance for a set of tokens.
     */
    function getInternalBalance(address user, IERC20[] memory tokens) external view returns (uint256[] memory);

    /**
     * @dev Performs a set of user balance operations, which involve Internal Balance (deposit, withdraw or transfer)
     * and plain ERC20 transfers using the Vault's allowance. This last feature is particularly useful for relayers, as
     * it lets integrators reuse a user's Vault allowance.
     *
     * For each operation, if the caller is not `sender`, it must be an authorized relayer for them.
     */
    function manageUserBalance(UserBalanceOp[] memory ops) external payable;

    /**
     * @dev Data for `manageUserBalance` operations, which include the possibility for ETH to be sent and received
     without manual WETH wrapping or unwrapping.
     */
    struct UserBalanceOp {
        UserBalanceOpKind kind;
        IAsset asset;
        uint256 amount;
        address sender;
        address payable recipient;
    }

    // There are four possible operations in `manageUserBalance`:
    //
    // - DEPOSIT_INTERNAL
    // Increases the Internal Balance of the `recipient` account by transferring tokens from the corresponding
    // `sender`. The sender must have allowed the Vault to use their tokens via `IERC20.approve()`.
    //
    // ETH can be used by passing the ETH sentinel value as the asset and forwarding ETH in the call: it will be wrapped
    // and deposited as WETH. Any ETH amount remaining will be sent back to the caller (not the sender, which is
    // relevant for relayers).
    //
    // Emits an `InternalBalanceChanged` event.
    //
    //
    // - WITHDRAW_INTERNAL
    // Decreases the Internal Balance of the `sender` account by transferring tokens to the `recipient`.
    //
    // ETH can be used by passing the ETH sentinel value as the asset. This will deduct WETH instead, unwrap it and send
    // it to the recipient as ETH.
    //
    // Emits an `InternalBalanceChanged` event.
    //
    //
    // - TRANSFER_INTERNAL
    // Transfers tokens from the Internal Balance of the `sender` account to the Internal Balance of `recipient`.
    //
    // Reverts if the ETH sentinel value is passed.
    //
    // Emits an `InternalBalanceChanged` event.
    //
    //
    // - TRANSFER_EXTERNAL
    // Transfers tokens from `sender` to `recipient`, using the Vault's ERC20 allowance. This is typically used by
    // relayers, as it lets them reuse a user's Vault allowance.
    //
    // Reverts if the ETH sentinel value is passed.
    //
    // Emits an `ExternalBalanceTransfer` event.

    enum UserBalanceOpKind { DEPOSIT_INTERNAL, WITHDRAW_INTERNAL, TRANSFER_INTERNAL, TRANSFER_EXTERNAL }

    /**
     * @dev Emitted when a user's Internal Balance changes, either from calls to `manageUserBalance`, or through
     * interacting with Pools using Internal Balance.
     *
     * Because Internal Balance works exclusively with ERC20 tokens, ETH deposits and withdrawals will use the WETH
     * address.
     */
    event InternalBalanceChanged(address indexed user, IERC20 indexed token, int256 delta);

    /**
     * @dev Emitted when a user's Vault ERC20 allowance is used by the Vault to transfer tokens to an external account.
     */
    event ExternalBalanceTransfer(IERC20 indexed token, address indexed sender, address recipient, uint256 amount);

    // Pools
    //
    // There are three specialization settings for Pools, which allow for cheaper swaps at the cost of reduced
    // functionality:
    //
    //  - General: no specialization, suited for all Pools. IGeneralPool is used for swap request callbacks, passing the
    // balance of all tokens in the Pool. These Pools have the largest swap costs (because of the extra storage reads),
    // which increase with the number of registered tokens.
    //
    //  - Minimal Swap Info: IMinimalSwapInfoPool is used instead of IGeneralPool, which saves gas by only passing the
    // balance of the two tokens involved in the swap. This is suitable for some pricing algorithms, like the weighted
    // constant product one popularized by Balancer V1. Swap costs are smaller compared to general Pools, and are
    // independent of the number of registered tokens.
    //
    //  - Two Token: only allows two tokens to be registered. This achieves the lowest possible swap gas cost. Like
    // minimal swap info Pools, these are called via IMinimalSwapInfoPool.

    enum PoolSpecialization { GENERAL, MINIMAL_SWAP_INFO, TWO_TOKEN }

    /**
     * @dev Registers the caller account as a Pool with a given specialization setting. Returns the Pool's ID, which
     * is used in all Pool-related functions. Pools cannot be deregistered, nor can the Pool's specialization be
     * changed.
     *
     * The caller is expected to be a smart contract that implements either `IGeneralPool` or `IMinimalSwapInfoPool`,
     * depending on the chosen specialization setting. This contract is known as the Pool's contract.
     *
     * Note that the same contract may register itself as multiple Pools with unique Pool IDs, or in other words,
     * multiple Pools may share the same contract.
     *
     * Emits a `PoolRegistered` event.
     */
    function registerPool(PoolSpecialization specialization) external returns (bytes32);

    /**
     * @dev Emitted when a Pool is registered by calling `registerPool`.
     */
    event PoolRegistered(bytes32 indexed poolId, address indexed poolAddress, PoolSpecialization specialization);

    /**
     * @dev Returns a Pool's contract address and specialization setting.
     */
    function getPool(bytes32 poolId) external view returns (address, PoolSpecialization);

    /**
     * @dev Registers `tokens` for the `poolId` Pool. Must be called by the Pool's contract.
     *
     * Pools can only interact with tokens they have registered. Users join a Pool by transferring registered tokens,
     * exit by receiving registered tokens, and can only swap registered tokens.
     *
     * Each token can only be registered once. For Pools with the Two Token specialization, `tokens` must have a length
     * of two, that is, both tokens must be registered in the same `registerTokens` call, and they must be sorted in
     * ascending order.
     *
     * The `tokens` and `assetManagers` arrays must have the same length, and each entry in these indicates the Asset
     * Manager for the corresponding token. Asset Managers can manage a Pool's tokens via `managePoolBalance`,
     * depositing and withdrawing them directly, and can even set their balance to arbitrary amounts. They are therefore
     * expected to be highly secured smart contracts with sound design principles, and the decision to register an
     * Asset Manager should not be made lightly.
     *
     * Pools can choose not to assign an Asset Manager to a given token by passing in the zero address. Once an Asset
     * Manager is set, it cannot be changed except by deregistering the associated token and registering again with a
     * different Asset Manager.
     *
     * Emits a `TokensRegistered` event.
     */
    function registerTokens(
        bytes32 poolId,
        IERC20[] memory tokens,
        address[] memory assetManagers
    ) external;

    /**
     * @dev Emitted when a Pool registers tokens by calling `registerTokens`.
     */
    event TokensRegistered(bytes32 indexed poolId, IERC20[] tokens, address[] assetManagers);

    /**
     * @dev Deregisters `tokens` for the `poolId` Pool. Must be called by the Pool's contract.
     *
     * Only registered tokens (via `registerTokens`) can be deregistered. Additionally, they must have zero total
     * balance. For Pools with the Two Token specialization, `tokens` must have a length of two, that is, both tokens
     * must be deregistered in the same `deregisterTokens` call.
     *
     * A deregistered token can be re-registered later on, possibly with a different Asset Manager.
     *
     * Emits a `TokensDeregistered` event.
     */
    function deregisterTokens(bytes32 poolId, IERC20[] memory tokens) external;

    /**
     * @dev Emitted when a Pool deregisters tokens by calling `deregisterTokens`.
     */
    event TokensDeregistered(bytes32 indexed poolId, IERC20[] tokens);

    /**
     * @dev Returns detailed information for a Pool's registered token.
     *
     * `cash` is the number of tokens the Vault currently holds for the Pool. `managed` is the number of tokens
     * withdrawn and held outside the Vault by the Pool's token Asset Manager. The Pool's total balance for `token`
     * equals the sum of `cash` and `managed`.
     *
     * Internally, `cash` and `managed` are stored using 112 bits. No action can ever cause a Pool's token `cash`,
     * `managed` or `total` balance to be greater than 2^112 - 1.
     *
     * `lastChangeBlock` is the number of the block in which `token`'s total balance was last modified (via either a
     * join, exit, swap, or Asset Manager update). This value is useful to avoid so-called 'sandwich attacks', for
     * example when developing price oracles. A change of zero (e.g. caused by a swap with amount zero) is considered a
     * change for this purpose, and will update `lastChangeBlock`.
     *
     * `assetManager` is the Pool's token Asset Manager.
     */
    function getPoolTokenInfo(bytes32 poolId, IERC20 token)
        external
        view
        returns (
            uint256 cash,
            uint256 managed,
            uint256 lastChangeBlock,
            address assetManager
        );

    /**
     * @dev Returns a Pool's registered tokens, the total balance for each, and the latest block when *any* of
     * the tokens' `balances` changed.
     *
     * The order of the `tokens` array is the same order that will be used in `joinPool`, `exitPool`, as well as in all
     * Pool hooks (where applicable). Calls to `registerTokens` and `deregisterTokens` may change this order.
     *
     * If a Pool only registers tokens once, and these are sorted in ascending order, they will be stored in the same
     * order as passed to `registerTokens`.
     *
     * Total balances include both tokens held by the Vault and those withdrawn by the Pool's Asset Managers. These are
     * the amounts used by joins, exits and swaps. For a detailed breakdown of token balances, use `getPoolTokenInfo`
     * instead.
     */
    function getPoolTokens(bytes32 poolId)
        external
        view
        returns (
            IERC20[] memory tokens,
            uint256[] memory balances,
            uint256 lastChangeBlock
        );

    /**
     * @dev Called by users to join a Pool, which transfers tokens from `sender` into the Pool's balance. This will
     * trigger custom Pool behavior, which will typically grant something in return to `recipient` - often tokenized
     * Pool shares.
     *
     * If the caller is not `sender`, it must be an authorized relayer for them.
     *
     * The `assets` and `maxAmountsIn` arrays must have the same length, and each entry indicates the maximum amount
     * to send for each asset. The amounts to send are decided by the Pool and not the Vault: it just enforces
     * these maximums.
     *
     * If joining a Pool that holds WETH, it is possible to send ETH directly: the Vault will do the wrapping. To enable
     * this mechanism, the IAsset sentinel value (the zero address) must be passed in the `assets` array instead of the
     * WETH address. Note that it is not possible to combine ETH and WETH in the same join. Any excess ETH will be sent
     * back to the caller (not the sender, which is important for relayers).
     *
     * `assets` must have the same length and order as the array returned by `getPoolTokens`. This prevents issues when
     * interacting with Pools that register and deregister tokens frequently. If sending ETH however, the array must be
     * sorted *before* replacing the WETH address with the ETH sentinel value (the zero address), which means the final
     * `assets` array might not be sorted. Pools with no registered tokens cannot be joined.
     *
     * If `fromInternalBalance` is true, the caller's Internal Balance will be preferred: ERC20 transfers will only
     * be made for the difference between the requested amount and Internal Balance (if any). Note that ETH cannot be
     * withdrawn from Internal Balance: attempting to do so will trigger a revert.
     *
     * This causes the Vault to call the `IBasePool.onJoinPool` hook on the Pool's contract, where Pools implement
     * their own custom logic. This typically requires additional information from the user (such as the expected number
     * of Pool shares). This can be encoded in the `userData` argument, which is ignored by the Vault and passed
     * directly to the Pool's contract, as is `recipient`.
     *
     * Emits a `PoolBalanceChanged` event.
     */
    function joinPool(
        bytes32 poolId,
        address sender,
        address recipient,
        JoinPoolRequest memory request
    ) external payable;

    struct JoinPoolRequest {
        IAsset[] assets;
        uint256[] maxAmountsIn;
        bytes userData;
        bool fromInternalBalance;
    }

    /**
     * @dev Called by users to exit a Pool, which transfers tokens from the Pool's balance to `recipient`. This will
     * trigger custom Pool behavior, which will typically ask for something in return from `sender` - often tokenized
     * Pool shares. The amount of tokens that can be withdrawn is limited by the Pool's `cash` balance (see
     * `getPoolTokenInfo`).
     *
     * If the caller is not `sender`, it must be an authorized relayer for them.
     *
     * The `tokens` and `minAmountsOut` arrays must have the same length, and each entry in these indicates the minimum
     * token amount to receive for each token contract. The amounts to send are decided by the Pool and not the Vault:
     * it just enforces these minimums.
     *
     * If exiting a Pool that holds WETH, it is possible to receive ETH directly: the Vault will do the unwrapping. To
     * enable this mechanism, the IAsset sentinel value (the zero address) must be passed in the `assets` array instead
     * of the WETH address. Note that it is not possible to combine ETH and WETH in the same exit.
     *
     * `assets` must have the same length and order as the array returned by `getPoolTokens`. This prevents issues when
     * interacting with Pools that register and deregister tokens frequently. If receiving ETH however, the array must
     * be sorted *before* replacing the WETH address with the ETH sentinel value (the zero address), which means the
     * final `assets` array might not be sorted. Pools with no registered tokens cannot be exited.
     *
     * If `toInternalBalance` is true, the tokens will be deposited to `recipient`'s Internal Balance. Otherwise,
     * an ERC20 transfer will be performed. Note that ETH cannot be deposited to Internal Balance: attempting to
     * do so will trigger a revert.
     *
     * `minAmountsOut` is the minimum amount of tokens the user expects to get out of the Pool, for each token in the
     * `tokens` array. This array must match the Pool's registered tokens.
     *
     * This causes the Vault to call the `IBasePool.onExitPool` hook on the Pool's contract, where Pools implement
     * their own custom logic. This typically requires additional information from the user (such as the expected number
     * of Pool shares to return). This can be encoded in the `userData` argument, which is ignored by the Vault and
     * passed directly to the Pool's contract.
     *
     * Emits a `PoolBalanceChanged` event.
     */
    function exitPool(
        bytes32 poolId,
        address sender,
        address payable recipient,
        ExitPoolRequest memory request
    ) external;

    struct ExitPoolRequest {
        IAsset[] assets;
        uint256[] minAmountsOut;
        bytes userData;
        bool toInternalBalance;
    }

    /**
     * @dev Emitted when a user joins or exits a Pool by calling `joinPool` or `exitPool`, respectively.
     */
    event PoolBalanceChanged(
        bytes32 indexed poolId,
        address indexed liquidityProvider,
        IERC20[] tokens,
        int256[] deltas,
        uint256[] protocolFeeAmounts
    );

    enum PoolBalanceChangeKind { JOIN, EXIT }

    // Swaps
    //
    // Users can swap tokens with Pools by calling the `swap` and `batchSwap` functions. To do this,
    // they need not trust Pool contracts in any way: all security checks are made by the Vault. They must however be
    // aware of the Pools' pricing algorithms in order to estimate the prices Pools will quote.
    //
    // The `swap` function executes a single swap, while `batchSwap` can perform multiple swaps in sequence.
    // In each individual swap, tokens of one kind are sent from the sender to the Pool (this is the 'token in'),
    // and tokens of another kind are sent from the Pool to the recipient in exchange (this is the 'token out').
    // More complex swaps, such as one token in to multiple tokens out can be achieved by batching together
    // individual swaps.
    //
    // There are two swap kinds:
    //  - 'given in' swaps, where the amount of tokens in (sent to the Pool) is known, and the Pool determines (via the
    // `onSwap` hook) the amount of tokens out (to send to the recipient).
    //  - 'given out' swaps, where the amount of tokens out (received from the Pool) is known, and the Pool determines
    // (via the `onSwap` hook) the amount of tokens in (to receive from the sender).
    //
    // Additionally, it is possible to chain swaps using a placeholder input amount, which the Vault replaces with
    // the calculated output of the previous swap. If the previous swap was 'given in', this will be the calculated
    // tokenOut amount. If the previous swap was 'given out', it will use the calculated tokenIn amount. These extended
    // swaps are known as 'multihop' swaps, since they 'hop' through a number of intermediate tokens before arriving at
    // the final intended token.
    //
    // In all cases, tokens are only transferred in and out of the Vault (or withdrawn from and deposited into Internal
    // Balance) after all individual swaps have been completed, and the net token balance change computed. This makes
    // certain swap patterns, such as multihops, or swaps that interact with the same token pair in multiple Pools, cost
    // much less gas than they would otherwise.
    //
    // It also means that under certain conditions it is possible to perform arbitrage by swapping with multiple
    // Pools in a way that results in net token movement out of the Vault (profit), with no tokens being sent in (only
    // updating the Pool's internal accounting).
    //
    // To protect users from front-running or the market changing rapidly, they supply a list of 'limits' for each token
    // involved in the swap, where either the maximum number of tokens to send (by passing a positive value) or the
    // minimum amount of tokens to receive (by passing a negative value) is specified.
    //
    // Additionally, a 'deadline' timestamp can also be provided, forcing the swap to fail if it occurs after
    // this point in time (e.g. if the transaction failed to be included in a block promptly).
    //
    // If interacting with Pools that hold WETH, it is possible to both send and receive ETH directly: the Vault will do
    // the wrapping and unwrapping. To enable this mechanism, the IAsset sentinel value (the zero address) must be
    // passed in the `assets` array instead of the WETH address. Note that it is possible to combine ETH and WETH in the
    // same swap. Any excess ETH will be sent back to the caller (not the sender, which is relevant for relayers).
    //
    // Finally, Internal Balance can be used when either sending or receiving tokens.

    enum SwapKind { GIVEN_IN, GIVEN_OUT }

    /**
     * @dev Performs a swap with a single Pool.
     *
     * If the swap is 'given in' (the number of tokens to send to the Pool is known), it returns the amount of tokens
     * taken from the Pool, which must be greater than or equal to `limit`.
     *
     * If the swap is 'given out' (the number of tokens to take from the Pool is known), it returns the amount of tokens
     * sent to the Pool, which must be less than or equal to `limit`.
     *
     * Internal Balance usage and the recipient are determined by the `funds` struct.
     *
     * Emits a `Swap` event.
     */
    function swap(
        SingleSwap memory singleSwap,
        FundManagement memory funds,
        uint256 limit,
        uint256 deadline
    ) external payable returns (uint256);

    /**
     * @dev Data for a single swap executed by `swap`. `amount` is either `amountIn` or `amountOut` depending on
     * the `kind` value.
     *
     * `assetIn` and `assetOut` are either token addresses, or the IAsset sentinel value for ETH (the zero address).
     * Note that Pools never interact with ETH directly: it will be wrapped to or unwrapped from WETH by the Vault.
     *
     * The `userData` field is ignored by the Vault, but forwarded to the Pool in the `onSwap` hook, and may be
     * used to extend swap behavior.
     */
    struct SingleSwap {
        bytes32 poolId;
        SwapKind kind;
        IAsset assetIn;
        IAsset assetOut;
        uint256 amount;
        bytes userData;
    }

    /**
     * @dev Performs a series of swaps with one or multiple Pools. In each individual swap, the caller determines either
     * the amount of tokens sent to or received from the Pool, depending on the `kind` value.
     *
     * Returns an array with the net Vault asset balance deltas. Positive amounts represent tokens (or ETH) sent to the
     * Vault, and negative amounts represent tokens (or ETH) sent by the Vault. Each delta corresponds to the asset at
     * the same index in the `assets` array.
     *
     * Swaps are executed sequentially, in the order specified by the `swaps` array. Each array element describes a
     * Pool, the token to be sent to this Pool, the token to receive from it, and an amount that is either `amountIn` or
     * `amountOut` depending on the swap kind.
     *
     * Multihop swaps can be executed by passing an `amount` value of zero for a swap. This will cause the amount in/out
     * of the previous swap to be used as the amount in for the current one. In a 'given in' swap, 'tokenIn' must equal
     * the previous swap's `tokenOut`. For a 'given out' swap, `tokenOut` must equal the previous swap's `tokenIn`.
     *
     * The `assets` array contains the addresses of all assets involved in the swaps. These are either token addresses,
     * or the IAsset sentinel value for ETH (the zero address). Each entry in the `swaps` array specifies tokens in and
     * out by referencing an index in `assets`. Note that Pools never interact with ETH directly: it will be wrapped to
     * or unwrapped from WETH by the Vault.
     *
     * Internal Balance usage, sender, and recipient are determined by the `funds` struct. The `limits` array specifies
     * the minimum or maximum amount of each token the vault is allowed to transfer.
     *
     * `batchSwap` can be used to make a single swap, like `swap` does, but doing so requires more gas than the
     * equivalent `swap` call.
     *
     * Emits `Swap` events.
     */
    function batchSwap(
        SwapKind kind,
        BatchSwapStep[] memory swaps,
        IAsset[] memory assets,
        FundManagement memory funds,
        int256[] memory limits,
        uint256 deadline
    ) external payable returns (int256[] memory);

    /**
     * @dev Data for each individual swap executed by `batchSwap`. The asset in and out fields are indexes into the
     * `assets` array passed to that function, and ETH assets are converted to WETH.
     *
     * If `amount` is zero, the multihop mechanism is used to determine the actual amount based on the amount in/out
     * from the previous swap, depending on the swap kind.
     *
     * The `userData` field is ignored by the Vault, but forwarded to the Pool in the `onSwap` hook, and may be
     * used to extend swap behavior.
     */
    struct BatchSwapStep {
        bytes32 poolId;
        uint256 assetInIndex;
        uint256 assetOutIndex;
        uint256 amount;
        bytes userData;
    }

    /**
     * @dev Emitted for each individual swap performed by `swap` or `batchSwap`.
     */
    event Swap(
        bytes32 indexed poolId,
        IERC20 indexed tokenIn,
        IERC20 indexed tokenOut,
        uint256 amountIn,
        uint256 amountOut
    );

    /**
     * @dev All tokens in a swap are either sent from the `sender` account to the Vault, or from the Vault to the
     * `recipient` account.
     *
     * If the caller is not `sender`, it must be an authorized relayer for them.
     *
     * If `fromInternalBalance` is true, the `sender`'s Internal Balance will be preferred, performing an ERC20
     * transfer for the difference between the requested amount and the User's Internal Balance (if any). The `sender`
     * must have allowed the Vault to use their tokens via `IERC20.approve()`. This matches the behavior of
     * `joinPool`.
     *
     * If `toInternalBalance` is true, tokens will be deposited to `recipient`'s internal balance instead of
     * transferred. This matches the behavior of `exitPool`.
     *
     * Note that ETH cannot be deposited to or withdrawn from Internal Balance: attempting to do so will trigger a
     * revert.
     */
    struct FundManagement {
        address sender;
        bool fromInternalBalance;
        address payable recipient;
        bool toInternalBalance;
    }

    /**
     * @dev Simulates a call to `batchSwap`, returning an array of Vault asset deltas. Calls to `swap` cannot be
     * simulated directly, but an equivalent `batchSwap` call can and will yield the exact same result.
     *
     * Each element in the array corresponds to the asset at the same index, and indicates the number of tokens (or ETH)
     * the Vault would take from the sender (if positive) or send to the recipient (if negative). The arguments it
     * receives are the same that an equivalent `batchSwap` call would receive.
     *
     * Unlike `batchSwap`, this function performs no checks on the sender or recipient field in the `funds` struct.
     * This makes it suitable to be called by off-chain applications via eth_call without needing to hold tokens,
     * approve them for the Vault, or even know a user's address.
     *
     * Note that this function is not 'view' (due to implementation details): the client code must explicitly execute
     * eth_call instead of eth_sendTransaction.
     */
    function queryBatchSwap(
        SwapKind kind,
        BatchSwapStep[] memory swaps,
        IAsset[] memory assets,
        FundManagement memory funds
    ) external returns (int256[] memory assetDeltas);

    // Flash Loans

    /**
     * @dev Performs a 'flash loan', sending tokens to `recipient`, executing the `receiveFlashLoan` hook on it,
     * and then reverting unless the tokens plus a proportional protocol fee have been returned.
     *
     * The `tokens` and `amounts` arrays must have the same length, and each entry in these indicates the loan amount
     * for each token contract. `tokens` must be sorted in ascending order.
     *
     * The 'userData' field is ignored by the Vault, and forwarded as-is to `recipient` as part of the
     * `receiveFlashLoan` call.
     *
     * Emits `FlashLoan` events.
     */
    function flashLoan(
        IFlashLoanRecipient recipient,
        IERC20[] memory tokens,
        uint256[] memory amounts,
        bytes memory userData
    ) external;

    /**
     * @dev Emitted for each individual flash loan performed by `flashLoan`.
     */
    event FlashLoan(IFlashLoanRecipient indexed recipient, IERC20 indexed token, uint256 amount, uint256 feeAmount);

    // Asset Management
    //
    // Each token registered for a Pool can be assigned an Asset Manager, which is able to freely withdraw the Pool's
    // tokens from the Vault, deposit them, or assign arbitrary values to its `managed` balance (see
    // `getPoolTokenInfo`). This makes them extremely powerful and dangerous. Even if an Asset Manager only directly
    // controls one of the tokens in a Pool, a malicious manager could set that token's balance to manipulate the
    // prices of the other tokens, and then drain the Pool with swaps. The risk of using Asset Managers is therefore
    // not constrained to the tokens they are managing, but extends to the entire Pool's holdings.
    //
    // However, a properly designed Asset Manager smart contract can be safely used for the Pool's benefit,
    // for example by lending unused tokens out for interest, or using them to participate in voting protocols.
    //
    // This concept is unrelated to the IAsset interface.

    /**
     * @dev Performs a set of Pool balance operations, which may be either withdrawals, deposits or updates.
     *
     * Pool Balance management features batching, which means a single contract call can be used to perform multiple
     * operations of different kinds, with different Pools and tokens, at once.
     *
     * For each operation, the caller must be registered as the Asset Manager for `token` in `poolId`.
     */
    function managePoolBalance(PoolBalanceOp[] memory ops) external;

    struct PoolBalanceOp {
        PoolBalanceOpKind kind;
        bytes32 poolId;
        IERC20 token;
        uint256 amount;
    }

    /**
     * Withdrawals decrease the Pool's cash, but increase its managed balance, leaving the total balance unchanged.
     *
     * Deposits increase the Pool's cash, but decrease its managed balance, leaving the total balance unchanged.
     *
     * Updates don't affect the Pool's cash balance, but because the managed balance changes, it does alter the total.
     * The external amount can be either increased or decreased by this call (i.e., reporting a gain or a loss).
     */
    enum PoolBalanceOpKind { WITHDRAW, DEPOSIT, UPDATE }

    /**
     * @dev Emitted when a Pool's token Asset Manager alters its balance via `managePoolBalance`.
     */
    event PoolBalanceManaged(
        bytes32 indexed poolId,
        address indexed assetManager,
        IERC20 indexed token,
        int256 cashDelta,
        int256 managedDelta
    );

    // Protocol Fees
    //
    // Some operations cause the Vault to collect tokens in the form of protocol fees, which can then be withdrawn by
    // permissioned accounts.
    //
    // There are two kinds of protocol fees:
    //
    //  - flash loan fees: charged on all flash loans, as a percentage of the amounts lent.
    //
    //  - swap fees: a percentage of the fees charged by Pools when performing swaps. For a number of reasons, including
    // swap gas costs and interface simplicity, protocol swap fees are not charged on each individual swap. Rather,
    // Pools are expected to keep track of how much they have charged in swap fees, and pay any outstanding debts to the
    // Vault when they are joined or exited. This prevents users from joining a Pool with unpaid debt, as well as
    // exiting a Pool in debt without first paying their share.

    /**
     * @dev Returns the current protocol fee module.
     */
    function getProtocolFeesCollector() external view returns (ProtocolFeesCollector);

    /**
     * @dev Safety mechanism to pause most Vault operations in the event of an emergency - typically detection of an
     * error in some part of the system.
     *
     * The Vault can only be paused during an initial time period, after which pausing is forever disabled.
     *
     * While the contract is paused, the following features are disabled:
     * - depositing and transferring internal balance
     * - transferring external balance (using the Vault's allowance)
     * - swaps
     * - joining Pools
     * - Asset Manager interactions
     *
     * Internal Balance can still be withdrawn, and Pools exited.
     */
    function setPaused(bool paused) external;

    /**
     * @dev Returns the Vault's WETH instance.
     */
    function WETH() external view returns (IWETH);
    // solhint-disable-previous-line func-name-mixedcase
}

File 11 of 86 : IAuthorizer.sol
// SPDX-License-Identifier: GPL-3.0-or-later
// This program is free software: you can redistribute it and/or modify
// it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
// the Free Software Foundation, either version 3 of the License, or
// (at your option) any later version.

// This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
// but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
// MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE.  See the
// GNU General Public License for more details.

// You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
// along with this program.  If not, see <http://www.gnu.org/licenses/>.

pragma solidity ^0.7.0;

interface IAuthorizer {
    /**
     * @dev Returns true if `account` can perform the action described by `actionId` in the contract `where`.
     */
    function canPerform(
        bytes32 actionId,
        address account,
        address where
    ) external view returns (bool);
}

File 12 of 86 : IFlashLoanRecipient.sol
// SPDX-License-Identifier: GPL-3.0-or-later
// This program is free software: you can redistribute it and/or modify
// it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
// the Free Software Foundation, either version 3 of the License, or
// (at your option) any later version.

// This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
// but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
// MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE.  See the
// GNU General Public License for more details.

// You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
// along with this program.  If not, see <http://www.gnu.org/licenses/>.

pragma solidity ^0.7.0;

// Inspired by Aave Protocol's IFlashLoanReceiver.

import "../../lib/openzeppelin/IERC20.sol";

interface IFlashLoanRecipient {
    /**
     * @dev When `flashLoan` is called on the Vault, it invokes the `receiveFlashLoan` hook on the recipient.
     *
     * At the time of the call, the Vault will have transferred `amounts` for `tokens` to the recipient. Before this
     * call returns, the recipient must have transferred `amounts` plus `feeAmounts` for each token back to the
     * Vault, or else the entire flash loan will revert.
     *
     * `userData` is the same value passed in the `IVault.flashLoan` call.
     */
    function receiveFlashLoan(
        IERC20[] memory tokens,
        uint256[] memory amounts,
        uint256[] memory feeAmounts,
        bytes memory userData
    ) external;
}

File 13 of 86 : ProtocolFeesCollector.sol
// SPDX-License-Identifier: GPL-3.0-or-later
// This program is free software: you can redistribute it and/or modify
// it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
// the Free Software Foundation, either version 3 of the License, or
// (at your option) any later version.

// This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
// but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
// MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE.  See the
// GNU General Public License for more details.

// You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
// along with this program.  If not, see <http://www.gnu.org/licenses/>.

pragma solidity ^0.7.0;
pragma experimental ABIEncoderV2;

import "../lib/openzeppelin/IERC20.sol";
import "../lib/helpers/InputHelpers.sol";
import "../lib/helpers/Authentication.sol";
import "../lib/openzeppelin/ReentrancyGuard.sol";
import "../lib/openzeppelin/SafeERC20.sol";

import "./interfaces/IVault.sol";
import "./interfaces/IAuthorizer.sol";

/**
 * @dev This an auxiliary contract to the Vault, deployed by it during construction. It offloads some of the tasks the
 * Vault performs to reduce its overall bytecode size.
 *
 * The current values for all protocol fee percentages are stored here, and any tokens charged as protocol fees are
 * sent to this contract, where they may be withdrawn by authorized entities. All authorization tasks are delegated
 * to the Vault's own authorizer.
 */
contract ProtocolFeesCollector is Authentication, ReentrancyGuard {
    using SafeERC20 for IERC20;

    // Absolute maximum fee percentages (1e18 = 100%, 1e16 = 1%).
    uint256 private constant _MAX_PROTOCOL_SWAP_FEE_PERCENTAGE = 50e16; // 50%
    uint256 private constant _MAX_PROTOCOL_FLASH_LOAN_FEE_PERCENTAGE = 1e16; // 1%

    IVault public immutable vault;

    // All fee percentages are 18-decimal fixed point numbers.

    // The swap fee is charged whenever a swap occurs, as a percentage of the fee charged by the Pool. These are not
    // actually charged on each individual swap: the `Vault` relies on the Pools being honest and reporting fees due
    // when users join and exit them.
    uint256 private _swapFeePercentage;

    // The flash loan fee is charged whenever a flash loan occurs, as a percentage of the tokens lent.
    uint256 private _flashLoanFeePercentage;

    event SwapFeePercentageChanged(uint256 newSwapFeePercentage);
    event FlashLoanFeePercentageChanged(uint256 newFlashLoanFeePercentage);

    constructor(IVault _vault)
        // The ProtocolFeesCollector is a singleton, so it simply uses its own address to disambiguate action
        // identifiers.
        Authentication(bytes32(uint256(address(this))))
    {
        vault = _vault;
    }

    function withdrawCollectedFees(
        IERC20[] calldata tokens,
        uint256[] calldata amounts,
        address recipient
    ) external nonReentrant authenticate {
        InputHelpers.ensureInputLengthMatch(tokens.length, amounts.length);

        for (uint256 i = 0; i < tokens.length; ++i) {
            IERC20 token = tokens[i];
            uint256 amount = amounts[i];
            token.safeTransfer(recipient, amount);
        }
    }

    function setSwapFeePercentage(uint256 newSwapFeePercentage) external authenticate {
        _require(newSwapFeePercentage <= _MAX_PROTOCOL_SWAP_FEE_PERCENTAGE, Errors.SWAP_FEE_PERCENTAGE_TOO_HIGH);
        _swapFeePercentage = newSwapFeePercentage;
        emit SwapFeePercentageChanged(newSwapFeePercentage);
    }

    function setFlashLoanFeePercentage(uint256 newFlashLoanFeePercentage) external authenticate {
        _require(
            newFlashLoanFeePercentage <= _MAX_PROTOCOL_FLASH_LOAN_FEE_PERCENTAGE,
            Errors.FLASH_LOAN_FEE_PERCENTAGE_TOO_HIGH
        );
        _flashLoanFeePercentage = newFlashLoanFeePercentage;
        emit FlashLoanFeePercentageChanged(newFlashLoanFeePercentage);
    }

    function getSwapFeePercentage() external view returns (uint256) {
        return _swapFeePercentage;
    }

    function getFlashLoanFeePercentage() external view returns (uint256) {
        return _flashLoanFeePercentage;
    }

    function getCollectedFeeAmounts(IERC20[] memory tokens) external view returns (uint256[] memory feeAmounts) {
        feeAmounts = new uint256[](tokens.length);
        for (uint256 i = 0; i < tokens.length; ++i) {
            feeAmounts[i] = tokens[i].balanceOf(address(this));
        }
    }

    function getAuthorizer() external view returns (IAuthorizer) {
        return _getAuthorizer();
    }

    function _canPerform(bytes32 actionId, address account) internal view override returns (bool) {
        return _getAuthorizer().canPerform(actionId, account, address(this));
    }

    function _getAuthorizer() internal view returns (IAuthorizer) {
        return vault.getAuthorizer();
    }
}

File 14 of 86 : ISignaturesValidator.sol
// SPDX-License-Identifier: GPL-3.0-or-later
// This program is free software: you can redistribute it and/or modify
// it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
// the Free Software Foundation, either version 3 of the License, or
// (at your option) any later version.

// This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
// but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
// MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE.  See the
// GNU General Public License for more details.

// You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
// along with this program.  If not, see <http://www.gnu.org/licenses/>.

pragma solidity ^0.7.0;

/**
 * @dev Interface for the SignatureValidator helper, used to support meta-transactions.
 */
interface ISignaturesValidator {
    /**
     * @dev Returns the EIP712 domain separator.
     */
    function getDomainSeparator() external view returns (bytes32);

    /**
     * @dev Returns the next nonce used by an address to sign messages.
     */
    function getNextNonce(address user) external view returns (uint256);
}

File 15 of 86 : ITemporarilyPausable.sol
// SPDX-License-Identifier: GPL-3.0-or-later
// This program is free software: you can redistribute it and/or modify
// it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
// the Free Software Foundation, either version 3 of the License, or
// (at your option) any later version.

// This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
// but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
// MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE.  See the
// GNU General Public License for more details.

// You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
// along with this program.  If not, see <http://www.gnu.org/licenses/>.

pragma solidity ^0.7.0;

/**
 * @dev Interface for the TemporarilyPausable helper.
 */
interface ITemporarilyPausable {
    /**
     * @dev Emitted every time the pause state changes by `_setPaused`.
     */
    event PausedStateChanged(bool paused);

    /**
     * @dev Returns the current paused state.
     */
    function getPausedState()
        external
        view
        returns (
            bool paused,
            uint256 pauseWindowEndTime,
            uint256 bufferPeriodEndTime
        );
}

File 16 of 86 : InputHelpers.sol
// SPDX-License-Identifier: GPL-3.0-or-later
// This program is free software: you can redistribute it and/or modify
// it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
// the Free Software Foundation, either version 3 of the License, or
// (at your option) any later version.

// This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
// but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
// MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE.  See the
// GNU General Public License for more details.

// You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
// along with this program.  If not, see <http://www.gnu.org/licenses/>.

pragma solidity ^0.7.0;

import "../openzeppelin/IERC20.sol";

import "./BalancerErrors.sol";

import "../../vault/interfaces/IAsset.sol";

library InputHelpers {
    function ensureInputLengthMatch(uint256 a, uint256 b) internal pure {
        _require(a == b, Errors.INPUT_LENGTH_MISMATCH);
    }

    function ensureInputLengthMatch(
        uint256 a,
        uint256 b,
        uint256 c
    ) internal pure {
        _require(a == b && b == c, Errors.INPUT_LENGTH_MISMATCH);
    }

    function ensureArrayIsSorted(IAsset[] memory array) internal pure {
        address[] memory addressArray;
        // solhint-disable-next-line no-inline-assembly
        assembly {
            addressArray := array
        }
        ensureArrayIsSorted(addressArray);
    }

    function ensureArrayIsSorted(IERC20[] memory array) internal pure {
        address[] memory addressArray;
        // solhint-disable-next-line no-inline-assembly
        assembly {
            addressArray := array
        }
        ensureArrayIsSorted(addressArray);
    }

    function ensureArrayIsSorted(address[] memory array) internal pure {
        if (array.length < 2) {
            return;
        }

        address previous = array[0];
        for (uint256 i = 1; i < array.length; ++i) {
            address current = array[i];
            _require(previous < current, Errors.UNSORTED_ARRAY);
            previous = current;
        }
    }
}

File 17 of 86 : Authentication.sol
// SPDX-License-Identifier: GPL-3.0-or-later
// This program is free software: you can redistribute it and/or modify
// it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
// the Free Software Foundation, either version 3 of the License, or
// (at your option) any later version.

// This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
// but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
// MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE.  See the
// GNU General Public License for more details.

// You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
// along with this program.  If not, see <http://www.gnu.org/licenses/>.

pragma solidity ^0.7.0;

import "./BalancerErrors.sol";
import "./IAuthentication.sol";

/**
 * @dev Building block for performing access control on external functions.
 *
 * This contract is used via the `authenticate` modifier (or the `_authenticateCaller` function), which can be applied
 * to external functions to only make them callable by authorized accounts.
 *
 * Derived contracts must implement the `_canPerform` function, which holds the actual access control logic.
 */
abstract contract Authentication is IAuthentication {
    bytes32 private immutable _actionIdDisambiguator;

    /**
     * @dev The main purpose of the `actionIdDisambiguator` is to prevent accidental function selector collisions in
     * multi contract systems.
     *
     * There are two main uses for it:
     *  - if the contract is a singleton, any unique identifier can be used to make the associated action identifiers
     *    unique. The contract's own address is a good option.
     *  - if the contract belongs to a family that shares action identifiers for the same functions, an identifier
     *    shared by the entire family (and no other contract) should be used instead.
     */
    constructor(bytes32 actionIdDisambiguator) {
        _actionIdDisambiguator = actionIdDisambiguator;
    }

    /**
     * @dev Reverts unless the caller is allowed to call this function. Should only be applied to external functions.
     */
    modifier authenticate() {
        _authenticateCaller();
        _;
    }

    /**
     * @dev Reverts unless the caller is allowed to call the entry point function.
     */
    function _authenticateCaller() internal view {
        bytes32 actionId = getActionId(msg.sig);
        _require(_canPerform(actionId, msg.sender), Errors.SENDER_NOT_ALLOWED);
    }

    function getActionId(bytes4 selector) public view override returns (bytes32) {
        // Each external function is dynamically assigned an action identifier as the hash of the disambiguator and the
        // function selector. Disambiguation is necessary to avoid potential collisions in the function selectors of
        // multiple contracts.
        return keccak256(abi.encodePacked(_actionIdDisambiguator, selector));
    }

    function _canPerform(bytes32 actionId, address user) internal view virtual returns (bool);
}

File 18 of 86 : ReentrancyGuard.sol
// SPDX-License-Identifier: MIT

pragma solidity ^0.7.0;

import "../helpers/BalancerErrors.sol";

// Based on the ReentrancyGuard library from OpenZeppelin contracts, altered to reduce bytecode size.
// Modifier code is inlined by the compiler, which causes its code to appear multiple times in the codebase. By using
// private functions, we achieve the same end result with slightly higher runtime gas costs but reduced bytecode size.

/**
 * @dev Contract module that helps prevent reentrant calls to a function.
 *
 * Inheriting from `ReentrancyGuard` will make the {nonReentrant} modifier
 * available, which can be applied to functions to make sure there are no nested
 * (reentrant) calls to them.
 *
 * Note that because there is a single `nonReentrant` guard, functions marked as
 * `nonReentrant` may not call one another. This can be worked around by making
 * those functions `private`, and then adding `external` `nonReentrant` entry
 * points to them.
 *
 * TIP: If you would like to learn more about reentrancy and alternative ways
 * to protect against it, check out our blog post
 * https://blog.openzeppelin.com/reentrancy-after-istanbul/[Reentrancy After Istanbul].
 */
abstract contract ReentrancyGuard {
    // Booleans are more expensive than uint256 or any type that takes up a full
    // word because each write operation emits an extra SLOAD to first read the
    // slot's contents, replace the bits taken up by the boolean, and then write
    // back. This is the compiler's defense against contract upgrades and
    // pointer aliasing, and it cannot be disabled.

    // The values being non-zero value makes deployment a bit more expensive,
    // but in exchange the refund on every call to nonReentrant will be lower in
    // amount. Since refunds are capped to a percentage of the total
    // transaction's gas, it is best to keep them low in cases like this one, to
    // increase the likelihood of the full refund coming into effect.
    uint256 private constant _NOT_ENTERED = 1;
    uint256 private constant _ENTERED = 2;

    uint256 private _status;

    constructor() {
        _status = _NOT_ENTERED;
    }

    /**
     * @dev Prevents a contract from calling itself, directly or indirectly.
     * Calling a `nonReentrant` function from another `nonReentrant`
     * function is not supported. It is possible to prevent this from happening
     * by making the `nonReentrant` function external, and make it call a
     * `private` function that does the actual work.
     */
    modifier nonReentrant() {
        _enterNonReentrant();
        _;
        _exitNonReentrant();
    }

    function _enterNonReentrant() private {
        // On the first call to nonReentrant, _status will be _NOT_ENTERED
        _require(_status != _ENTERED, Errors.REENTRANCY);

        // Any calls to nonReentrant after this point will fail
        _status = _ENTERED;
    }

    function _exitNonReentrant() private {
        // By storing the original value once again, a refund is triggered (see
        // https://eips.ethereum.org/EIPS/eip-2200)
        _status = _NOT_ENTERED;
    }
}

File 19 of 86 : IAuthentication.sol
// SPDX-License-Identifier: GPL-3.0-or-later
// This program is free software: you can redistribute it and/or modify
// it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
// the Free Software Foundation, either version 3 of the License, or
// (at your option) any later version.

// This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
// but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
// MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE.  See the
// GNU General Public License for more details.

// You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
// along with this program.  If not, see <http://www.gnu.org/licenses/>.

pragma solidity ^0.7.0;

interface IAuthentication {
    /**
     * @dev Returns the action identifier associated with the external function described by `selector`.
     */
    function getActionId(bytes4 selector) external view returns (bytes32);
}

File 20 of 86 : UserBalance.sol
// SPDX-License-Identifier: GPL-3.0-or-later
// This program is free software: you can redistribute it and/or modify
// it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
// the Free Software Foundation, either version 3 of the License, or
// (at your option) any later version.

// This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
// but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
// MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE.  See the
// GNU General Public License for more details.

// You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
// along with this program.  If not, see <http://www.gnu.org/licenses/>.

pragma solidity ^0.7.0;
pragma experimental ABIEncoderV2;

import "../lib/helpers/BalancerErrors.sol";
import "../lib/math/Math.sol";
import "../lib/openzeppelin/IERC20.sol";
import "../lib/openzeppelin/ReentrancyGuard.sol";
import "../lib/openzeppelin/SafeCast.sol";
import "../lib/openzeppelin/SafeERC20.sol";

import "./AssetTransfersHandler.sol";
import "./VaultAuthorization.sol";

/**
 * Implement User Balance interactions, which combine Internal Balance and using the Vault's ERC20 allowance.
 *
 * Users can deposit tokens into the Vault, where they are allocated to their Internal Balance, and later
 * transferred or withdrawn. It can also be used as a source of tokens when joining Pools, as a destination
 * when exiting them, and as either when performing swaps. This usage of Internal Balance results in greatly reduced
 * gas costs when compared to relying on plain ERC20 transfers, leading to large savings for frequent users.
 *
 * Internal Balance management features batching, which means a single contract call can be used to perform multiple
 * operations of different kinds, with different senders and recipients, at once.
 */
abstract contract UserBalance is ReentrancyGuard, AssetTransfersHandler, VaultAuthorization {
    using Math for uint256;
    using SafeCast for uint256;
    using SafeERC20 for IERC20;

    // Internal Balance for each token, for each account.
    mapping(address => mapping(IERC20 => uint256)) private _internalTokenBalance;

    function getInternalBalance(address user, IERC20[] memory tokens)
        external
        view
        override
        returns (uint256[] memory balances)
    {
        balances = new uint256[](tokens.length);
        for (uint256 i = 0; i < tokens.length; i++) {
            balances[i] = _getInternalBalance(user, tokens[i]);
        }
    }

    function manageUserBalance(UserBalanceOp[] memory ops) external payable override nonReentrant {
        // We need to track how much of the received ETH was used and wrapped into WETH to return any excess.
        uint256 ethWrapped = 0;

        // Cache for these checks so we only perform them once (if at all).
        bool checkedCallerIsRelayer = false;
        bool checkedNotPaused = false;

        for (uint256 i = 0; i < ops.length; i++) {
            UserBalanceOpKind kind;
            IAsset asset;
            uint256 amount;
            address sender;
            address payable recipient;

            // This destructuring by calling `_validateUserBalanceOp` seems odd, but results in reduced bytecode size.
            (kind, asset, amount, sender, recipient, checkedCallerIsRelayer) = _validateUserBalanceOp(
                ops[i],
                checkedCallerIsRelayer
            );

            if (kind == UserBalanceOpKind.WITHDRAW_INTERNAL) {
                // Internal Balance withdrawals can always be performed by an authorized account.
                _withdrawFromInternalBalance(asset, sender, recipient, amount);
            } else {
                // All other operations are blocked if the contract is paused.

                // We cache the result of the pause check and skip it for other operations in this same transaction
                // (if any).
                if (!checkedNotPaused) {
                    _ensureNotPaused();
                    checkedNotPaused = true;
                }

                if (kind == UserBalanceOpKind.DEPOSIT_INTERNAL) {
                    _depositToInternalBalance(asset, sender, recipient, amount);

                    // Keep track of all ETH wrapped into WETH as part of a deposit.
                    if (_isETH(asset)) {
                        ethWrapped = ethWrapped.add(amount);
                    }
                } else {
                    // Transfers don't support ETH.
                    _require(!_isETH(asset), Errors.CANNOT_USE_ETH_SENTINEL);
                    IERC20 token = _asIERC20(asset);

                    if (kind == UserBalanceOpKind.TRANSFER_INTERNAL) {
                        _transferInternalBalance(token, sender, recipient, amount);
                    } else {
                        // TRANSFER_EXTERNAL
                        _transferToExternalBalance(token, sender, recipient, amount);
                    }
                }
            }
        }

        // Handle any remaining ETH.
        _handleRemainingEth(ethWrapped);
    }

    function _depositToInternalBalance(
        IAsset asset,
        address sender,
        address recipient,
        uint256 amount
    ) private {
        _increaseInternalBalance(recipient, _translateToIERC20(asset), amount);
        _receiveAsset(asset, amount, sender, false);
    }

    function _withdrawFromInternalBalance(
        IAsset asset,
        address sender,
        address payable recipient,
        uint256 amount
    ) private {
        // A partial decrease of Internal Balance is disallowed: `sender` must have the full `amount`.
        _decreaseInternalBalance(sender, _translateToIERC20(asset), amount, false);
        _sendAsset(asset, amount, recipient, false);
    }

    function _transferInternalBalance(
        IERC20 token,
        address sender,
        address recipient,
        uint256 amount
    ) private {
        // A partial decrease of Internal Balance is disallowed: `sender` must have the full `amount`.
        _decreaseInternalBalance(sender, token, amount, false);
        _increaseInternalBalance(recipient, token, amount);
    }

    function _transferToExternalBalance(
        IERC20 token,
        address sender,
        address recipient,
        uint256 amount
    ) private {
        if (amount > 0) {
            token.safeTransferFrom(sender, recipient, amount);
            emit ExternalBalanceTransfer(token, sender, recipient, amount);
        }
    }

    /**
     * @dev Increases `account`'s Internal Balance for `token` by `amount`.
     */
    function _increaseInternalBalance(
        address account,
        IERC20 token,
        uint256 amount
    ) internal override {
        uint256 currentBalance = _getInternalBalance(account, token);
        uint256 newBalance = currentBalance.add(amount);
        _setInternalBalance(account, token, newBalance, amount.toInt256());
    }

    /**
     * @dev Decreases `account`'s Internal Balance for `token` by `amount`. If `allowPartial` is true, this function
     * doesn't revert if `account` doesn't have enough balance, and sets it to zero and returns the deducted amount
     * instead.
     */
    function _decreaseInternalBalance(
        address account,
        IERC20 token,
        uint256 amount,
        bool allowPartial
    ) internal override returns (uint256 deducted) {
        uint256 currentBalance = _getInternalBalance(account, token);
        _require(allowPartial || (currentBalance >= amount), Errors.INSUFFICIENT_INTERNAL_BALANCE);

        deducted = Math.min(currentBalance, amount);
        // By construction, `deducted` is lower or equal to `currentBalance`, so we don't need to use checked
        // arithmetic.
        uint256 newBalance = currentBalance - deducted;
        _setInternalBalance(account, token, newBalance, -(deducted.toInt256()));
    }

    /**
     * @dev Sets `account`'s Internal Balance for `token` to `newBalance`.
     *
     * Emits an `InternalBalanceChanged` event. This event includes `delta`, which is the amount the balance increased
     * (if positive) or decreased (if negative). To avoid reading the current balance in order to compute the delta,
     * this function relies on the caller providing it directly.
     */
    function _setInternalBalance(
        address account,
        IERC20 token,
        uint256 newBalance,
        int256 delta
    ) private {
        _internalTokenBalance[account][token] = newBalance;
        emit InternalBalanceChanged(account, token, delta);
    }

    /**
     * @dev Returns `account`'s Internal Balance for `token`.
     */
    function _getInternalBalance(address account, IERC20 token) internal view returns (uint256) {
        return _internalTokenBalance[account][token];
    }

    /**
     * @dev Destructures a User Balance operation, validating that the contract caller is allowed to perform it.
     */
    function _validateUserBalanceOp(UserBalanceOp memory op, bool checkedCallerIsRelayer)
        private
        view
        returns (
            UserBalanceOpKind,
            IAsset,
            uint256,
            address,
            address payable,
            bool
        )
    {
        // The only argument we need to validate is `sender`, which can only be either the contract caller, or a
        // relayer approved by `sender`.
        address sender = op.sender;

        if (sender != msg.sender) {
            // We need to check both that the contract caller is a relayer, and that `sender` approved them.

            // Because the relayer check is global (i.e. independent of `sender`), we cache that result and skip it for
            // other operations in this same transaction (if any).
            if (!checkedCallerIsRelayer) {
                _authenticateCaller();
                checkedCallerIsRelayer = true;
            }

            _require(_hasApprovedRelayer(sender, msg.sender), Errors.USER_DOESNT_ALLOW_RELAYER);
        }

        return (op.kind, op.asset, op.amount, sender, op.recipient, checkedCallerIsRelayer);
    }
}

File 21 of 86 : SafeCast.sol
// SPDX-License-Identifier: MIT

pragma solidity ^0.7.0;

import "../helpers/BalancerErrors.sol";

/**
 * @dev Wrappers over Solidity's uintXX/intXX casting operators with added overflow
 * checks.
 *
 * Downcasting from uint256/int256 in Solidity does not revert on overflow. This can
 * easily result in undesired exploitation or bugs, since developers usually
 * assume that overflows raise errors. `SafeCast` restores this intuition by
 * reverting the transaction when such an operation overflows.
 *
 * Using this library instead of the unchecked operations eliminates an entire
 * class of bugs, so it's recommended to use it always.
 *
 * Can be combined with {SafeMath} and {SignedSafeMath} to extend it to smaller types, by performing
 * all math on `uint256` and `int256` and then downcasting.
 */
library SafeCast {
    /**
     * @dev Converts an unsigned uint256 into a signed int256.
     *
     * Requirements:
     *
     * - input must be less than or equal to maxInt256.
     */
    function toInt256(uint256 value) internal pure returns (int256) {
        _require(value < 2**255, Errors.SAFE_CAST_VALUE_CANT_FIT_INT256);
        return int256(value);
    }
}

File 22 of 86 : VaultAuthorization.sol
// SPDX-License-Identifier: GPL-3.0-or-later
// This program is free software: you can redistribute it and/or modify
// it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
// the Free Software Foundation, either version 3 of the License, or
// (at your option) any later version.

// This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
// but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
// MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE.  See the
// GNU General Public License for more details.

// You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
// along with this program.  If not, see <http://www.gnu.org/licenses/>.

pragma solidity ^0.7.0;
pragma experimental ABIEncoderV2;

import "../lib/helpers/BalancerErrors.sol";
import "../lib/helpers/Authentication.sol";
import "../lib/helpers/TemporarilyPausable.sol";
import "../lib/helpers/BalancerErrors.sol";
import "../lib/helpers/SignaturesValidator.sol";
import "../lib/openzeppelin/ReentrancyGuard.sol";

import "./interfaces/IVault.sol";
import "./interfaces/IAuthorizer.sol";

/**
 * @dev Manages access control of Vault permissioned functions by relying on the Authorizer and signature validation.
 *
 * Additionally handles relayer access and approval.
 */
abstract contract VaultAuthorization is
    IVault,
    ReentrancyGuard,
    Authentication,
    SignaturesValidator,
    TemporarilyPausable
{
    // Ideally, we'd store the type hashes as immutable state variables to avoid computing the hash at runtime, but
    // unfortunately immutable variables cannot be used in assembly, so we just keep the precomputed hashes instead.

    // _JOIN_TYPE_HASH = keccak256("JoinPool(bytes calldata,address sender,uint256 nonce,uint256 deadline)");
    bytes32 private constant _JOIN_TYPE_HASH = 0x3f7b71252bd19113ff48c19c6e004a9bcfcca320a0d74d58e85877cbd7dcae58;

    // _EXIT_TYPE_HASH = keccak256("ExitPool(bytes calldata,address sender,uint256 nonce,uint256 deadline)");
    bytes32 private constant _EXIT_TYPE_HASH = 0x8bbc57f66ea936902f50a71ce12b92c43f3c5340bb40c27c4e90ab84eeae3353;

    // _SWAP_TYPE_HASH = keccak256("Swap(bytes calldata,address sender,uint256 nonce,uint256 deadline)");
    bytes32 private constant _SWAP_TYPE_HASH = 0xe192dcbc143b1e244ad73b813fd3c097b832ad260a157340b4e5e5beda067abe;

    // _BATCH_SWAP_TYPE_HASH = keccak256("BatchSwap(bytes calldata,address sender,uint256 nonce,uint256 deadline)");
    bytes32 private constant _BATCH_SWAP_TYPE_HASH = 0x9bfc43a4d98313c6766986ffd7c916c7481566d9f224c6819af0a53388aced3a;

    // _SET_RELAYER_TYPE_HASH =
    //     keccak256("SetRelayerApproval(bytes calldata,address sender,uint256 nonce,uint256 deadline)");
    bytes32
        private constant _SET_RELAYER_TYPE_HASH = 0xa3f865aa351e51cfeb40f5178d1564bb629fe9030b83caf6361d1baaf5b90b5a;

    IAuthorizer private _authorizer;
    mapping(address => mapping(address => bool)) private _approvedRelayers;

    /**
     * @dev Reverts unless `user` is the caller, or the caller is approved by the Authorizer to call this function (that
     * is, it is a relayer for that function), and either:
     *  a) `user` approved the caller as a relayer (via `setRelayerApproval`), or
     *  b) a valid signature from them was appended to the calldata.
     *
     * Should only be applied to external functions.
     */
    modifier authenticateFor(address user) {
        _authenticateFor(user);
        _;
    }

    constructor(IAuthorizer authorizer)
        // The Vault is a singleton, so it simply uses its own address to disambiguate action identifiers.
        Authentication(bytes32(uint256(address(this))))
        SignaturesValidator("Balancer V2 Vault")
    {
        _setAuthorizer(authorizer);
    }

    function setAuthorizer(IAuthorizer newAuthorizer) external override nonReentrant authenticate {
        _setAuthorizer(newAuthorizer);
    }

    function _setAuthorizer(IAuthorizer newAuthorizer) private {
        emit AuthorizerChanged(newAuthorizer);
        _authorizer = newAuthorizer;
    }

    function getAuthorizer() external view override returns (IAuthorizer) {
        return _authorizer;
    }

    function setRelayerApproval(
        address sender,
        address relayer,
        bool approved
    ) external override nonReentrant whenNotPaused authenticateFor(sender) {
        _approvedRelayers[sender][relayer] = approved;
        emit RelayerApprovalChanged(relayer, sender, approved);
    }

    function hasApprovedRelayer(address user, address relayer) external view override returns (bool) {
        return _hasApprovedRelayer(user, relayer);
    }

    /**
     * @dev Reverts unless `user` is the caller, or the caller is approved by the Authorizer to call the entry point
     * function (that is, it is a relayer for that function) and either:
     *  a) `user` approved the caller as a relayer (via `setRelayerApproval`), or
     *  b) a valid signature from them was appended to the calldata.
     */
    function _authenticateFor(address user) internal {
        if (msg.sender != user) {
            // In this context, 'permission to call a function' means 'being a relayer for a function'.
            _authenticateCaller();

            // Being a relayer is not sufficient: `user` must have also approved the caller either via
            // `setRelayerApproval`, or by providing a signature appended to the calldata.
            if (!_hasApprovedRelayer(user, msg.sender)) {
                _validateSignature(user, Errors.USER_DOESNT_ALLOW_RELAYER);
            }
        }
    }

    /**
     * @dev Returns true if `user` approved `relayer` to act as a relayer for them.
     */
    function _hasApprovedRelayer(address user, address relayer) internal view returns (bool) {
        return _approvedRelayers[user][relayer];
    }

    function _canPerform(bytes32 actionId, address user) internal view override returns (bool) {
        // Access control is delegated to the Authorizer.
        return _authorizer.canPerform(actionId, user, address(this));
    }

    function _typeHash() internal pure override returns (bytes32 hash) {
        // This is a simple switch-case statement, trivially written in Solidity by chaining else-if statements, but the
        // assembly implementation results in much denser bytecode.
        // solhint-disable-next-line no-inline-assembly
        assembly {
            // The function selector is located at the first 4 bytes of calldata. We copy the first full calldata
            // 256 word, and then perform a logical shift to the right, moving the selector to the least significant
            // 4 bytes.
            let selector := shr(224, calldataload(0))

            // With the selector in the least significant 4 bytes, we can use 4 byte literals with leading zeros,
            // resulting in dense bytecode (PUSH4 opcodes).
            switch selector
                case 0xb95cac28 {
                    hash := _JOIN_TYPE_HASH
                }
                case 0x8bdb3913 {
                    hash := _EXIT_TYPE_HASH
                }
                case 0x52bbbe29 {
                    hash := _SWAP_TYPE_HASH
                }
                case 0x945bcec9 {
                    hash := _BATCH_SWAP_TYPE_HASH
                }
                case 0xfa6e671d {
                    hash := _SET_RELAYER_TYPE_HASH
                }
                default {
                    hash := 0x0000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000
                }
        }
    }
}

File 23 of 86 : TemporarilyPausable.sol
// SPDX-License-Identifier: GPL-3.0-or-later
// This program is free software: you can redistribute it and/or modify
// it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
// the Free Software Foundation, either version 3 of the License, or
// (at your option) any later version.

// This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
// but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
// MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE.  See the
// GNU General Public License for more details.

// You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
// along with this program.  If not, see <http://www.gnu.org/licenses/>.

pragma solidity ^0.7.0;

import "./BalancerErrors.sol";
import "./ITemporarilyPausable.sol";

/**
 * @dev Allows for a contract to be paused during an initial period after deployment, disabling functionality. Can be
 * used as an emergency switch in case a security vulnerability or threat is identified.
 *
 * The contract can only be paused during the Pause Window, a period that starts at deployment. It can also be
 * unpaused and repaused any number of times during this period. This is intended to serve as a safety measure: it lets
 * system managers react quickly to potentially dangerous situations, knowing that this action is reversible if careful
 * analysis later determines there was a false alarm.
 *
 * If the contract is paused when the Pause Window finishes, it will remain in the paused state through an additional
 * Buffer Period, after which it will be automatically unpaused forever. This is to ensure there is always enough time
 * to react to an emergency, even if the threat is discovered shortly before the Pause Window expires.
 *
 * Note that since the contract can only be paused within the Pause Window, unpausing during the Buffer Period is
 * irreversible.
 */
abstract contract TemporarilyPausable is ITemporarilyPausable {
    // The Pause Window and Buffer Period are timestamp-based: they should not be relied upon for sub-minute accuracy.
    // solhint-disable not-rely-on-time

    uint256 private constant _MAX_PAUSE_WINDOW_DURATION = 90 days;
    uint256 private constant _MAX_BUFFER_PERIOD_DURATION = 30 days;

    uint256 private immutable _pauseWindowEndTime;
    uint256 private immutable _bufferPeriodEndTime;

    bool private _paused;

    constructor(uint256 pauseWindowDuration, uint256 bufferPeriodDuration) {
        _require(pauseWindowDuration <= _MAX_PAUSE_WINDOW_DURATION, Errors.MAX_PAUSE_WINDOW_DURATION);
        _require(bufferPeriodDuration <= _MAX_BUFFER_PERIOD_DURATION, Errors.MAX_BUFFER_PERIOD_DURATION);

        uint256 pauseWindowEndTime = block.timestamp + pauseWindowDuration;

        _pauseWindowEndTime = pauseWindowEndTime;
        _bufferPeriodEndTime = pauseWindowEndTime + bufferPeriodDuration;
    }

    /**
     * @dev Reverts if the contract is paused.
     */
    modifier whenNotPaused() {
        _ensureNotPaused();
        _;
    }

    /**
     * @dev Returns the current contract pause status, as well as the end times of the Pause Window and Buffer
     * Period.
     */
    function getPausedState()
        external
        view
        override
        returns (
            bool paused,
            uint256 pauseWindowEndTime,
            uint256 bufferPeriodEndTime
        )
    {
        paused = !_isNotPaused();
        pauseWindowEndTime = _getPauseWindowEndTime();
        bufferPeriodEndTime = _getBufferPeriodEndTime();
    }

    /**
     * @dev Sets the pause state to `paused`. The contract can only be paused until the end of the Pause Window, and
     * unpaused until the end of the Buffer Period.
     *
     * Once the Buffer Period expires, this function reverts unconditionally.
     */
    function _setPaused(bool paused) internal {
        if (paused) {
            _require(block.timestamp < _getPauseWindowEndTime(), Errors.PAUSE_WINDOW_EXPIRED);
        } else {
            _require(block.timestamp < _getBufferPeriodEndTime(), Errors.BUFFER_PERIOD_EXPIRED);
        }

        _paused = paused;
        emit PausedStateChanged(paused);
    }

    /**
     * @dev Reverts if the contract is paused.
     */
    function _ensureNotPaused() internal view {
        _require(_isNotPaused(), Errors.PAUSED);
    }

    /**
     * @dev Returns true if the contract is unpaused.
     *
     * Once the Buffer Period expires, the gas cost of calling this function is reduced dramatically, as storage is no
     * longer accessed.
     */
    function _isNotPaused() internal view returns (bool) {
        // After the Buffer Period, the (inexpensive) timestamp check short-circuits the storage access.
        return block.timestamp > _getBufferPeriodEndTime() || !_paused;
    }

    // These getters lead to reduced bytecode size by inlining the immutable variables in a single place.

    function _getPauseWindowEndTime() private view returns (uint256) {
        return _pauseWindowEndTime;
    }

    function _getBufferPeriodEndTime() private view returns (uint256) {
        return _bufferPeriodEndTime;
    }
}

File 24 of 86 : SignaturesValidator.sol
// SPDX-License-Identifier: GPL-3.0-or-later
// This program is free software: you can redistribute it and/or modify
// it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
// the Free Software Foundation, either version 3 of the License, or
// (at your option) any later version.

// This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
// but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
// MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE.  See the
// GNU General Public License for more details.

// You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
// along with this program.  If not, see <http://www.gnu.org/licenses/>.

pragma solidity ^0.7.0;

import "./BalancerErrors.sol";
import "./ISignaturesValidator.sol";
import "../openzeppelin/EIP712.sol";

/**
 * @dev Utility for signing Solidity function calls.
 *
 * This contract relies on the fact that Solidity contracts can be called with extra calldata, and enables
 * meta-transaction schemes by appending an EIP712 signature of the original calldata at the end.
 *
 * Derived contracts must implement the `_typeHash` function to map function selectors to EIP712 structs.
 */
abstract contract SignaturesValidator is ISignaturesValidator, EIP712 {
    // The appended data consists of a deadline, plus the [v,r,s] signature. For simplicity, we use a full 256 bit slot
    // for each of these values, even if 'v' is typically an 8 bit value.
    uint256 internal constant _EXTRA_CALLDATA_LENGTH = 4 * 32;

    // Replay attack prevention for each user.
    mapping(address => uint256) internal _nextNonce;

    constructor(string memory name) EIP712(name, "1") {
        // solhint-disable-previous-line no-empty-blocks
    }

    function getDomainSeparator() external view override returns (bytes32) {
        return _domainSeparatorV4();
    }

    function getNextNonce(address user) external view override returns (uint256) {
        return _nextNonce[user];
    }

    /**
     * @dev Reverts with `errorCode` unless a valid signature for `user` was appended to the calldata.
     */
    function _validateSignature(address user, uint256 errorCode) internal {
        uint256 nextNonce = _nextNonce[user]++;
        _require(_isSignatureValid(user, nextNonce), errorCode);
    }

    function _isSignatureValid(address user, uint256 nonce) private view returns (bool) {
        uint256 deadline = _deadline();

        // The deadline is timestamp-based: it should not be relied upon for sub-minute accuracy.
        // solhint-disable-next-line not-rely-on-time
        if (deadline < block.timestamp) {
            return false;
        }

        bytes32 typeHash = _typeHash();
        if (typeHash == bytes32(0)) {
            // Prevent accidental signature validation for functions that don't have an associated type hash.
            return false;
        }

        // All type hashes have this format: (bytes calldata, address sender, uint256 nonce, uint256 deadline).
        bytes32 structHash = keccak256(abi.encode(typeHash, keccak256(_calldata()), msg.sender, nonce, deadline));
        bytes32 digest = _hashTypedDataV4(structHash);
        (uint8 v, bytes32 r, bytes32 s) = _signature();

        address recoveredAddress = ecrecover(digest, v, r, s);

        // ecrecover returns the zero address on recover failure, so we need to handle that explicitly.
        return recoveredAddress != address(0) && recoveredAddress == user;
    }

    /**
     * @dev Returns the EIP712 type hash for the current entry point function, which can be identified by its function
     * selector (available as `msg.sig`).
     *
     * The type hash must conform to the following format:
     *  <name>(bytes calldata, address sender, uint256 nonce, uint256 deadline)
     *
     * If 0x00, all signatures will be considered invalid.
     */
    function _typeHash() internal view virtual returns (bytes32);

    /**
     * @dev Extracts the signature deadline from extra calldata.
     *
     * This function returns bogus data if no signature is included.
     */
    function _deadline() internal pure returns (uint256) {
        // The deadline is the first extra argument at the end of the original calldata.
        return uint256(_decodeExtraCalldataWord(0));
    }

    /**
     * @dev Extracts the signature parameters from extra calldata.
     *
     * This function returns bogus data if no signature is included. This is not a security risk, as that data would not
     * be considered a valid signature in the first place.
     */
    function _signature()
        internal
        pure
        returns (
            uint8 v,
            bytes32 r,
            bytes32 s
        )
    {
        // v, r and s are appended after the signature deadline, in that order.
        v = uint8(uint256(_decodeExtraCalldataWord(0x20)));
        r = _decodeExtraCalldataWord(0x40);
        s = _decodeExtraCalldataWord(0x60);
    }

    /**
     * @dev Returns the original calldata, without the extra bytes containing the signature.
     *
     * This function returns bogus data if no signature is included.
     */
    function _calldata() internal pure returns (bytes memory result) {
        result = msg.data; // A calldata to memory assignment results in memory allocation and copy of contents.
        if (result.length > _EXTRA_CALLDATA_LENGTH) {
            // solhint-disable-next-line no-inline-assembly
            assembly {
                // We simply overwrite the array length with the reduced one.
                mstore(result, sub(calldatasize(), _EXTRA_CALLDATA_LENGTH))
            }
        }
    }

    /**
     * @dev Returns a 256 bit word from 'extra' calldata, at some offset from the expected end of the original calldata.
     *
     * This function returns bogus data if no signature is included.
     */
    function _decodeExtraCalldataWord(uint256 offset) private pure returns (bytes32 result) {
        // solhint-disable-next-line no-inline-assembly
        assembly {
            result := calldataload(add(sub(calldatasize(), _EXTRA_CALLDATA_LENGTH), offset))
        }
    }
}

File 25 of 86 : EIP712.sol
// SPDX-License-Identifier: MIT

pragma solidity ^0.7.0;

/**
 * @dev https://eips.ethereum.org/EIPS/eip-712[EIP 712] is a standard for hashing and signing of typed structured data.
 *
 * The encoding specified in the EIP is very generic, and such a generic implementation in Solidity is not feasible,
 * thus this contract does not implement the encoding itself. Protocols need to implement the type-specific encoding
 * they need in their contracts using a combination of `abi.encode` and `keccak256`.
 *
 * This contract implements the EIP 712 domain separator ({_domainSeparatorV4}) that is used as part of the encoding
 * scheme, and the final step of the encoding to obtain the message digest that is then signed via ECDSA
 * ({_hashTypedDataV4}).
 *
 * The implementation of the domain separator was designed to be as efficient as possible while still properly updating
 * the chain id to protect against replay attacks on an eventual fork of the chain.
 *
 * NOTE: This contract implements the version of the encoding known as "v4", as implemented by the JSON RPC method
 * https://docs.metamask.io/guide/signing-data.html[`eth_signTypedDataV4` in MetaMask].
 *
 * _Available since v3.4._
 */
abstract contract EIP712 {
    /* solhint-disable var-name-mixedcase */
    bytes32 private immutable _HASHED_NAME;
    bytes32 private immutable _HASHED_VERSION;
    bytes32 private immutable _TYPE_HASH;

    /* solhint-enable var-name-mixedcase */

    /**
     * @dev Initializes the domain separator and parameter caches.
     *
     * The meaning of `name` and `version` is specified in
     * https://eips.ethereum.org/EIPS/eip-712#definition-of-domainseparator[EIP 712]:
     *
     * - `name`: the user readable name of the signing domain, i.e. the name of the DApp or the protocol.
     * - `version`: the current major version of the signing domain.
     *
     * NOTE: These parameters cannot be changed except through a xref:learn::upgrading-smart-contracts.adoc[smart
     * contract upgrade].
     */
    constructor(string memory name, string memory version) {
        _HASHED_NAME = keccak256(bytes(name));
        _HASHED_VERSION = keccak256(bytes(version));
        _TYPE_HASH = keccak256("EIP712Domain(string name,string version,uint256 chainId,address verifyingContract)");
    }

    /**
     * @dev Returns the domain separator for the current chain.
     */
    function _domainSeparatorV4() internal view virtual returns (bytes32) {
        return keccak256(abi.encode(_TYPE_HASH, _HASHED_NAME, _HASHED_VERSION, _getChainId(), address(this)));
    }

    /**
     * @dev Given an already https://eips.ethereum.org/EIPS/eip-712#definition-of-hashstruct[hashed struct], this
     * function returns the hash of the fully encoded EIP712 message for this domain.
     *
     * This hash can be used together with {ECDSA-recover} to obtain the signer of a message. For example:
     *
     * ```solidity
     * bytes32 digest = _hashTypedDataV4(keccak256(abi.encode(
     *     keccak256("Mail(address to,string contents)"),
     *     mailTo,
     *     keccak256(bytes(mailContents))
     * )));
     * address signer = ECDSA.recover(digest, signature);
     * ```
     */
    function _hashTypedDataV4(bytes32 structHash) internal view virtual returns (bytes32) {
        return keccak256(abi.encodePacked("\x19\x01", _domainSeparatorV4(), structHash));
    }

    function _getChainId() private view returns (uint256 chainId) {
        // Silence state mutability warning without generating bytecode.
        // See https://github.com/ethereum/solidity/issues/10090#issuecomment-741789128 and
        // https://github.com/ethereum/solidity/issues/2691
        this;

        // solhint-disable-next-line no-inline-assembly
        assembly {
            chainId := chainid()
        }
    }
}

File 26 of 86 : PoolBalances.sol
// SPDX-License-Identifier: GPL-3.0-or-later
// This program is free software: you can redistribute it and/or modify
// it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
// the Free Software Foundation, either version 3 of the License, or
// (at your option) any later version.

// This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
// but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
// MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE.  See the
// GNU General Public License for more details.

// You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
// along with this program.  If not, see <http://www.gnu.org/licenses/>.

pragma solidity ^0.7.0;
pragma experimental ABIEncoderV2;

import "../lib/math/Math.sol";
import "../lib/helpers/BalancerErrors.sol";
import "../lib/helpers/InputHelpers.sol";
import "../lib/openzeppelin/IERC20.sol";
import "../lib/openzeppelin/ReentrancyGuard.sol";
import "../lib/openzeppelin/SafeERC20.sol";

import "./Fees.sol";
import "./PoolTokens.sol";
import "./UserBalance.sol";
import "./interfaces/IBasePool.sol";

/**
 * @dev Stores the Asset Managers (by Pool and token), and implements the top level Asset Manager and Pool interfaces,
 * such as registering and deregistering tokens, joining and exiting Pools, and informational functions like `getPool`
 * and `getPoolTokens`, delegating to specialization-specific functions as needed.
 *
 * `managePoolBalance` handles all Asset Manager interactions.
 */
abstract contract PoolBalances is Fees, ReentrancyGuard, PoolTokens, UserBalance {
    using Math for uint256;
    using SafeERC20 for IERC20;
    using BalanceAllocation for bytes32;
    using BalanceAllocation for bytes32[];

    function joinPool(
        bytes32 poolId,
        address sender,
        address recipient,
        JoinPoolRequest memory request
    ) external payable override whenNotPaused {
        // This function doesn't have the nonReentrant modifier: it is applied to `_joinOrExit` instead.

        // Note that `recipient` is not actually payable in the context of a join - we cast it because we handle both
        // joins and exits at once.
        _joinOrExit(PoolBalanceChangeKind.JOIN, poolId, sender, payable(recipient), _toPoolBalanceChange(request));
    }

    function exitPool(
        bytes32 poolId,
        address sender,
        address payable recipient,
        ExitPoolRequest memory request
    ) external override {
        // This function doesn't have the nonReentrant modifier: it is applied to `_joinOrExit` instead.
        _joinOrExit(PoolBalanceChangeKind.EXIT, poolId, sender, recipient, _toPoolBalanceChange(request));
    }

    // This has the exact same layout as JoinPoolRequest and ExitPoolRequest, except the `maxAmountsIn` and
    // `minAmountsOut` are called `limits`. Internally we use this struct for both since these two functions are quite
    // similar, but expose the others to callers for clarity.
    struct PoolBalanceChange {
        IAsset[] assets;
        uint256[] limits;
        bytes userData;
        bool useInternalBalance;
    }

    /**
     * @dev Converts a JoinPoolRequest into a PoolBalanceChange, with no runtime cost.
     */
    function _toPoolBalanceChange(JoinPoolRequest memory request)
        private
        pure
        returns (PoolBalanceChange memory change)
    {
        // solhint-disable-next-line no-inline-assembly
        assembly {
            change := request
        }
    }

    /**
     * @dev Converts an ExitPoolRequest into a PoolBalanceChange, with no runtime cost.
     */
    function _toPoolBalanceChange(ExitPoolRequest memory request)
        private
        pure
        returns (PoolBalanceChange memory change)
    {
        // solhint-disable-next-line no-inline-assembly
        assembly {
            change := request
        }
    }

    /**
     * @dev Implements both `joinPool` and `exitPool`, based on `kind`.
     */
    function _joinOrExit(
        PoolBalanceChangeKind kind,
        bytes32 poolId,
        address sender,
        address payable recipient,
        PoolBalanceChange memory change
    ) private nonReentrant withRegisteredPool(poolId) authenticateFor(sender) {
        // This function uses a large number of stack variables (poolId, sender and recipient, balances, amounts, fees,
        // etc.), which leads to 'stack too deep' issues. It relies on private functions with seemingly arbitrary
        // interfaces to work around this limitation.

        InputHelpers.ensureInputLengthMatch(change.assets.length, change.limits.length);

        // We first check that the caller passed the Pool's registered tokens in the correct order, and retrieve the
        // current balance for each.
        IERC20[] memory tokens = _translateToIERC20(change.assets);
        bytes32[] memory balances = _validateTokensAndGetBalances(poolId, tokens);

        // The bulk of the work is done here: the corresponding Pool hook is called, its final balances are computed,
        // assets are transferred, and fees are paid.
        (
            bytes32[] memory finalBalances,
            uint256[] memory amountsInOrOut,
            uint256[] memory paidProtocolSwapFeeAmounts
        ) = _callPoolBalanceChange(kind, poolId, sender, recipient, change, balances);

        // All that remains is storing the new Pool balances.
        PoolSpecialization specialization = _getPoolSpecialization(poolId);
        if (specialization == PoolSpecialization.TWO_TOKEN) {
            _setTwoTokenPoolCashBalances(poolId, tokens[0], finalBalances[0], tokens[1], finalBalances[1]);
        } else if (specialization == PoolSpecialization.MINIMAL_SWAP_INFO) {
            _setMinimalSwapInfoPoolBalances(poolId, tokens, finalBalances);
        } else {
            // PoolSpecialization.GENERAL
            _setGeneralPoolBalances(poolId, finalBalances);
        }

        bool positive = kind == PoolBalanceChangeKind.JOIN; // Amounts in are positive, out are negative
        emit PoolBalanceChanged(
            poolId,
            sender,
            tokens,
            // We can unsafely cast to int256 because balances are actually stored as uint112
            _unsafeCastToInt256(amountsInOrOut, positive),
            paidProtocolSwapFeeAmounts
        );
    }

    /**
     * @dev Calls the corresponding Pool hook to get the amounts in/out plus protocol fee amounts, and performs the
     * associated token transfers and fee payments, returning the Pool's final balances.
     */
    function _callPoolBalanceChange(
        PoolBalanceChangeKind kind,
        bytes32 poolId,
        address sender,
        address payable recipient,
        PoolBalanceChange memory change,
        bytes32[] memory balances
    )
        private
        returns (
            bytes32[] memory finalBalances,
            uint256[] memory amountsInOrOut,
            uint256[] memory dueProtocolFeeAmounts
        )
    {
        (uint256[] memory totalBalances, uint256 lastChangeBlock) = balances.totalsAndLastChangeBlock();

        IBasePool pool = IBasePool(_getPoolAddress(poolId));
        (amountsInOrOut, dueProtocolFeeAmounts) = kind == PoolBalanceChangeKind.JOIN
            ? pool.onJoinPool(
                poolId,
                sender,
                recipient,
                totalBalances,
                lastChangeBlock,
                _getProtocolSwapFeePercentage(),
                change.userData
            )
            : pool.onExitPool(
                poolId,
                sender,
                recipient,
                totalBalances,
                lastChangeBlock,
                _getProtocolSwapFeePercentage(),
                change.userData
            );

        InputHelpers.ensureInputLengthMatch(balances.length, amountsInOrOut.length, dueProtocolFeeAmounts.length);

        // The Vault ignores the `recipient` in joins and the `sender` in exits: it is up to the Pool to keep track of
        // their participation.
        finalBalances = kind == PoolBalanceChangeKind.JOIN
            ? _processJoinPoolTransfers(sender, change, balances, amountsInOrOut, dueProtocolFeeAmounts)
            : _processExitPoolTransfers(recipient, change, balances, amountsInOrOut, dueProtocolFeeAmounts);
    }

    /**
     * @dev Transfers `amountsIn` from `sender`, checking that they are within their accepted limits, and pays
     * accumulated protocol swap fees.
     *
     * Returns the Pool's final balances, which are the current balances plus `amountsIn` minus accumulated protocol
     * swap fees.
     */
    function _processJoinPoolTransfers(
        address sender,
        PoolBalanceChange memory change,
        bytes32[] memory balances,
        uint256[] memory amountsIn,
        uint256[] memory dueProtocolFeeAmounts
    ) private returns (bytes32[] memory finalBalances) {
        // We need to track how much of the received ETH was used and wrapped into WETH to return any excess.
        uint256 wrappedEth = 0;

        finalBalances = new bytes32[](balances.length);
        for (uint256 i = 0; i < change.assets.length; ++i) {
            uint256 amountIn = amountsIn[i];
            _require(amountIn <= change.limits[i], Errors.JOIN_ABOVE_MAX);

            // Receive assets from the sender - possibly from Internal Balance.
            IAsset asset = change.assets[i];
            _receiveAsset(asset, amountIn, sender, change.useInternalBalance);

            if (_isETH(asset)) {
                wrappedEth = wrappedEth.add(amountIn);
            }

            uint256 feeAmount = dueProtocolFeeAmounts[i];
            _payFeeAmount(_translateToIERC20(asset), feeAmount);

            // Compute the new Pool balances. Note that the fee amount might be larger than `amountIn`,
            // resulting in an overall decrease of the Pool's balance for a token.
            finalBalances[i] = (amountIn >= feeAmount) // This lets us skip checked arithmetic
                ? balances[i].increaseCash(amountIn - feeAmount)
                : balances[i].decreaseCash(feeAmount - amountIn);
        }

        // Handle any used and remaining ETH.
        _handleRemainingEth(wrappedEth);
    }

    /**
     * @dev Transfers `amountsOut` to `recipient`, checking that they are within their accepted limits, and pays
     * accumulated protocol swap fees from the Pool.
     *
     * Returns the Pool's final balances, which are the current `balances` minus `amountsOut` and fees paid
     * (`dueProtocolFeeAmounts`).
     */
    function _processExitPoolTransfers(
        address payable recipient,
        PoolBalanceChange memory change,
        bytes32[] memory balances,
        uint256[] memory amountsOut,
        uint256[] memory dueProtocolFeeAmounts
    ) private returns (bytes32[] memory finalBalances) {
        finalBalances = new bytes32[](balances.length);
        for (uint256 i = 0; i < change.assets.length; ++i) {
            uint256 amountOut = amountsOut[i];
            _require(amountOut >= change.limits[i], Errors.EXIT_BELOW_MIN);

            // Send tokens to the recipient - possibly to Internal Balance
            IAsset asset = change.assets[i];
            _sendAsset(asset, amountOut, recipient, change.useInternalBalance);

            uint256 feeAmount = dueProtocolFeeAmounts[i];
            _payFeeAmount(_translateToIERC20(asset), feeAmount);

            // Compute the new Pool balances. A Pool's token balance always decreases after an exit (potentially by 0).
            finalBalances[i] = balances[i].decreaseCash(amountOut.add(feeAmount));
        }
    }

    /**
     * @dev Returns the total balance for `poolId`'s `expectedTokens`.
     *
     * `expectedTokens` must exactly equal the token array returned by `getPoolTokens`: both arrays must have the same
     * length, elements and order. Additionally, the Pool must have at least one registered token.
     */
    function _validateTokensAndGetBalances(bytes32 poolId, IERC20[] memory expectedTokens)
        private
        view
        returns (bytes32[] memory)
    {
        (IERC20[] memory actualTokens, bytes32[] memory balances) = _getPoolTokens(poolId);
        InputHelpers.ensureInputLengthMatch(actualTokens.length, expectedTokens.length);
        _require(actualTokens.length > 0, Errors.POOL_NO_TOKENS);

        for (uint256 i = 0; i < actualTokens.length; ++i) {
            _require(actualTokens[i] == expectedTokens[i], Errors.TOKENS_MISMATCH);
        }

        return balances;
    }

    /**
     * @dev Casts an array of uint256 to int256, setting the sign of the result according to the `positive` flag,
     * without checking whether the values fit in the signed 256 bit range.
     */
    function _unsafeCastToInt256(uint256[] memory values, bool positive)
        private
        pure
        returns (int256[] memory signedValues)
    {
        signedValues = new int256[](values.length);
        for (uint256 i = 0; i < values.length; i++) {
            signedValues[i] = positive ? int256(values[i]) : -int256(values[i]);
        }
    }
}

File 27 of 86 : Fees.sol
// SPDX-License-Identifier: GPL-3.0-or-later
// This program is free software: you can redistribute it and/or modify
// it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
// the Free Software Foundation, either version 3 of the License, or
// (at your option) any later version.

// This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
// but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
// MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE.  See the
// GNU General Public License for more details.

// You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
// along with this program.  If not, see <http://www.gnu.org/licenses/>.

pragma solidity ^0.7.0;
pragma experimental ABIEncoderV2;

import "../lib/math/FixedPoint.sol";
import "../lib/helpers/BalancerErrors.sol";
import "../lib/openzeppelin/IERC20.sol";
import "../lib/openzeppelin/ReentrancyGuard.sol";
import "../lib/openzeppelin/SafeERC20.sol";

import "./ProtocolFeesCollector.sol";
import "./VaultAuthorization.sol";
import "./interfaces/IVault.sol";

/**
 * @dev To reduce the bytecode size of the Vault, most of the protocol fee logic is not here, but in the
 * ProtocolFeesCollector contract.
 */
abstract contract Fees is IVault {
    using SafeERC20 for IERC20;

    ProtocolFeesCollector private immutable _protocolFeesCollector;

    constructor() {
        _protocolFeesCollector = new ProtocolFeesCollector(IVault(this));
    }

    function getProtocolFeesCollector() public view override returns (ProtocolFeesCollector) {
        return _protocolFeesCollector;
    }

    /**
     * @dev Returns the protocol swap fee percentage.
     */
    function _getProtocolSwapFeePercentage() internal view returns (uint256) {
        return getProtocolFeesCollector().getSwapFeePercentage();
    }

    /**
     * @dev Returns the protocol fee amount to charge for a flash loan of `amount`.
     */
    function _calculateFlashLoanFeeAmount(uint256 amount) internal view returns (uint256) {
        // Fixed point multiplication introduces error: we round up, which means in certain scenarios the charged
        // percentage can be slightly higher than intended.
        uint256 percentage = getProtocolFeesCollector().getFlashLoanFeePercentage();
        return FixedPoint.mulUp(amount, percentage);
    }

    function _payFeeAmount(IERC20 token, uint256 amount) internal {
        if (amount > 0) {
            token.safeTransfer(address(getProtocolFeesCollector()), amount);
        }
    }
}

File 28 of 86 : PoolTokens.sol
// SPDX-License-Identifier: GPL-3.0-or-later
// This program is free software: you can redistribute it and/or modify
// it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
// the Free Software Foundation, either version 3 of the License, or
// (at your option) any later version.

// This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
// but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
// MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE.  See the
// GNU General Public License for more details.

// You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
// along with this program.  If not, see <http://www.gnu.org/licenses/>.

pragma solidity ^0.7.0;
pragma experimental ABIEncoderV2;

import "../lib/helpers/BalancerErrors.sol";
import "../lib/openzeppelin/ReentrancyGuard.sol";

import "./AssetManagers.sol";
import "./PoolRegistry.sol";
import "./balances/BalanceAllocation.sol";

abstract contract PoolTokens is ReentrancyGuard, PoolRegistry, AssetManagers {
    using BalanceAllocation for bytes32;
    using BalanceAllocation for bytes32[];

    function registerTokens(
        bytes32 poolId,
        IERC20[] memory tokens,
        address[] memory assetManagers
    ) external override nonReentrant whenNotPaused onlyPool(poolId) {
        InputHelpers.ensureInputLengthMatch(tokens.length, assetManagers.length);

        // Validates token addresses and assigns Asset Managers
        for (uint256 i = 0; i < tokens.length; ++i) {
            IERC20 token = tokens[i];
            _require(token != IERC20(0), Errors.INVALID_TOKEN);

            _poolAssetManagers[poolId][token] = assetManagers[i];
        }

        PoolSpecialization specialization = _getPoolSpecialization(poolId);
        if (specialization == PoolSpecialization.TWO_TOKEN) {
            _require(tokens.length == 2, Errors.TOKENS_LENGTH_MUST_BE_2);
            _registerTwoTokenPoolTokens(poolId, tokens[0], tokens[1]);
        } else if (specialization == PoolSpecialization.MINIMAL_SWAP_INFO) {
            _registerMinimalSwapInfoPoolTokens(poolId, tokens);
        } else {
            // PoolSpecialization.GENERAL
            _registerGeneralPoolTokens(poolId, tokens);
        }

        emit TokensRegistered(poolId, tokens, assetManagers);
    }

    function deregisterTokens(bytes32 poolId, IERC20[] memory tokens)
        external
        override
        nonReentrant
        whenNotPaused
        onlyPool(poolId)
    {
        PoolSpecialization specialization = _getPoolSpecialization(poolId);
        if (specialization == PoolSpecialization.TWO_TOKEN) {
            _require(tokens.length == 2, Errors.TOKENS_LENGTH_MUST_BE_2);
            _deregisterTwoTokenPoolTokens(poolId, tokens[0], tokens[1]);
        } else if (specialization == PoolSpecialization.MINIMAL_SWAP_INFO) {
            _deregisterMinimalSwapInfoPoolTokens(poolId, tokens);
        } else {
            // PoolSpecialization.GENERAL
            _deregisterGeneralPoolTokens(poolId, tokens);
        }

        // The deregister calls above ensure the total token balance is zero. Therefore it is now safe to remove any
        // associated Asset Managers, since they hold no Pool balance.
        for (uint256 i = 0; i < tokens.length; ++i) {
            delete _poolAssetManagers[poolId][tokens[i]];
        }

        emit TokensDeregistered(poolId, tokens);
    }

    function getPoolTokens(bytes32 poolId)
        external
        view
        override
        withRegisteredPool(poolId)
        returns (
            IERC20[] memory tokens,
            uint256[] memory balances,
            uint256 lastChangeBlock
        )
    {
        bytes32[] memory rawBalances;
        (tokens, rawBalances) = _getPoolTokens(poolId);
        (balances, lastChangeBlock) = rawBalances.totalsAndLastChangeBlock();
    }

    function getPoolTokenInfo(bytes32 poolId, IERC20 token)
        external
        view
        override
        withRegisteredPool(poolId)
        returns (
            uint256 cash,
            uint256 managed,
            uint256 lastChangeBlock,
            address assetManager
        )
    {
        bytes32 balance;
        PoolSpecialization specialization = _getPoolSpecialization(poolId);

        if (specialization == PoolSpecialization.TWO_TOKEN) {
            balance = _getTwoTokenPoolBalance(poolId, token);
        } else if (specialization == PoolSpecialization.MINIMAL_SWAP_INFO) {
            balance = _getMinimalSwapInfoPoolBalance(poolId, token);
        } else {
            // PoolSpecialization.GENERAL
            balance = _getGeneralPoolBalance(poolId, token);
        }

        cash = balance.cash();
        managed = balance.managed();
        lastChangeBlock = balance.lastChangeBlock();
        assetManager = _poolAssetManagers[poolId][token];
    }

    /**
     * @dev Returns all of `poolId`'s registered tokens, along with their raw balances.
     */
    function _getPoolTokens(bytes32 poolId) internal view returns (IERC20[] memory tokens, bytes32[] memory balances) {
        PoolSpecialization specialization = _getPoolSpecialization(poolId);
        if (specialization == PoolSpecialization.TWO_TOKEN) {
            return _getTwoTokenPoolTokens(poolId);
        } else if (specialization == PoolSpecialization.MINIMAL_SWAP_INFO) {
            return _getMinimalSwapInfoPoolTokens(poolId);
        } else {
            // PoolSpecialization.GENERAL
            return _getGeneralPoolTokens(poolId);
        }
    }
}

File 29 of 86 : IBasePool.sol
// SPDX-License-Identifier: GPL-3.0-or-later
// This program is free software: you can redistribute it and/or modify
// it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
// the Free Software Foundation, either version 3 of the License, or
// (at your option) any later version.

// This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
// but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
// MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE.  See the
// GNU General Public License for more details.

// You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
// along with this program.  If not, see <http://www.gnu.org/licenses/>.

pragma solidity ^0.7.0;
pragma experimental ABIEncoderV2;

import "./IVault.sol";
import "./IPoolSwapStructs.sol";

/**
 * @dev Interface for adding and removing liquidity that all Pool contracts should implement. Note that this is not
 * the complete Pool contract interface, as it is missing the swap hooks. Pool contracts should also inherit from
 * either IGeneralPool or IMinimalSwapInfoPool
 */
interface IBasePool is IPoolSwapStructs {
    /**
     * @dev Called by the Vault when a user calls `IVault.joinPool` to add liquidity to this Pool. Returns how many of
     * each registered token the user should provide, as well as the amount of protocol fees the Pool owes to the Vault.
     * The Vault will then take tokens from `sender` and add them to the Pool's balances, as well as collect
     * the reported amount in protocol fees, which the pool should calculate based on `protocolSwapFeePercentage`.
     *
     * Protocol fees are reported and charged on join events so that the Pool is free of debt whenever new users join.
     *
     * `sender` is the account performing the join (from which tokens will be withdrawn), and `recipient` is the account
     * designated to receive any benefits (typically pool shares). `currentBalances` contains the total balances
     * for each token the Pool registered in the Vault, in the same order that `IVault.getPoolTokens` would return.
     *
     * `lastChangeBlock` is the last block in which *any* of the Pool's registered tokens last changed its total
     * balance.
     *
     * `userData` contains any pool-specific instructions needed to perform the calculations, such as the type of
     * join (e.g., proportional given an amount of pool shares, single-asset, multi-asset, etc.)
     *
     * Contracts implementing this function should check that the caller is indeed the Vault before performing any
     * state-changing operations, such as minting pool shares.
     */
    function onJoinPool(
        bytes32 poolId,
        address sender,
        address recipient,
        uint256[] memory balances,
        uint256 lastChangeBlock,
        uint256 protocolSwapFeePercentage,
        bytes memory userData
    ) external returns (uint256[] memory amountsIn, uint256[] memory dueProtocolFeeAmounts);

    /**
     * @dev Called by the Vault when a user calls `IVault.exitPool` to remove liquidity from this Pool. Returns how many
     * tokens the Vault should deduct from the Pool's balances, as well as the amount of protocol fees the Pool owes
     * to the Vault. The Vault will then take tokens from the Pool's balances and send them to `recipient`,
     * as well as collect the reported amount in protocol fees, which the Pool should calculate based on
     * `protocolSwapFeePercentage`.
     *
     * Protocol fees are charged on exit events to guarantee that users exiting the Pool have paid their share.
     *
     * `sender` is the account performing the exit (typically the pool shareholder), and `recipient` is the account
     * to which the Vault will send the proceeds. `currentBalances` contains the total token balances for each token
     * the Pool registered in the Vault, in the same order that `IVault.getPoolTokens` would return.
     *
     * `lastChangeBlock` is the last block in which *any* of the Pool's registered tokens last changed its total
     * balance.
     *
     * `userData` contains any pool-specific instructions needed to perform the calculations, such as the type of
     * exit (e.g., proportional given an amount of pool shares, single-asset, multi-asset, etc.)
     *
     * Contracts implementing this function should check that the caller is indeed the Vault before performing any
     * state-changing operations, such as burning pool shares.
     */
    function onExitPool(
        bytes32 poolId,
        address sender,
        address recipient,
        uint256[] memory balances,
        uint256 lastChangeBlock,
        uint256 protocolSwapFeePercentage,
        bytes memory userData
    ) external returns (uint256[] memory amountsOut, uint256[] memory dueProtocolFeeAmounts);
}

File 30 of 86 : FixedPoint.sol
// SPDX-License-Identifier: GPL-3.0-or-later
// This program is free software: you can redistribute it and/or modify
// it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
// the Free Software Foundation, either version 3 of the License, or
// (at your option) any later version.

// This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
// but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
// MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE.  See the
// GNU General Public License for more details.

// You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
// along with this program.  If not, see <http://www.gnu.org/licenses/>.

pragma solidity ^0.7.0;

import "./LogExpMath.sol";
import "../helpers/BalancerErrors.sol";

/* solhint-disable private-vars-leading-underscore */

library FixedPoint {
    uint256 internal constant ONE = 1e18; // 18 decimal places
    uint256 internal constant MAX_POW_RELATIVE_ERROR = 10000; // 10^(-14)

    // Minimum base for the power function when the exponent is 'free' (larger than ONE).
    uint256 internal constant MIN_POW_BASE_FREE_EXPONENT = 0.7e18;

    function add(uint256 a, uint256 b) internal pure returns (uint256) {
        // Fixed Point addition is the same as regular checked addition

        uint256 c = a + b;
        _require(c >= a, Errors.ADD_OVERFLOW);
        return c;
    }

    function sub(uint256 a, uint256 b) internal pure returns (uint256) {
        // Fixed Point addition is the same as regular checked addition

        _require(b <= a, Errors.SUB_OVERFLOW);
        uint256 c = a - b;
        return c;
    }

    function mulDown(uint256 a, uint256 b) internal pure returns (uint256) {
        uint256 product = a * b;
        _require(a == 0 || product / a == b, Errors.MUL_OVERFLOW);

        return product / ONE;
    }

    function mulUp(uint256 a, uint256 b) internal pure returns (uint256) {
        uint256 product = a * b;
        _require(a == 0 || product / a == b, Errors.MUL_OVERFLOW);

        if (product == 0) {
            return 0;
        } else {
            // The traditional divUp formula is:
            // divUp(x, y) := (x + y - 1) / y
            // To avoid intermediate overflow in the addition, we distribute the division and get:
            // divUp(x, y) := (x - 1) / y + 1
            // Note that this requires x != 0, which we already tested for.

            return ((product - 1) / ONE) + 1;
        }
    }

    function divDown(uint256 a, uint256 b) internal pure returns (uint256) {
        _require(b != 0, Errors.ZERO_DIVISION);

        if (a == 0) {
            return 0;
        } else {
            uint256 aInflated = a * ONE;
            _require(aInflated / a == ONE, Errors.DIV_INTERNAL); // mul overflow

            return aInflated / b;
        }
    }

    function divUp(uint256 a, uint256 b) internal pure returns (uint256) {
        _require(b != 0, Errors.ZERO_DIVISION);

        if (a == 0) {
            return 0;
        } else {
            uint256 aInflated = a * ONE;
            _require(aInflated / a == ONE, Errors.DIV_INTERNAL); // mul overflow

            // The traditional divUp formula is:
            // divUp(x, y) := (x + y - 1) / y
            // To avoid intermediate overflow in the addition, we distribute the division and get:
            // divUp(x, y) := (x - 1) / y + 1
            // Note that this requires x != 0, which we already tested for.

            return ((aInflated - 1) / b) + 1;
        }
    }

    /**
     * @dev Returns x^y, assuming both are fixed point numbers, rounding down. The result is guaranteed to not be above
     * the true value (that is, the error function expected - actual is always positive).
     */
    function powDown(uint256 x, uint256 y) internal pure returns (uint256) {
        uint256 raw = LogExpMath.pow(x, y);
        uint256 maxError = add(mulUp(raw, MAX_POW_RELATIVE_ERROR), 1);

        if (raw < maxError) {
            return 0;
        } else {
            return sub(raw, maxError);
        }
    }

    /**
     * @dev Returns x^y, assuming both are fixed point numbers, rounding up. The result is guaranteed to not be below
     * the true value (that is, the error function expected - actual is always negative).
     */
    function powUp(uint256 x, uint256 y) internal pure returns (uint256) {
        uint256 raw = LogExpMath.pow(x, y);
        uint256 maxError = add(mulUp(raw, MAX_POW_RELATIVE_ERROR), 1);

        return add(raw, maxError);
    }

    /**
     * @dev Returns the complement of a value (1 - x), capped to 0 if x is larger than 1.
     *
     * Useful when computing the complement for values with some level of relative error, as it strips this error and
     * prevents intermediate negative values.
     */
    function complement(uint256 x) internal pure returns (uint256) {
        return (x < ONE) ? (ONE - x) : 0;
    }
}

File 31 of 86 : LogExpMath.sol
// SPDX-License-Identifier: GPL-3.0-or-later
// This program is free software: you can redistribute it and/or modify
// it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
// the Free Software Foundation, either version 3 of the License, or
// (at your option) any later version.

// This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
// but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
// MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE.  See the
// GNU General internal License for more details.

// You should have received a copy of the GNU General internal License
// along with this program.  If not, see <http://www.gnu.org/licenses/>.

pragma solidity ^0.7.0;

import "../helpers/BalancerErrors.sol";

/* solhint-disable */

/**
 * @dev Exponentiation and logarithm functions for 18 decimal fixed point numbers (both base and exponent/argument).
 *
 * Exponentiation and logarithm with arbitrary bases (x^y and log_x(y)) are implemented by conversion to natural
 * exponentiation and logarithm (where the base is Euler's number).
 *
 * @author Fernando Martinelli - @fernandomartinelli
 * @author Sergio Yuhjtman - @sergioyuhjtman
 * @author Daniel Fernandez - @dmf7z
 */
library LogExpMath {
    // All fixed point multiplications and divisions are inlined. This means we need to divide by ONE when multiplying
    // two numbers, and multiply by ONE when dividing them.

    // All arguments and return values are 18 decimal fixed point numbers.
    int256 constant ONE_18 = 1e18;

    // Internally, intermediate values are computed with higher precision as 20 decimal fixed point numbers, and in the
    // case of ln36, 36 decimals.
    int256 constant ONE_20 = 1e20;
    int256 constant ONE_36 = 1e36;

    // The domain of natural exponentiation is bound by the word size and number of decimals used.
    //
    // Because internally the result will be stored using 20 decimals, the largest possible result is
    // (2^255 - 1) / 10^20, which makes the largest exponent ln((2^255 - 1) / 10^20) = 130.700829182905140221.
    // The smallest possible result is 10^(-18), which makes largest negative argument
    // ln(10^(-18)) = -41.446531673892822312.
    // We use 130.0 and -41.0 to have some safety margin.
    int256 constant MAX_NATURAL_EXPONENT = 130e18;
    int256 constant MIN_NATURAL_EXPONENT = -41e18;

    // Bounds for ln_36's argument. Both ln(0.9) and ln(1.1) can be represented with 36 decimal places in a fixed point
    // 256 bit integer.
    int256 constant LN_36_LOWER_BOUND = ONE_18 - 1e17;
    int256 constant LN_36_UPPER_BOUND = ONE_18 + 1e17;

    uint256 constant MILD_EXPONENT_BOUND = 2**254 / uint256(ONE_20);

    // 18 decimal constants
    int256 constant x0 = 128000000000000000000; // 2ˆ7
    int256 constant a0 = 38877084059945950922200000000000000000000000000000000000; // eˆ(x0) (no decimals)
    int256 constant x1 = 64000000000000000000; // 2ˆ6
    int256 constant a1 = 6235149080811616882910000000; // eˆ(x1) (no decimals)

    // 20 decimal constants
    int256 constant x2 = 3200000000000000000000; // 2ˆ5
    int256 constant a2 = 7896296018268069516100000000000000; // eˆ(x2)
    int256 constant x3 = 1600000000000000000000; // 2ˆ4
    int256 constant a3 = 888611052050787263676000000; // eˆ(x3)
    int256 constant x4 = 800000000000000000000; // 2ˆ3
    int256 constant a4 = 298095798704172827474000; // eˆ(x4)
    int256 constant x5 = 400000000000000000000; // 2ˆ2
    int256 constant a5 = 5459815003314423907810; // eˆ(x5)
    int256 constant x6 = 200000000000000000000; // 2ˆ1
    int256 constant a6 = 738905609893065022723; // eˆ(x6)
    int256 constant x7 = 100000000000000000000; // 2ˆ0
    int256 constant a7 = 271828182845904523536; // eˆ(x7)
    int256 constant x8 = 50000000000000000000; // 2ˆ-1
    int256 constant a8 = 164872127070012814685; // eˆ(x8)
    int256 constant x9 = 25000000000000000000; // 2ˆ-2
    int256 constant a9 = 128402541668774148407; // eˆ(x9)
    int256 constant x10 = 12500000000000000000; // 2ˆ-3
    int256 constant a10 = 113314845306682631683; // eˆ(x10)
    int256 constant x11 = 6250000000000000000; // 2ˆ-4
    int256 constant a11 = 106449445891785942956; // eˆ(x11)

    /**
     * @dev Exponentiation (x^y) with unsigned 18 decimal fixed point base and exponent.
     *
     * Reverts if ln(x) * y is smaller than `MIN_NATURAL_EXPONENT`, or larger than `MAX_NATURAL_EXPONENT`.
     */
    function pow(uint256 x, uint256 y) internal pure returns (uint256) {
        if (y == 0) {
            // We solve the 0^0 indetermination by making it equal one.
            return uint256(ONE_18);
        }

        if (x == 0) {
            return 0;
        }

        // Instead of computing x^y directly, we instead rely on the properties of logarithms and exponentiation to
        // arrive at that result. In particular, exp(ln(x)) = x, and ln(x^y) = y * ln(x). This means
        // x^y = exp(y * ln(x)).

        // The ln function takes a signed value, so we need to make sure x fits in the signed 256 bit range.
        _require(x < 2**255, Errors.X_OUT_OF_BOUNDS);
        int256 x_int256 = int256(x);

        // We will compute y * ln(x) in a single step. Depending on the value of x, we can either use ln or ln_36. In
        // both cases, we leave the division by ONE_18 (due to fixed point multiplication) to the end.

        // This prevents y * ln(x) from overflowing, and at the same time guarantees y fits in the signed 256 bit range.
        _require(y < MILD_EXPONENT_BOUND, Errors.Y_OUT_OF_BOUNDS);
        int256 y_int256 = int256(y);

        int256 logx_times_y;
        if (LN_36_LOWER_BOUND < x_int256 && x_int256 < LN_36_UPPER_BOUND) {
            int256 ln_36_x = ln_36(x_int256);

            // ln_36_x has 36 decimal places, so multiplying by y_int256 isn't as straightforward, since we can't just
            // bring y_int256 to 36 decimal places, as it might overflow. Instead, we perform two 18 decimal
            // multiplications and add the results: one with the first 18 decimals of ln_36_x, and one with the
            // (downscaled) last 18 decimals.
            logx_times_y = ((ln_36_x / ONE_18) * y_int256 + ((ln_36_x % ONE_18) * y_int256) / ONE_18);
        } else {
            logx_times_y = ln(x_int256) * y_int256;
        }
        logx_times_y /= ONE_18;

        // Finally, we compute exp(y * ln(x)) to arrive at x^y
        _require(
            MIN_NATURAL_EXPONENT <= logx_times_y && logx_times_y <= MAX_NATURAL_EXPONENT,
            Errors.PRODUCT_OUT_OF_BOUNDS
        );

        return uint256(exp(logx_times_y));
    }

    /**
     * @dev Natural exponentiation (e^x) with signed 18 decimal fixed point exponent.
     *
     * Reverts if `x` is smaller than MIN_NATURAL_EXPONENT, or larger than `MAX_NATURAL_EXPONENT`.
     */
    function exp(int256 x) internal pure returns (int256) {
        _require(x >= MIN_NATURAL_EXPONENT && x <= MAX_NATURAL_EXPONENT, Errors.INVALID_EXPONENT);

        if (x < 0) {
            // We only handle positive exponents: e^(-x) is computed as 1 / e^x. We can safely make x positive since it
            // fits in the signed 256 bit range (as it is larger than MIN_NATURAL_EXPONENT).
            // Fixed point division requires multiplying by ONE_18.
            return ((ONE_18 * ONE_18) / exp(-x));
        }

        // First, we use the fact that e^(x+y) = e^x * e^y to decompose x into a sum of powers of two, which we call x_n,
        // where x_n == 2^(7 - n), and e^x_n = a_n has been precomputed. We choose the first x_n, x0, to equal 2^7
        // because all larger powers are larger than MAX_NATURAL_EXPONENT, and therefore not present in the
        // decomposition.
        // At the end of this process we will have the product of all e^x_n = a_n that apply, and the remainder of this
        // decomposition, which will be lower than the smallest x_n.
        // exp(x) = k_0 * a_0 * k_1 * a_1 * ... + k_n * a_n * exp(remainder), where each k_n equals either 0 or 1.
        // We mutate x by subtracting x_n, making it the remainder of the decomposition.

        // The first two a_n (e^(2^7) and e^(2^6)) are too large if stored as 18 decimal numbers, and could cause
        // intermediate overflows. Instead we store them as plain integers, with 0 decimals.
        // Additionally, x0 + x1 is larger than MAX_NATURAL_EXPONENT, which means they will not both be present in the
        // decomposition.

        // For each x_n, we test if that term is present in the decomposition (if x is larger than it), and if so deduct
        // it and compute the accumulated product.

        int256 firstAN;
        if (x >= x0) {
            x -= x0;
            firstAN = a0;
        } else if (x >= x1) {
            x -= x1;
            firstAN = a1;
        } else {
            firstAN = 1; // One with no decimal places
        }

        // We now transform x into a 20 decimal fixed point number, to have enhanced precision when computing the
        // smaller terms.
        x *= 100;

        // `product` is the accumulated product of all a_n (except a0 and a1), which starts at 20 decimal fixed point
        // one. Recall that fixed point multiplication requires dividing by ONE_20.
        int256 product = ONE_20;

        if (x >= x2) {
            x -= x2;
            product = (product * a2) / ONE_20;
        }
        if (x >= x3) {
            x -= x3;
            product = (product * a3) / ONE_20;
        }
        if (x >= x4) {
            x -= x4;
            product = (product * a4) / ONE_20;
        }
        if (x >= x5) {
            x -= x5;
            product = (product * a5) / ONE_20;
        }
        if (x >= x6) {
            x -= x6;
            product = (product * a6) / ONE_20;
        }
        if (x >= x7) {
            x -= x7;
            product = (product * a7) / ONE_20;
        }
        if (x >= x8) {
            x -= x8;
            product = (product * a8) / ONE_20;
        }
        if (x >= x9) {
            x -= x9;
            product = (product * a9) / ONE_20;
        }

        // x10 and x11 are unnecessary here since we have high enough precision already.

        // Now we need to compute e^x, where x is small (in particular, it is smaller than x9). We use the Taylor series
        // expansion for e^x: 1 + x + (x^2 / 2!) + (x^3 / 3!) + ... + (x^n / n!).

        int256 seriesSum = ONE_20; // The initial one in the sum, with 20 decimal places.
        int256 term; // Each term in the sum, where the nth term is (x^n / n!).

        // The first term is simply x.
        term = x;
        seriesSum += term;

        // Each term (x^n / n!) equals the previous one times x, divided by n. Since x is a fixed point number,
        // multiplying by it requires dividing by ONE_20, but dividing by the non-fixed point n values does not.

        term = ((term * x) / ONE_20) / 2;
        seriesSum += term;

        term = ((term * x) / ONE_20) / 3;
        seriesSum += term;

        term = ((term * x) / ONE_20) / 4;
        seriesSum += term;

        term = ((term * x) / ONE_20) / 5;
        seriesSum += term;

        term = ((term * x) / ONE_20) / 6;
        seriesSum += term;

        term = ((term * x) / ONE_20) / 7;
        seriesSum += term;

        term = ((term * x) / ONE_20) / 8;
        seriesSum += term;

        term = ((term * x) / ONE_20) / 9;
        seriesSum += term;

        term = ((term * x) / ONE_20) / 10;
        seriesSum += term;

        term = ((term * x) / ONE_20) / 11;
        seriesSum += term;

        term = ((term * x) / ONE_20) / 12;
        seriesSum += term;

        // 12 Taylor terms are sufficient for 18 decimal precision.

        // We now have the first a_n (with no decimals), and the product of all other a_n present, and the Taylor
        // approximation of the exponentiation of the remainder (both with 20 decimals). All that remains is to multiply
        // all three (one 20 decimal fixed point multiplication, dividing by ONE_20, and one integer multiplication),
        // and then drop two digits to return an 18 decimal value.

        return (((product * seriesSum) / ONE_20) * firstAN) / 100;
    }

    /**
     * @dev Natural logarithm (ln(a)) with signed 18 decimal fixed point argument.
     */
    function ln(int256 a) internal pure returns (int256) {
        // The real natural logarithm is not defined for negative numbers or zero.
        _require(a > 0, Errors.OUT_OF_BOUNDS);

        if (a < ONE_18) {
            // Since ln(a^k) = k * ln(a), we can compute ln(a) as ln(a) = ln((1/a)^(-1)) = - ln((1/a)). If a is less
            // than one, 1/a will be greater than one, and this if statement will not be entered in the recursive call.
            // Fixed point division requires multiplying by ONE_18.
            return (-ln((ONE_18 * ONE_18) / a));
        }

        // First, we use the fact that ln^(a * b) = ln(a) + ln(b) to decompose ln(a) into a sum of powers of two, which
        // we call x_n, where x_n == 2^(7 - n), which are the natural logarithm of precomputed quantities a_n (that is,
        // ln(a_n) = x_n). We choose the first x_n, x0, to equal 2^7 because the exponential of all larger powers cannot
        // be represented as 18 fixed point decimal numbers in 256 bits, and are therefore larger than a.
        // At the end of this process we will have the sum of all x_n = ln(a_n) that apply, and the remainder of this
        // decomposition, which will be lower than the smallest a_n.
        // ln(a) = k_0 * x_0 + k_1 * x_1 + ... + k_n * x_n + ln(remainder), where each k_n equals either 0 or 1.
        // We mutate a by subtracting a_n, making it the remainder of the decomposition.

        // For reasons related to how `exp` works, the first two a_n (e^(2^7) and e^(2^6)) are not stored as fixed point
        // numbers with 18 decimals, but instead as plain integers with 0 decimals, so we need to multiply them by
        // ONE_18 to convert them to fixed point.
        // For each a_n, we test if that term is present in the decomposition (if a is larger than it), and if so divide
        // by it and compute the accumulated sum.

        int256 sum = 0;
        if (a >= a0 * ONE_18) {
            a /= a0; // Integer, not fixed point division
            sum += x0;
        }

        if (a >= a1 * ONE_18) {
            a /= a1; // Integer, not fixed point division
            sum += x1;
        }

        // All other a_n and x_n are stored as 20 digit fixed point numbers, so we convert the sum and a to this format.
        sum *= 100;
        a *= 100;

        // Because further a_n are  20 digit fixed point numbers, we multiply by ONE_20 when dividing by them.

        if (a >= a2) {
            a = (a * ONE_20) / a2;
            sum += x2;
        }

        if (a >= a3) {
            a = (a * ONE_20) / a3;
            sum += x3;
        }

        if (a >= a4) {
            a = (a * ONE_20) / a4;
            sum += x4;
        }

        if (a >= a5) {
            a = (a * ONE_20) / a5;
            sum += x5;
        }

        if (a >= a6) {
            a = (a * ONE_20) / a6;
            sum += x6;
        }

        if (a >= a7) {
            a = (a * ONE_20) / a7;
            sum += x7;
        }

        if (a >= a8) {
            a = (a * ONE_20) / a8;
            sum += x8;
        }

        if (a >= a9) {
            a = (a * ONE_20) / a9;
            sum += x9;
        }

        if (a >= a10) {
            a = (a * ONE_20) / a10;
            sum += x10;
        }

        if (a >= a11) {
            a = (a * ONE_20) / a11;
            sum += x11;
        }

        // a is now a small number (smaller than a_11, which roughly equals 1.06). This means we can use a Taylor series
        // that converges rapidly for values of `a` close to one - the same one used in ln_36.
        // Let z = (a - 1) / (a + 1).
        // ln(a) = 2 * (z + z^3 / 3 + z^5 / 5 + z^7 / 7 + ... + z^(2 * n + 1) / (2 * n + 1))

        // Recall that 20 digit fixed point division requires multiplying by ONE_20, and multiplication requires
        // division by ONE_20.
        int256 z = ((a - ONE_20) * ONE_20) / (a + ONE_20);
        int256 z_squared = (z * z) / ONE_20;

        // num is the numerator of the series: the z^(2 * n + 1) term
        int256 num = z;

        // seriesSum holds the accumulated sum of each term in the series, starting with the initial z
        int256 seriesSum = num;

        // In each step, the numerator is multiplied by z^2
        num = (num * z_squared) / ONE_20;
        seriesSum += num / 3;

        num = (num * z_squared) / ONE_20;
        seriesSum += num / 5;

        num = (num * z_squared) / ONE_20;
        seriesSum += num / 7;

        num = (num * z_squared) / ONE_20;
        seriesSum += num / 9;

        num = (num * z_squared) / ONE_20;
        seriesSum += num / 11;

        // 6 Taylor terms are sufficient for 36 decimal precision.

        // Finally, we multiply by 2 (non fixed point) to compute ln(remainder)
        seriesSum *= 2;

        // We now have the sum of all x_n present, and the Taylor approximation of the logarithm of the remainder (both
        // with 20 decimals). All that remains is to sum these two, and then drop two digits to return a 18 decimal
        // value.

        return (sum + seriesSum) / 100;
    }

    /**
     * @dev Logarithm (log(arg, base), with signed 18 decimal fixed point base and argument argument.
     */
    function log(int256 arg, int256 base) internal pure returns (int256) {
        // This performs a simple base change: log(arg, base) = ln(arg) / ln(base).

        // Both logBase and logArg are computed as 36 decimal fixed point numbers, either by using ln_36, or by
        // upscaling.

        int256 logBase;
        if (LN_36_LOWER_BOUND < base && base < LN_36_UPPER_BOUND) {
            logBase = ln_36(base);
        } else {
            logBase = ln(base) * ONE_18;
        }

        int256 logArg;
        if (LN_36_LOWER_BOUND < arg && arg < LN_36_UPPER_BOUND) {
            logArg = ln_36(arg);
        } else {
            logArg = ln(arg) * ONE_18;
        }

        // When dividing, we multiply by ONE_18 to arrive at a result with 18 decimal places
        return (logArg * ONE_18) / logBase;
    }

    /**
     * @dev High precision (36 decimal places) natural logarithm (ln(x)) with signed 18 decimal fixed point argument,
     * for x close to one.
     *
     * Should only be used if x is between LN_36_LOWER_BOUND and LN_36_UPPER_BOUND.
     */
    function ln_36(int256 x) private pure returns (int256) {
        // Since ln(1) = 0, a value of x close to one will yield a very small result, which makes using 36 digits
        // worthwhile.

        // First, we transform x to a 36 digit fixed point value.
        x *= ONE_18;

        // We will use the following Taylor expansion, which converges very rapidly. Let z = (x - 1) / (x + 1).
        // ln(x) = 2 * (z + z^3 / 3 + z^5 / 5 + z^7 / 7 + ... + z^(2 * n + 1) / (2 * n + 1))

        // Recall that 36 digit fixed point division requires multiplying by ONE_36, and multiplication requires
        // division by ONE_36.
        int256 z = ((x - ONE_36) * ONE_36) / (x + ONE_36);
        int256 z_squared = (z * z) / ONE_36;

        // num is the numerator of the series: the z^(2 * n + 1) term
        int256 num = z;

        // seriesSum holds the accumulated sum of each term in the series, starting with the initial z
        int256 seriesSum = num;

        // In each step, the numerator is multiplied by z^2
        num = (num * z_squared) / ONE_36;
        seriesSum += num / 3;

        num = (num * z_squared) / ONE_36;
        seriesSum += num / 5;

        num = (num * z_squared) / ONE_36;
        seriesSum += num / 7;

        num = (num * z_squared) / ONE_36;
        seriesSum += num / 9;

        num = (num * z_squared) / ONE_36;
        seriesSum += num / 11;

        num = (num * z_squared) / ONE_36;
        seriesSum += num / 13;

        num = (num * z_squared) / ONE_36;
        seriesSum += num / 15;

        // 8 Taylor terms are sufficient for 36 decimal precision.

        // All that remains is multiplying by 2 (non fixed point).
        return seriesSum * 2;
    }
}

File 32 of 86 : AssetManagers.sol
// SPDX-License-Identifier: GPL-3.0-or-later
// This program is free software: you can redistribute it and/or modify
// it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
// the Free Software Foundation, either version 3 of the License, or
// (at your option) any later version.

// This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
// but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
// MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE.  See the
// GNU General Public License for more details.

// You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
// along with this program.  If not, see <http://www.gnu.org/licenses/>.

pragma solidity ^0.7.0;
pragma experimental ABIEncoderV2;

import "../lib/math/Math.sol";
import "../lib/helpers/BalancerErrors.sol";
import "../lib/helpers/InputHelpers.sol";
import "../lib/openzeppelin/IERC20.sol";
import "../lib/openzeppelin/SafeERC20.sol";
import "../lib/openzeppelin/ReentrancyGuard.sol";

import "./UserBalance.sol";
import "./balances/BalanceAllocation.sol";
import "./balances/GeneralPoolsBalance.sol";
import "./balances/MinimalSwapInfoPoolsBalance.sol";
import "./balances/TwoTokenPoolsBalance.sol";

abstract contract AssetManagers is
    ReentrancyGuard,
    GeneralPoolsBalance,
    MinimalSwapInfoPoolsBalance,
    TwoTokenPoolsBalance
{
    using Math for uint256;
    using SafeERC20 for IERC20;

    // Stores the Asset Manager for each token of each Pool.
    mapping(bytes32 => mapping(IERC20 => address)) internal _poolAssetManagers;

    function managePoolBalance(PoolBalanceOp[] memory ops) external override nonReentrant whenNotPaused {
        // This variable could be declared inside the loop, but that causes the compiler to allocate memory on each
        // loop iteration, increasing gas costs.
        PoolBalanceOp memory op;

        for (uint256 i = 0; i < ops.length; ++i) {
            // By indexing the array only once, we don't spend extra gas in the same bounds check.
            op = ops[i];

            bytes32 poolId = op.poolId;
            _ensureRegisteredPool(poolId);

            IERC20 token = op.token;
            _require(_isTokenRegistered(poolId, token), Errors.TOKEN_NOT_REGISTERED);
            _require(_poolAssetManagers[poolId][token] == msg.sender, Errors.SENDER_NOT_ASSET_MANAGER);

            PoolBalanceOpKind kind = op.kind;
            uint256 amount = op.amount;
            (int256 cashDelta, int256 managedDelta) = _performPoolManagementOperation(kind, poolId, token, amount);

            emit PoolBalanceManaged(poolId, msg.sender, token, cashDelta, managedDelta);
        }
    }

    /**
     * @dev Performs the `kind` Asset Manager operation on a Pool.
     *
     * Withdrawals will transfer `amount` tokens to the caller, deposits will transfer `amount` tokens from the caller,
     * and updates will set the managed balance to `amount`.
     *
     * Returns a tuple with the 'cash' and 'managed' balance deltas as a result of this call.
     */
    function _performPoolManagementOperation(
        PoolBalanceOpKind kind,
        bytes32 poolId,
        IERC20 token,
        uint256 amount
    ) private returns (int256, int256) {
        PoolSpecialization specialization = _getPoolSpecialization(poolId);

        if (kind == PoolBalanceOpKind.WITHDRAW) {
            return _withdrawPoolBalance(poolId, specialization, token, amount);
        } else if (kind == PoolBalanceOpKind.DEPOSIT) {
            return _depositPoolBalance(poolId, specialization, token, amount);
        } else {
            // PoolBalanceOpKind.UPDATE
            return _updateManagedBalance(poolId, specialization, token, amount);
        }
    }

    /**
     * @dev Moves `amount` tokens from a Pool's 'cash' to 'managed' balance, and transfers them to the caller.
     *
     * Returns the 'cash' and 'managed' balance deltas as a result of this call, which will be complementary.
     */
    function _withdrawPoolBalance(
        bytes32 poolId,
        PoolSpecialization specialization,
        IERC20 token,
        uint256 amount
    ) private returns (int256 cashDelta, int256 managedDelta) {
        if (specialization == PoolSpecialization.TWO_TOKEN) {
            _twoTokenPoolCashToManaged(poolId, token, amount);
        } else if (specialization == PoolSpecialization.MINIMAL_SWAP_INFO) {
            _minimalSwapInfoPoolCashToManaged(poolId, token, amount);
        } else {
            // PoolSpecialization.GENERAL
            _generalPoolCashToManaged(poolId, token, amount);
        }

        if (amount > 0) {
            token.safeTransfer(msg.sender, amount);
        }

        // Since 'cash' and 'managed' are stored as uint112, `amount` is guaranteed to also fit in 112 bits. It will
        // therefore always fit in a 256 bit integer.
        cashDelta = int256(-amount);
        managedDelta = int256(amount);
    }

    /**
     * @dev Moves `amount` tokens from a Pool's 'managed' to 'cash' balance, and transfers them from the caller.
     *
     * Returns the 'cash' and 'managed' balance deltas as a result of this call, which will be complementary.
     */
    function _depositPoolBalance(
        bytes32 poolId,
        PoolSpecialization specialization,
        IERC20 token,
        uint256 amount
    ) private returns (int256 cashDelta, int256 managedDelta) {
        if (specialization == PoolSpecialization.TWO_TOKEN) {
            _twoTokenPoolManagedToCash(poolId, token, amount);
        } else if (specialization == PoolSpecialization.MINIMAL_SWAP_INFO) {
            _minimalSwapInfoPoolManagedToCash(poolId, token, amount);
        } else {
            // PoolSpecialization.GENERAL
            _generalPoolManagedToCash(poolId, token, amount);
        }

        if (amount > 0) {
            token.safeTransferFrom(msg.sender, address(this), amount);
        }

        // Since 'cash' and 'managed' are stored as uint112, `amount` is guaranteed to also fit in 112 bits. It will
        // therefore always fit in a 256 bit integer.
        cashDelta = int256(amount);
        managedDelta = int256(-amount);
    }

    /**
     * @dev Sets a Pool's 'managed' balance to `amount`.
     *
     * Returns the 'cash' and 'managed' balance deltas as a result of this call (the 'cash' delta will always be zero).
     */
    function _updateManagedBalance(
        bytes32 poolId,
        PoolSpecialization specialization,
        IERC20 token,
        uint256 amount
    ) private returns (int256 cashDelta, int256 managedDelta) {
        if (specialization == PoolSpecialization.TWO_TOKEN) {
            managedDelta = _setTwoTokenPoolManagedBalance(poolId, token, amount);
        } else if (specialization == PoolSpecialization.MINIMAL_SWAP_INFO) {
            managedDelta = _setMinimalSwapInfoPoolManagedBalance(poolId, token, amount);
        } else {
            // PoolSpecialization.GENERAL
            managedDelta = _setGeneralPoolManagedBalance(poolId, token, amount);
        }

        cashDelta = 0;
    }

    /**
     * @dev Returns true if `token` is registered for `poolId`.
     */
    function _isTokenRegistered(bytes32 poolId, IERC20 token) private view returns (bool) {
        PoolSpecialization specialization = _getPoolSpecialization(poolId);
        if (specialization == PoolSpecialization.TWO_TOKEN) {
            return _isTwoTokenPoolTokenRegistered(poolId, token);
        } else if (specialization == PoolSpecialization.MINIMAL_SWAP_INFO) {
            return _isMinimalSwapInfoPoolTokenRegistered(poolId, token);
        } else {
            // PoolSpecialization.GENERAL
            return _isGeneralPoolTokenRegistered(poolId, token);
        }
    }
}

File 33 of 86 : PoolRegistry.sol
// SPDX-License-Identifier: GPL-3.0-or-later
// This program is free software: you can redistribute it and/or modify
// it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
// the Free Software Foundation, either version 3 of the License, or
// (at your option) any later version.

// This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
// but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
// MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE.  See the
// GNU General Public License for more details.

// You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
// along with this program.  If not, see <http://www.gnu.org/licenses/>.

pragma solidity ^0.7.0;
pragma experimental ABIEncoderV2;

import "../lib/helpers/BalancerErrors.sol";
import "../lib/openzeppelin/ReentrancyGuard.sol";

import "./VaultAuthorization.sol";

/**
 * @dev Maintains the Pool ID data structure, implements Pool ID creation and registration, and defines useful modifiers
 * and helper functions for ensuring correct behavior when working with Pools.
 */
abstract contract PoolRegistry is ReentrancyGuard, VaultAuthorization {
    // Each pool is represented by their unique Pool ID. We use `bytes32` for them, for lack of a way to define new
    // types.
    mapping(bytes32 => bool) private _isPoolRegistered;

    // We keep an increasing nonce to make Pool IDs unique. It is interpreted as a `uint80`, but storing it as a
    // `uint256` results in reduced bytecode on reads and writes due to the lack of masking.
    uint256 private _nextPoolNonce;

    /**
     * @dev Reverts unless `poolId` corresponds to a registered Pool.
     */
    modifier withRegisteredPool(bytes32 poolId) {
        _ensureRegisteredPool(poolId);
        _;
    }

    /**
     * @dev Reverts unless `poolId` corresponds to a registered Pool, and the caller is the Pool's contract.
     */
    modifier onlyPool(bytes32 poolId) {
        _ensurePoolIsSender(poolId);
        _;
    }

    /**
     * @dev Reverts unless `poolId` corresponds to a registered Pool.
     */
    function _ensureRegisteredPool(bytes32 poolId) internal view {
        _require(_isPoolRegistered[poolId], Errors.INVALID_POOL_ID);
    }

    /**
     * @dev Reverts unless `poolId` corresponds to a registered Pool, and the caller is the Pool's contract.
     */
    function _ensurePoolIsSender(bytes32 poolId) private view {
        _ensureRegisteredPool(poolId);
        _require(msg.sender == _getPoolAddress(poolId), Errors.CALLER_NOT_POOL);
    }

    function registerPool(PoolSpecialization specialization)
        external
        override
        nonReentrant
        whenNotPaused
        returns (bytes32)
    {
        // Each Pool is assigned a unique ID based on an incrementing nonce. This assumes there will never be more than
        // 2**80 Pools, and the nonce will not overflow.

        bytes32 poolId = _toPoolId(msg.sender, specialization, uint80(_nextPoolNonce));

        _require(!_isPoolRegistered[poolId], Errors.INVALID_POOL_ID); // Should never happen as Pool IDs are unique.
        _isPoolRegistered[poolId] = true;

        _nextPoolNonce += 1;

        // Note that msg.sender is the pool's contract
        emit PoolRegistered(poolId, msg.sender, specialization);
        return poolId;
    }

    function getPool(bytes32 poolId)
        external
        view
        override
        withRegisteredPool(poolId)
        returns (address, PoolSpecialization)
    {
        return (_getPoolAddress(poolId), _getPoolSpecialization(poolId));
    }

    /**
     * @dev Creates a Pool ID.
     *
     * These are deterministically created by packing the Pool's contract address and its specialization setting into
     * the ID. This saves gas by making this data easily retrievable from a Pool ID with no storage accesses.
     *
     * Since a single contract can register multiple Pools, a unique nonce must be provided to ensure Pool IDs are
     * unique.
     *
     * Pool IDs have the following layout:
     * | 20 bytes pool contract address | 2 bytes specialization setting | 10 bytes nonce |
     * MSB                                                                              LSB
     *
     * 2 bytes for the specialization setting is a bit overkill: there only three of them, which means two bits would
     * suffice. However, there's nothing else of interest to store in this extra space.
     */
    function _toPoolId(
        address pool,
        PoolSpecialization specialization,
        uint80 nonce
    ) internal pure returns (bytes32) {
        bytes32 serialized;

        serialized |= bytes32(uint256(nonce));
        serialized |= bytes32(uint256(specialization)) << (10 * 8);
        serialized |= bytes32(uint256(pool)) << (12 * 8);

        return serialized;
    }

    /**
     * @dev Returns the address of a Pool's contract.
     *
     * Due to how Pool IDs are created, this is done with no storage accesses and costs little gas.
     */
    function _getPoolAddress(bytes32 poolId) internal pure returns (address) {
        // 12 byte logical shift left to remove the nonce and specialization setting. We don't need to mask,
        // since the logical shift already sets the upper bits to zero.
        return address(uint256(poolId) >> (12 * 8));
    }

    /**
     * @dev Returns the specialization setting of a Pool.
     *
     * Due to how Pool IDs are created, this is done with no storage accesses and costs little gas.
     */
    function _getPoolSpecialization(bytes32 poolId) internal pure returns (PoolSpecialization specialization) {
        // 10 byte logical shift left to remove the nonce, followed by a 2 byte mask to remove the address.
        uint256 value = uint256(poolId >> (10 * 8)) & (2**(2 * 8) - 1);

        // Casting a value into an enum results in a runtime check that reverts unless the value is within the enum's
        // range. Passing an invalid Pool ID to this function would then result in an obscure revert with no reason
        // string: we instead perform the check ourselves to help in error diagnosis.

        // There are three Pool specialization settings: general, minimal swap info and two tokens, which correspond to
        // values 0, 1 and 2.
        _require(value < 3, Errors.INVALID_POOL_ID);

        // Because we have checked that `value` is within the enum range, we can use assembly to skip the runtime check.
        // solhint-disable-next-line no-inline-assembly
        assembly {
            specialization := value
        }
    }
}

File 34 of 86 : BalanceAllocation.sol
// SPDX-License-Identifier: GPL-3.0-or-later
// This program is free software: you can redistribute it and/or modify
// it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
// the Free Software Foundation, either version 3 of the License, or
// (at your option) any later version.

// This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
// but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
// MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE.  See the
// GNU General Public License for more details.

// You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
// along with this program.  If not, see <http://www.gnu.org/licenses/>.

pragma solidity ^0.7.0;

import "../../lib/math/Math.sol";

// This library is used to create a data structure that represents a token's balance for a Pool. 'cash' is how many
// tokens the Pool has sitting inside of the Vault. 'managed' is how many tokens were withdrawn from the Vault by the
// Pool's Asset Manager. 'total' is the sum of these two, and represents the Pool's total token balance, including
// tokens that are *not* inside of the Vault.
//
// 'cash' is updated whenever tokens enter and exit the Vault, while 'managed' is only updated if the reason tokens are
// moving is due to an Asset Manager action. This is reflected in the different methods available: 'increaseCash'
// and 'decreaseCash' for swaps and add/remove liquidity events, and 'cashToManaged' and 'managedToCash' for events
// transferring funds to and from the Asset Manager.
//
// The Vault disallows the Pool's 'cash' from becoming negative. In other words, it can never use any tokens that are
// not inside the Vault.
//
// One of the goals of this library is to store the entire token balance in a single storage slot, which is why we use
// 112 bit unsigned integers for 'cash' and 'managed'. For consistency, we also disallow any combination of 'cash' and
// 'managed' that yields a 'total' that doesn't fit in 112 bits.
//
// The remaining 32 bits of the slot are used to store the most recent block when the total balance changed. This
// can be used to implement price oracles that are resilient to 'sandwich' attacks.
//
// We could use a Solidity struct to pack these three values together in a single storage slot, but unfortunately
// Solidity only allows for structs to live in either storage, calldata or memory. Because a memory struct still takes
// up a slot in the stack (to store its memory location), and because the entire balance fits in a single stack slot
// (two 112 bit values plus the 32 bit block), using memory is strictly less gas performant. Therefore, we do manual
// packing and unpacking.
//
// Since we cannot define new types, we rely on bytes32 to represent these values instead, as it doesn't have any
// associated arithmetic operations and therefore reduces the chance of misuse.
library BalanceAllocation {
    using Math for uint256;

    // The 'cash' portion of the balance is stored in the least significant 112 bits of a 256 bit word, while the
    // 'managed' part uses the following 112 bits. The most significant 32 bits are used to store the block

    /**
     * @dev Returns the total amount of Pool tokens, including those that are not currently in the Vault ('managed').
     */
    function total(bytes32 balance) internal pure returns (uint256) {
        // Since 'cash' and 'managed' are 112 bit values, we don't need checked arithmetic. Additionally, `toBalance`
        // ensures that 'total' always fits in 112 bits.
        return cash(balance) + managed(balance);
    }

    /**
     * @dev Returns the amount of Pool tokens currently in the Vault.
     */
    function cash(bytes32 balance) internal pure returns (uint256) {
        uint256 mask = 2**(112) - 1;
        return uint256(balance) & mask;
    }

    /**
     * @dev Returns the amount of Pool tokens that are being managed by an Asset Manager.
     */
    function managed(bytes32 balance) internal pure returns (uint256) {
        uint256 mask = 2**(112) - 1;
        return uint256(balance >> 112) & mask;
    }

    /**
     * @dev Returns the last block when the total balance changed.
     */
    function lastChangeBlock(bytes32 balance) internal pure returns (uint256) {
        uint256 mask = 2**(32) - 1;
        return uint256(balance >> 224) & mask;
    }

    /**
     * @dev Returns the difference in 'managed' between two balances.
     */
    function managedDelta(bytes32 newBalance, bytes32 oldBalance) internal pure returns (int256) {
        // Because `managed` is a 112 bit value, we can safely perform unchecked arithmetic in 256 bits.
        return int256(managed(newBalance)) - int256(managed(oldBalance));
    }

    /**
     * @dev Returns the total balance for each entry in `balances`, as well as the latest block when the total
     * balance of *any* of them last changed.
     */
    function totalsAndLastChangeBlock(bytes32[] memory balances)
        internal
        pure
        returns (
            uint256[] memory results,
            uint256 lastChangeBlock_ // Avoid shadowing
        )
    {
        results = new uint256[](balances.length);
        lastChangeBlock_ = 0;

        for (uint256 i = 0; i < results.length; i++) {
            bytes32 balance = balances[i];
            results[i] = total(balance);
            lastChangeBlock_ = Math.max(lastChangeBlock_, lastChangeBlock(balance));
        }
    }

    /**
     * @dev Returns true if `balance`'s 'total' balance is zero. Costs less gas than computing 'total' and comparing
     * with zero.
     */
    function isZero(bytes32 balance) internal pure returns (bool) {
        // We simply need to check the least significant 224 bytes of the word: the block does not affect this.
        uint256 mask = 2**(224) - 1;
        return (uint256(balance) & mask) == 0;
    }

    /**
     * @dev Returns true if `balance`'s 'total' balance is not zero. Costs less gas than computing 'total' and comparing
     * with zero.
     */
    function isNotZero(bytes32 balance) internal pure returns (bool) {
        return !isZero(balance);
    }

    /**
     * @dev Packs together `cash` and `managed` amounts with a block to create a balance value.
     *
     * For consistency, this also checks that the sum of `cash` and `managed` (`total`) fits in 112 bits.
     */
    function toBalance(
        uint256 _cash,
        uint256 _managed,
        uint256 _blockNumber
    ) internal pure returns (bytes32) {
        uint256 _total = _cash + _managed;

        // Since both 'cash' and 'managed' are positive integers, by checking that their sum ('total') fits in 112 bits
        // we are also indirectly checking that both 'cash' and 'managed' themselves fit in 112 bits.
        _require(_total >= _cash && _total < 2**112, Errors.BALANCE_TOTAL_OVERFLOW);

        // We assume the block fits in 32 bits - this is expected to hold for at least a few decades.
        return _pack(_cash, _managed, _blockNumber);
    }

    /**
     * @dev Increases a Pool's 'cash' (and therefore its 'total'). Called when Pool tokens are sent to the Vault (except
     * for Asset Manager deposits).
     *
     * Updates the last total balance change block, even if `amount` is zero.
     */
    function increaseCash(bytes32 balance, uint256 amount) internal view returns (bytes32) {
        uint256 newCash = cash(balance).add(amount);
        uint256 currentManaged = managed(balance);
        uint256 newLastChangeBlock = block.number;

        return toBalance(newCash, currentManaged, newLastChangeBlock);
    }

    /**
     * @dev Decreases a Pool's 'cash' (and therefore its 'total'). Called when Pool tokens are sent from the Vault
     * (except for Asset Manager withdrawals).
     *
     * Updates the last total balance change block, even if `amount` is zero.
     */
    function decreaseCash(bytes32 balance, uint256 amount) internal view returns (bytes32) {
        uint256 newCash = cash(balance).sub(amount);
        uint256 currentManaged = managed(balance);
        uint256 newLastChangeBlock = block.number;

        return toBalance(newCash, currentManaged, newLastChangeBlock);
    }

    /**
     * @dev Moves 'cash' into 'managed', leaving 'total' unchanged. Called when an Asset Manager withdraws Pool tokens
     * from the Vault.
     */
    function cashToManaged(bytes32 balance, uint256 amount) internal pure returns (bytes32) {
        uint256 newCash = cash(balance).sub(amount);
        uint256 newManaged = managed(balance).add(amount);
        uint256 currentLastChangeBlock = lastChangeBlock(balance);

        return toBalance(newCash, newManaged, currentLastChangeBlock);
    }

    /**
     * @dev Moves 'managed' into 'cash', leaving 'total' unchanged. Called when an Asset Manager deposits Pool tokens
     * into the Vault.
     */
    function managedToCash(bytes32 balance, uint256 amount) internal pure returns (bytes32) {
        uint256 newCash = cash(balance).add(amount);
        uint256 newManaged = managed(balance).sub(amount);
        uint256 currentLastChangeBlock = lastChangeBlock(balance);

        return toBalance(newCash, newManaged, currentLastChangeBlock);
    }

    /**
     * @dev Sets 'managed' balance to an arbitrary value, changing 'total'. Called when the Asset Manager reports
     * profits or losses. It's the Manager's responsibility to provide a meaningful value.
     *
     * Updates the last total balance change block, even if `newManaged` is equal to the current 'managed' value.
     */
    function setManaged(bytes32 balance, uint256 newManaged) internal view returns (bytes32) {
        uint256 currentCash = cash(balance);
        uint256 newLastChangeBlock = block.number;
        return toBalance(currentCash, newManaged, newLastChangeBlock);
    }

    // Alternative mode for Pools with the Two Token specialization setting

    // Instead of storing cash and external for each 'token in' a single storage slot, Two Token Pools store the cash
    // for both tokens in the same slot, and the managed for both in another one. This reduces the gas cost for swaps,
    // because the only slot that needs to be updated is the one with the cash. However, it also means that managing
    // balances is more cumbersome, as both tokens need to be read/written at the same time.
    //
    // The field with both cash balances packed is called sharedCash, and the one with external amounts is called
    // sharedManaged. These two are collectively called the 'shared' balance fields. In both of these, the portion
    // that corresponds to token A is stored in the least significant 112 bits of a 256 bit word, while token B's part
    // uses the next least significant 112 bits.
    //
    // Because only cash is written to during a swap, we store the last total balance change block with the
    // packed cash fields. Typically Pools have a distinct block per token: in the case of Two Token Pools they
    // are the same.

    /**
     * @dev Extracts the part of the balance that corresponds to token A. This function can be used to decode both
     * shared cash and managed balances.
     */
    function _decodeBalanceA(bytes32 sharedBalance) private pure returns (uint256) {
        uint256 mask = 2**(112) - 1;
        return uint256(sharedBalance) & mask;
    }

    /**
     * @dev Extracts the part of the balance that corresponds to token B. This function can be used to decode both
     * shared cash and managed balances.
     */
    function _decodeBalanceB(bytes32 sharedBalance) private pure returns (uint256) {
        uint256 mask = 2**(112) - 1;
        return uint256(sharedBalance >> 112) & mask;
    }

    // To decode the last balance change block, we can simply use the `blockNumber` function.

    /**
     * @dev Unpacks the shared token A and token B cash and managed balances into the balance for token A.
     */
    function fromSharedToBalanceA(bytes32 sharedCash, bytes32 sharedManaged) internal pure returns (bytes32) {
        // Note that we extract the block from the sharedCash field, which is the one that is updated by swaps.
        // Both token A and token B use the same block
        return toBalance(_decodeBalanceA(sharedCash), _decodeBalanceA(sharedManaged), lastChangeBlock(sharedCash));
    }

    /**
     * @dev Unpacks the shared token A and token B cash and managed balances into the balance for token B.
     */
    function fromSharedToBalanceB(bytes32 sharedCash, bytes32 sharedManaged) internal pure returns (bytes32) {
        // Note that we extract the block from the sharedCash field, which is the one that is updated by swaps.
        // Both token A and token B use the same block
        return toBalance(_decodeBalanceB(sharedCash), _decodeBalanceB(sharedManaged), lastChangeBlock(sharedCash));
    }

    /**
     * @dev Returns the sharedCash shared field, given the current balances for token A and token B.
     */
    function toSharedCash(bytes32 tokenABalance, bytes32 tokenBBalance) internal pure returns (bytes32) {
        // Both balances are assigned the same block  Since it is possible a single one of them has changed (for
        // example, in an Asset Manager update), we keep the latest (largest) one.
        uint32 newLastChangeBlock = uint32(Math.max(lastChangeBlock(tokenABalance), lastChangeBlock(tokenBBalance)));

        return _pack(cash(tokenABalance), cash(tokenBBalance), newLastChangeBlock);
    }

    /**
     * @dev Returns the sharedManaged shared field, given the current balances for token A and token B.
     */
    function toSharedManaged(bytes32 tokenABalance, bytes32 tokenBBalance) internal pure returns (bytes32) {
        // We don't bother storing a last change block, as it is read from the shared cash field.
        return _pack(managed(tokenABalance), managed(tokenBBalance), 0);
    }

    // Shared functions

    /**
     * @dev Packs together two uint112 and one uint32 into a bytes32
     */
    function _pack(
        uint256 _leastSignificant,
        uint256 _midSignificant,
        uint256 _mostSignificant
    ) private pure returns (bytes32) {
        return bytes32((_mostSignificant << 224) + (_midSignificant << 112) + _leastSignificant);
    }
}

File 35 of 86 : GeneralPoolsBalance.sol
// SPDX-License-Identifier: GPL-3.0-or-later
// This program is free software: you can redistribute it and/or modify
// it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
// the Free Software Foundation, either version 3 of the License, or
// (at your option) any later version.

// This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
// but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
// MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE.  See the
// GNU General Public License for more details.

// You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
// along with this program.  If not, see <http://www.gnu.org/licenses/>.

pragma solidity ^0.7.0;

import "../../lib/helpers/BalancerErrors.sol";
import "../../lib/openzeppelin/EnumerableMap.sol";
import "../../lib/openzeppelin/IERC20.sol";

import "./BalanceAllocation.sol";

abstract contract GeneralPoolsBalance {
    using BalanceAllocation for bytes32;
    using EnumerableMap for EnumerableMap.IERC20ToBytes32Map;

    // Data for Pools with the General specialization setting
    //
    // These Pools use the IGeneralPool interface, which means the Vault must query the balance for *all* of their
    // tokens in every swap. If we kept a mapping of token to balance plus a set (array) of tokens, it'd be very gas
    // intensive to read all token addresses just to then do a lookup on the balance mapping.
    //
    // Instead, we use our customized EnumerableMap, which lets us read the N balances in N+1 storage accesses (one for
    // each token in the Pool), access the index of any 'token in' a single read (required for the IGeneralPool call),
    // and update an entry's value given its index.

    // Map of token -> balance pairs for each Pool with this specialization. Many functions rely on storage pointers to
    // a Pool's EnumerableMap to save gas when computing storage slots.
    mapping(bytes32 => EnumerableMap.IERC20ToBytes32Map) internal _generalPoolsBalances;

    /**
     * @dev Registers a list of tokens in a General Pool.
     *
     * This function assumes `poolId` exists and corresponds to the General specialization setting.
     *
     * Requirements:
     *
     * - `tokens` must not be registered in the Pool
     * - `tokens` must not contain duplicates
     */
    function _registerGeneralPoolTokens(bytes32 poolId, IERC20[] memory tokens) internal {
        EnumerableMap.IERC20ToBytes32Map storage poolBalances = _generalPoolsBalances[poolId];

        for (uint256 i = 0; i < tokens.length; ++i) {
            // EnumerableMaps require an explicit initial value when creating a key-value pair: we use zero, the same
            // value that is found in uninitialized storage, which corresponds to an empty balance.
            bool added = poolBalances.set(tokens[i], 0);
            _require(added, Errors.TOKEN_ALREADY_REGISTERED);
        }
    }

    /**
     * @dev Deregisters a list of tokens in a General Pool.
     *
     * This function assumes `poolId` exists and corresponds to the General specialization setting.
     *
     * Requirements:
     *
     * - `tokens` must be registered in the Pool
     * - `tokens` must have zero balance in the Vault
     * - `tokens` must not contain duplicates
     */
    function _deregisterGeneralPoolTokens(bytes32 poolId, IERC20[] memory tokens) internal {
        EnumerableMap.IERC20ToBytes32Map storage poolBalances = _generalPoolsBalances[poolId];

        for (uint256 i = 0; i < tokens.length; ++i) {
            IERC20 token = tokens[i];
            bytes32 currentBalance = _getGeneralPoolBalance(poolBalances, token);
            _require(currentBalance.isZero(), Errors.NONZERO_TOKEN_BALANCE);

            // We don't need to check remove's return value, since _getGeneralPoolBalance already checks that the token
            // was registered.
            poolBalances.remove(token);
        }
    }

    /**
     * @dev Sets the balances of a General Pool's tokens to `balances`.
     *
     * WARNING: this assumes `balances` has the same length and order as the Pool's tokens.
     */
    function _setGeneralPoolBalances(bytes32 poolId, bytes32[] memory balances) internal {
        EnumerableMap.IERC20ToBytes32Map storage poolBalances = _generalPoolsBalances[poolId];

        for (uint256 i = 0; i < balances.length; ++i) {
            // Since we assume all balances are properly ordered, we can simply use `unchecked_setAt` to avoid one less
            // storage read per token.
            poolBalances.unchecked_setAt(i, balances[i]);
        }
    }

    /**
     * @dev Transforms `amount` of `token`'s balance in a General Pool from cash into managed.
     *
     * This function assumes `poolId` exists, corresponds to the General specialization setting, and that `token` is
     * registered for that Pool.
     */
    function _generalPoolCashToManaged(
        bytes32 poolId,
        IERC20 token,
        uint256 amount
    ) internal {
        _updateGeneralPoolBalance(poolId, token, BalanceAllocation.cashToManaged, amount);
    }

    /**
     * @dev Transforms `amount` of `token`'s balance in a General Pool from managed into cash.
     *
     * This function assumes `poolId` exists, corresponds to the General specialization setting, and that `token` is
     * registered for that Pool.
     */
    function _generalPoolManagedToCash(
        bytes32 poolId,
        IERC20 token,
        uint256 amount
    ) internal {
        _updateGeneralPoolBalance(poolId, token, BalanceAllocation.managedToCash, amount);
    }

    /**
     * @dev Sets `token`'s managed balance in a General Pool to `amount`.
     *
     * This function assumes `poolId` exists, corresponds to the General specialization setting, and that `token` is
     * registered for that Pool.
     *
     * Returns the managed balance delta as a result of this call.
     */
    function _setGeneralPoolManagedBalance(
        bytes32 poolId,
        IERC20 token,
        uint256 amount
    ) internal returns (int256) {
        return _updateGeneralPoolBalance(poolId, token, BalanceAllocation.setManaged, amount);
    }

    /**
     * @dev Sets `token`'s balance in a General Pool to the result of the `mutation` function when called with the
     * current balance and `amount`.
     *
     * This function assumes `poolId` exists, corresponds to the General specialization setting, and that `token` is
     * registered for that Pool.
     *
     * Returns the managed balance delta as a result of this call.
     */
    function _updateGeneralPoolBalance(
        bytes32 poolId,
        IERC20 token,
        function(bytes32, uint256) returns (bytes32) mutation,
        uint256 amount
    ) private returns (int256) {
        EnumerableMap.IERC20ToBytes32Map storage poolBalances = _generalPoolsBalances[poolId];
        bytes32 currentBalance = _getGeneralPoolBalance(poolBalances, token);

        bytes32 newBalance = mutation(currentBalance, amount);
        poolBalances.set(token, newBalance);

        return newBalance.managedDelta(currentBalance);
    }

    /**
     * @dev Returns an array with all the tokens and balances in a General Pool. The order may change when tokens are
     * registered or deregistered.
     *
     * This function assumes `poolId` exists and corresponds to the General specialization setting.
     */
    function _getGeneralPoolTokens(bytes32 poolId)
        internal
        view
        returns (IERC20[] memory tokens, bytes32[] memory balances)
    {
        EnumerableMap.IERC20ToBytes32Map storage poolBalances = _generalPoolsBalances[poolId];
        tokens = new IERC20[](poolBalances.length());
        balances = new bytes32[](tokens.length);

        for (uint256 i = 0; i < tokens.length; ++i) {
            // Because the iteration is bounded by `tokens.length`, which matches the EnumerableMap's length, we can use
            // `unchecked_at` as we know `i` is a valid token index, saving storage reads.
            (tokens[i], balances[i]) = poolBalances.unchecked_at(i);
        }
    }

    /**
     * @dev Returns the balance of a token in a General Pool.
     *
     * This function assumes `poolId` exists and corresponds to the General specialization setting.
     *
     * Requirements:
     *
     * - `token` must be registered in the Pool
     */
    function _getGeneralPoolBalance(bytes32 poolId, IERC20 token) internal view returns (bytes32) {
        EnumerableMap.IERC20ToBytes32Map storage poolBalances = _generalPoolsBalances[poolId];
        return _getGeneralPoolBalance(poolBalances, token);
    }

    /**
     * @dev Same as `_getGeneralPoolBalance` but using a Pool's storage pointer, which saves gas in repeated reads and
     * writes.
     */
    function _getGeneralPoolBalance(EnumerableMap.IERC20ToBytes32Map storage poolBalances, IERC20 token)
        private
        view
        returns (bytes32)
    {
        return poolBalances.get(token, Errors.TOKEN_NOT_REGISTERED);
    }

    /**
     * @dev Returns true if `token` is registered in a General Pool.
     *
     * This function assumes `poolId` exists and corresponds to the General specialization setting.
     */
    function _isGeneralPoolTokenRegistered(bytes32 poolId, IERC20 token) internal view returns (bool) {
        EnumerableMap.IERC20ToBytes32Map storage poolBalances = _generalPoolsBalances[poolId];
        return poolBalances.contains(token);
    }
}

File 36 of 86 : MinimalSwapInfoPoolsBalance.sol
// SPDX-License-Identifier: GPL-3.0-or-later
// This program is free software: you can redistribute it and/or modify
// it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
// the Free Software Foundation, either version 3 of the License, or
// (at your option) any later version.

// This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
// but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
// MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE.  See the
// GNU General Public License for more details.

// You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
// along with this program.  If not, see <http://www.gnu.org/licenses/>.

pragma solidity ^0.7.0;
pragma experimental ABIEncoderV2;

import "../../lib/helpers/BalancerErrors.sol";
import "../../lib/openzeppelin/EnumerableSet.sol";
import "../../lib/openzeppelin/IERC20.sol";

import "./BalanceAllocation.sol";
import "../PoolRegistry.sol";

abstract contract MinimalSwapInfoPoolsBalance is PoolRegistry {
    using BalanceAllocation for bytes32;
    using EnumerableSet for EnumerableSet.AddressSet;

    // Data for Pools with the Minimal Swap Info specialization setting
    //
    // These Pools use the IMinimalSwapInfoPool interface, and so the Vault must read the balance of the two tokens
    // in the swap. The best solution is to use a mapping from token to balance, which lets us read or write any token's
    // balance in a single storage access.
    //
    // We also keep a set of registered tokens. Because tokens with non-zero balance are by definition registered, in
    // some balance getters we skip checking for token registration if a non-zero balance is found, saving gas by
    // performing a single read instead of two.

    mapping(bytes32 => mapping(IERC20 => bytes32)) internal _minimalSwapInfoPoolsBalances;
    mapping(bytes32 => EnumerableSet.AddressSet) internal _minimalSwapInfoPoolsTokens;

    /**
     * @dev Registers a list of tokens in a Minimal Swap Info Pool.
     *
     * This function assumes `poolId` exists and corresponds to the Minimal Swap Info specialization setting.
     *
     * Requirements:
     *
     * - `tokens` must not be registered in the Pool
     * - `tokens` must not contain duplicates
     */
    function _registerMinimalSwapInfoPoolTokens(bytes32 poolId, IERC20[] memory tokens) internal {
        EnumerableSet.AddressSet storage poolTokens = _minimalSwapInfoPoolsTokens[poolId];

        for (uint256 i = 0; i < tokens.length; ++i) {
            bool added = poolTokens.add(address(tokens[i]));
            _require(added, Errors.TOKEN_ALREADY_REGISTERED);
            // Note that we don't initialize the balance mapping: the default value of zero corresponds to an empty
            // balance.
        }
    }

    /**
     * @dev Deregisters a list of tokens in a Minimal Swap Info Pool.
     *
     * This function assumes `poolId` exists and corresponds to the Minimal Swap Info specialization setting.
     *
     * Requirements:
     *
     * - `tokens` must be registered in the Pool
     * - `tokens` must have zero balance in the Vault
     * - `tokens` must not contain duplicates
     */
    function _deregisterMinimalSwapInfoPoolTokens(bytes32 poolId, IERC20[] memory tokens) internal {
        EnumerableSet.AddressSet storage poolTokens = _minimalSwapInfoPoolsTokens[poolId];

        for (uint256 i = 0; i < tokens.length; ++i) {
            IERC20 token = tokens[i];
            _require(_minimalSwapInfoPoolsBalances[poolId][token].isZero(), Errors.NONZERO_TOKEN_BALANCE);

            // For consistency with other Pool specialization settings, we explicitly reset the balance (which may have
            // a non-zero last change block).
            delete _minimalSwapInfoPoolsBalances[poolId][token];

            bool removed = poolTokens.remove(address(token));
            _require(removed, Errors.TOKEN_NOT_REGISTERED);
        }
    }

    /**
     * @dev Sets the balances of a Minimal Swap Info Pool's tokens to `balances`.
     *
     * WARNING: this assumes `balances` has the same length and order as the Pool's tokens.
     */
    function _setMinimalSwapInfoPoolBalances(
        bytes32 poolId,
        IERC20[] memory tokens,
        bytes32[] memory balances
    ) internal {
        for (uint256 i = 0; i < tokens.length; ++i) {
            _minimalSwapInfoPoolsBalances[poolId][tokens[i]] = balances[i];
        }
    }

    /**
     * @dev Transforms `amount` of `token`'s balance in a Minimal Swap Info Pool from cash into managed.
     *
     * This function assumes `poolId` exists, corresponds to the Minimal Swap Info specialization setting, and that
     * `token` is registered for that Pool.
     */
    function _minimalSwapInfoPoolCashToManaged(
        bytes32 poolId,
        IERC20 token,
        uint256 amount
    ) internal {
        _updateMinimalSwapInfoPoolBalance(poolId, token, BalanceAllocation.cashToManaged, amount);
    }

    /**
     * @dev Transforms `amount` of `token`'s balance in a Minimal Swap Info Pool from managed into cash.
     *
     * This function assumes `poolId` exists, corresponds to the Minimal Swap Info specialization setting, and that
     * `token` is registered for that Pool.
     */
    function _minimalSwapInfoPoolManagedToCash(
        bytes32 poolId,
        IERC20 token,
        uint256 amount
    ) internal {
        _updateMinimalSwapInfoPoolBalance(poolId, token, BalanceAllocation.managedToCash, amount);
    }

    /**
     * @dev Sets `token`'s managed balance in a Minimal Swap Info Pool to `amount`.
     *
     * This function assumes `poolId` exists, corresponds to the Minimal Swap Info specialization setting, and that
     * `token` is registered for that Pool.
     *
     * Returns the managed balance delta as a result of this call.
     */
    function _setMinimalSwapInfoPoolManagedBalance(
        bytes32 poolId,
        IERC20 token,
        uint256 amount
    ) internal returns (int256) {
        return _updateMinimalSwapInfoPoolBalance(poolId, token, BalanceAllocation.setManaged, amount);
    }

    /**
     * @dev Sets `token`'s balance in a Minimal Swap Info Pool to the result of the `mutation` function when called with
     * the current balance and `amount`.
     *
     * This function assumes `poolId` exists, corresponds to the Minimal Swap Info specialization setting, and that
     * `token` is registered for that Pool.
     *
     * Returns the managed balance delta as a result of this call.
     */
    function _updateMinimalSwapInfoPoolBalance(
        bytes32 poolId,
        IERC20 token,
        function(bytes32, uint256) returns (bytes32) mutation,
        uint256 amount
    ) internal returns (int256) {
        bytes32 currentBalance = _getMinimalSwapInfoPoolBalance(poolId, token);

        bytes32 newBalance = mutation(currentBalance, amount);
        _minimalSwapInfoPoolsBalances[poolId][token] = newBalance;

        return newBalance.managedDelta(currentBalance);
    }

    /**
     * @dev Returns an array with all the tokens and balances in a Minimal Swap Info Pool. The order may change when
     * tokens are registered or deregistered.
     *
     * This function assumes `poolId` exists and corresponds to the Minimal Swap Info specialization setting.
     */
    function _getMinimalSwapInfoPoolTokens(bytes32 poolId)
        internal
        view
        returns (IERC20[] memory tokens, bytes32[] memory balances)
    {
        EnumerableSet.AddressSet storage poolTokens = _minimalSwapInfoPoolsTokens[poolId];
        tokens = new IERC20[](poolTokens.length());
        balances = new bytes32[](tokens.length);

        for (uint256 i = 0; i < tokens.length; ++i) {
            // Because the iteration is bounded by `tokens.length`, which matches the EnumerableSet's length, we can use
            // `unchecked_at` as we know `i` is a valid token index, saving storage reads.
            IERC20 token = IERC20(poolTokens.unchecked_at(i));
            tokens[i] = token;
            balances[i] = _minimalSwapInfoPoolsBalances[poolId][token];
        }
    }

    /**
     * @dev Returns the balance of a token in a Minimal Swap Info Pool.
     *
     * Requirements:
     *
     * - `poolId` must be a Minimal Swap Info Pool
     * - `token` must be registered in the Pool
     */
    function _getMinimalSwapInfoPoolBalance(bytes32 poolId, IERC20 token) internal view returns (bytes32) {
        bytes32 balance = _minimalSwapInfoPoolsBalances[poolId][token];

        // A non-zero balance guarantees that the token is registered. If zero, we manually check if the token is
        // registered in the Pool. Token registration implies that the Pool is registered as well, which lets us save
        // gas by not performing the check.
        bool tokenRegistered = balance.isNotZero() || _minimalSwapInfoPoolsTokens[poolId].contains(address(token));

        if (!tokenRegistered) {
            // The token might not be registered because the Pool itself is not registered. We check this to provide a
            // more accurate revert reason.
            _ensureRegisteredPool(poolId);
            _revert(Errors.TOKEN_NOT_REGISTERED);
        }

        return balance;
    }

    /**
     * @dev Returns true if `token` is registered in a Minimal Swap Info Pool.
     *
     * This function assumes `poolId` exists and corresponds to the Minimal Swap Info specialization setting.
     */
    function _isMinimalSwapInfoPoolTokenRegistered(bytes32 poolId, IERC20 token) internal view returns (bool) {
        EnumerableSet.AddressSet storage poolTokens = _minimalSwapInfoPoolsTokens[poolId];
        return poolTokens.contains(address(token));
    }
}

File 37 of 86 : TwoTokenPoolsBalance.sol
// SPDX-License-Identifier: GPL-3.0-or-later
// This program is free software: you can redistribute it and/or modify
// it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
// the Free Software Foundation, either version 3 of the License, or
// (at your option) any later version.

// This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
// but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
// MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE.  See the
// GNU General Public License for more details.

// You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
// along with this program.  If not, see <http://www.gnu.org/licenses/>.

pragma solidity ^0.7.0;
pragma experimental ABIEncoderV2;

import "../../lib/helpers/BalancerErrors.sol";
import "../../lib/openzeppelin/IERC20.sol";

import "./BalanceAllocation.sol";
import "../PoolRegistry.sol";

abstract contract TwoTokenPoolsBalance is PoolRegistry {
    using BalanceAllocation for bytes32;

    // Data for Pools with the Two Token specialization setting
    //
    // These are similar to the Minimal Swap Info Pool case (because the Pool only has two tokens, and therefore there
    // are only two balances to read), but there's a key difference in how data is stored. Keeping a set makes little
    // sense, as it will only ever hold two tokens, so we can just store those two directly.
    //
    // The gas savings associated with using these Pools come from how token balances are stored: cash amounts for token
    // A and token B are packed together, as are managed amounts. Because only cash changes in a swap, there's no need
    // to write to this second storage slot. A single last change block number for both tokens is stored with the packed
    // cash fields.

    struct TwoTokenPoolBalances {
        bytes32 sharedCash;
        bytes32 sharedManaged;
    }

    // We could just keep a mapping from Pool ID to TwoTokenSharedBalances, but there's an issue: we wouldn't know to
    // which tokens those balances correspond. This would mean having to also check which are registered with the Pool.
    //
    // What we do instead to save those storage reads is keep a nested mapping from the token pair hash to the balances
    // struct. The Pool only has two tokens, so only a single entry of this mapping is set (the one that corresponds to
    // that pair's hash).
    //
    // This has the trade-off of making Vault code that interacts with these Pools cumbersome: both balances must be
    // accessed at the same time by using both token addresses, and some logic is needed to determine how the pair hash
    // is computed. We do this by sorting the tokens, calling the token with the lowest numerical address value token A,
    // and the other one token B. In functions where the token arguments could be either A or B, we use X and Y instead.
    //
    // If users query a token pair containing an unregistered token, the Pool will generate a hash for a mapping entry
    // that was not set, and return zero balances. Non-zero balances are only possible if both tokens in the pair
    // are registered with the Pool, which means we don't have to check the TwoTokenPoolTokens struct, and can save
    // storage reads.

    struct TwoTokenPoolTokens {
        IERC20 tokenA;
        IERC20 tokenB;
        mapping(bytes32 => TwoTokenPoolBalances) balances;
    }

    mapping(bytes32 => TwoTokenPoolTokens) private _twoTokenPoolTokens;

    /**
     * @dev Registers tokens in a Two Token Pool.
     *
     * This function assumes `poolId` exists and corresponds to the Two Token specialization setting.
     *
     * Requirements:
     *
     * - `tokenX` and `tokenY` must not be the same
     * - The tokens must be ordered: tokenX < tokenY
     */
    function _registerTwoTokenPoolTokens(
        bytes32 poolId,
        IERC20 tokenX,
        IERC20 tokenY
    ) internal {
        // Not technically true since we didn't register yet, but this is consistent with the error messages of other
        // specialization settings.
        _require(tokenX != tokenY, Errors.TOKEN_ALREADY_REGISTERED);

        _require(tokenX < tokenY, Errors.UNSORTED_TOKENS);

        // A Two Token Pool with no registered tokens is identified by having zero addresses for tokens A and B.
        TwoTokenPoolTokens storage poolTokens = _twoTokenPoolTokens[poolId];
        _require(poolTokens.tokenA == IERC20(0) && poolTokens.tokenB == IERC20(0), Errors.TOKENS_ALREADY_SET);

        // Since tokenX < tokenY, tokenX is A and tokenY is B
        poolTokens.tokenA = tokenX;
        poolTokens.tokenB = tokenY;

        // Note that we don't initialize the balance mapping: the default value of zero corresponds to an empty
        // balance.
    }

    /**
     * @dev Deregisters tokens in a Two Token Pool.
     *
     * This function assumes `poolId` exists and corresponds to the Two Token specialization setting.
     *
     * Requirements:
     *
     * - `tokenX` and `tokenY` must be registered in the Pool
     * - both tokens must have zero balance in the Vault
     */
    function _deregisterTwoTokenPoolTokens(
        bytes32 poolId,
        IERC20 tokenX,
        IERC20 tokenY
    ) internal {
        (
            bytes32 balanceA,
            bytes32 balanceB,
            TwoTokenPoolBalances storage poolBalances
        ) = _getTwoTokenPoolSharedBalances(poolId, tokenX, tokenY);

        _require(balanceA.isZero() && balanceB.isZero(), Errors.NONZERO_TOKEN_BALANCE);

        delete _twoTokenPoolTokens[poolId];

        // For consistency with other Pool specialization settings, we explicitly reset the packed cash field (which may
        // have a non-zero last change block).
        delete poolBalances.sharedCash;
    }

    /**
     * @dev Sets the cash balances of a Two Token Pool's tokens.
     *
     * WARNING: this assumes `tokenA` and `tokenB` are the Pool's two registered tokens, and are in the correct order.
     */
    function _setTwoTokenPoolCashBalances(
        bytes32 poolId,
        IERC20 tokenA,
        bytes32 balanceA,
        IERC20 tokenB,
        bytes32 balanceB
    ) internal {
        bytes32 pairHash = _getTwoTokenPairHash(tokenA, tokenB);
        TwoTokenPoolBalances storage poolBalances = _twoTokenPoolTokens[poolId].balances[pairHash];
        poolBalances.sharedCash = BalanceAllocation.toSharedCash(balanceA, balanceB);
    }

    /**
     * @dev Transforms `amount` of `token`'s balance in a Two Token Pool from cash into managed.
     *
     * This function assumes `poolId` exists, corresponds to the Two Token specialization setting, and that `token` is
     * registered for that Pool.
     */
    function _twoTokenPoolCashToManaged(
        bytes32 poolId,
        IERC20 token,
        uint256 amount
    ) internal {
        _updateTwoTokenPoolSharedBalance(poolId, token, BalanceAllocation.cashToManaged, amount);
    }

    /**
     * @dev Transforms `amount` of `token`'s balance in a Two Token Pool from managed into cash.
     *
     * This function assumes `poolId` exists, corresponds to the Two Token specialization setting, and that `token` is
     * registered for that Pool.
     */
    function _twoTokenPoolManagedToCash(
        bytes32 poolId,
        IERC20 token,
        uint256 amount
    ) internal {
        _updateTwoTokenPoolSharedBalance(poolId, token, BalanceAllocation.managedToCash, amount);
    }

    /**
     * @dev Sets `token`'s managed balance in a Two Token Pool to `amount`.
     *
     * This function assumes `poolId` exists, corresponds to the Two Token specialization setting, and that `token` is
     * registered for that Pool.
     *
     * Returns the managed balance delta as a result of this call.
     */
    function _setTwoTokenPoolManagedBalance(
        bytes32 poolId,
        IERC20 token,
        uint256 amount
    ) internal returns (int256) {
        return _updateTwoTokenPoolSharedBalance(poolId, token, BalanceAllocation.setManaged, amount);
    }

    /**
     * @dev Sets `token`'s balance in a Two Token Pool to the result of the `mutation` function when called with
     * the current balance and `amount`.
     *
     * This function assumes `poolId` exists, corresponds to the Two Token specialization setting, and that `token` is
     * registered for that Pool.
     *
     * Returns the managed balance delta as a result of this call.
     */
    function _updateTwoTokenPoolSharedBalance(
        bytes32 poolId,
        IERC20 token,
        function(bytes32, uint256) returns (bytes32) mutation,
        uint256 amount
    ) private returns (int256) {
        (
            TwoTokenPoolBalances storage balances,
            IERC20 tokenA,
            bytes32 balanceA,
            ,
            bytes32 balanceB
        ) = _getTwoTokenPoolBalances(poolId);

        int256 delta;
        if (token == tokenA) {
            bytes32 newBalance = mutation(balanceA, amount);
            delta = newBalance.managedDelta(balanceA);
            balanceA = newBalance;
        } else {
            // token == tokenB
            bytes32 newBalance = mutation(balanceB, amount);
            delta = newBalance.managedDelta(balanceB);
            balanceB = newBalance;
        }

        balances.sharedCash = BalanceAllocation.toSharedCash(balanceA, balanceB);
        balances.sharedManaged = BalanceAllocation.toSharedManaged(balanceA, balanceB);

        return delta;
    }

    /*
     * @dev Returns an array with all the tokens and balances in a Two Token Pool. The order may change when
     * tokens are registered or deregistered.
     *
     * This function assumes `poolId` exists and corresponds to the Two Token specialization setting.
     */
    function _getTwoTokenPoolTokens(bytes32 poolId)
        internal
        view
        returns (IERC20[] memory tokens, bytes32[] memory balances)
    {
        (, IERC20 tokenA, bytes32 balanceA, IERC20 tokenB, bytes32 balanceB) = _getTwoTokenPoolBalances(poolId);

        // Both tokens will either be zero (if unregistered) or non-zero (if registered), but we keep the full check for
        // clarity.
        if (tokenA == IERC20(0) || tokenB == IERC20(0)) {
            return (new IERC20[](0), new bytes32[](0));
        }

        // Note that functions relying on this getter expect tokens to be properly ordered, so we use the (A, B)
        // ordering.

        tokens = new IERC20[](2);
        tokens[0] = tokenA;
        tokens[1] = tokenB;

        balances = new bytes32[](2);
        balances[0] = balanceA;
        balances[1] = balanceB;
    }

    /**
     * @dev Same as `_getTwoTokenPoolTokens`, except it returns the two tokens and balances directly instead of using
     * an array, as well as a storage pointer to the `TwoTokenPoolBalances` struct, which can be used to update it
     * without having to recompute the pair hash and storage slot.
     */
    function _getTwoTokenPoolBalances(bytes32 poolId)
        private
        view
        returns (
            TwoTokenPoolBalances storage poolBalances,
            IERC20 tokenA,
            bytes32 balanceA,
            IERC20 tokenB,
            bytes32 balanceB
        )
    {
        TwoTokenPoolTokens storage poolTokens = _twoTokenPoolTokens[poolId];
        tokenA = poolTokens.tokenA;
        tokenB = poolTokens.tokenB;

        bytes32 pairHash = _getTwoTokenPairHash(tokenA, tokenB);
        poolBalances = poolTokens.balances[pairHash];

        bytes32 sharedCash = poolBalances.sharedCash;
        bytes32 sharedManaged = poolBalances.sharedManaged;

        balanceA = BalanceAllocation.fromSharedToBalanceA(sharedCash, sharedManaged);
        balanceB = BalanceAllocation.fromSharedToBalanceB(sharedCash, sharedManaged);
    }

    /**
     * @dev Returns the balance of a token in a Two Token Pool.
     *
     * This function assumes `poolId` exists and corresponds to the General specialization setting.
     *
     * This function is convenient but not particularly gas efficient, and should be avoided during gas-sensitive
     * operations, such as swaps. For those, _getTwoTokenPoolSharedBalances provides a more flexible interface.
     *
     * Requirements:
     *
     * - `token` must be registered in the Pool
     */
    function _getTwoTokenPoolBalance(bytes32 poolId, IERC20 token) internal view returns (bytes32) {
        // We can't just read the balance of token, because we need to know the full pair in order to compute the pair
        // hash and access the balance mapping. We therefore rely on `_getTwoTokenPoolBalances`.
        (, IERC20 tokenA, bytes32 balanceA, IERC20 tokenB, bytes32 balanceB) = _getTwoTokenPoolBalances(poolId);

        if (token == tokenA) {
            return balanceA;
        } else if (token == tokenB) {
            return balanceB;
        } else {
            _revert(Errors.TOKEN_NOT_REGISTERED);
        }
    }

    /**
     * @dev Returns the balance of the two tokens in a Two Token Pool.
     *
     * The returned balances are those of token A and token B, where token A is the lowest of token X and token Y, and
     * token B the other.
     *
     * This function also returns a storage pointer to the TwoTokenPoolBalances struct associated with the token pair,
     * which can be used to update it without having to recompute the pair hash and storage slot.
     *
     * Requirements:
     *
     * - `poolId` must be a Minimal Swap Info Pool
     * - `tokenX` and `tokenY` must be registered in the Pool
     */
    function _getTwoTokenPoolSharedBalances(
        bytes32 poolId,
        IERC20 tokenX,
        IERC20 tokenY
    )
        internal
        view
        returns (
            bytes32 balanceA,
            bytes32 balanceB,
            TwoTokenPoolBalances storage poolBalances
        )
    {
        (IERC20 tokenA, IERC20 tokenB) = _sortTwoTokens(tokenX, tokenY);
        bytes32 pairHash = _getTwoTokenPairHash(tokenA, tokenB);

        poolBalances = _twoTokenPoolTokens[poolId].balances[pairHash];

        // Because we're reading balances using the pair hash, if either token X or token Y is not registered then
        // *both* balance entries will be zero.
        bytes32 sharedCash = poolBalances.sharedCash;
        bytes32 sharedManaged = poolBalances.sharedManaged;

        // A non-zero balance guarantees that both tokens are registered. If zero, we manually check whether each
        // token is registered in the Pool. Token registration implies that the Pool is registered as well, which
        // lets us save gas by not performing the check.
        bool tokensRegistered = sharedCash.isNotZero() ||
            sharedManaged.isNotZero() ||
            (_isTwoTokenPoolTokenRegistered(poolId, tokenA) && _isTwoTokenPoolTokenRegistered(poolId, tokenB));

        if (!tokensRegistered) {
            // The tokens might not be registered because the Pool itself is not registered. We check this to provide a
            // more accurate revert reason.
            _ensureRegisteredPool(poolId);
            _revert(Errors.TOKEN_NOT_REGISTERED);
        }

        balanceA = BalanceAllocation.fromSharedToBalanceA(sharedCash, sharedManaged);
        balanceB = BalanceAllocation.fromSharedToBalanceB(sharedCash, sharedManaged);
    }

    /**
     * @dev Returns true if `token` is registered in a Two Token Pool.
     *
     * This function assumes `poolId` exists and corresponds to the Two Token specialization setting.
     */
    function _isTwoTokenPoolTokenRegistered(bytes32 poolId, IERC20 token) internal view returns (bool) {
        TwoTokenPoolTokens storage poolTokens = _twoTokenPoolTokens[poolId];

        // The zero address can never be a registered token.
        return (token == poolTokens.tokenA || token == poolTokens.tokenB) && token != IERC20(0);
    }

    /**
     * @dev Returns the hash associated with a given token pair.
     */
    function _getTwoTokenPairHash(IERC20 tokenA, IERC20 tokenB) private pure returns (bytes32) {
        return keccak256(abi.encodePacked(tokenA, tokenB));
    }

    /**
     * @dev Sorts two tokens in ascending order, returning them as a (tokenA, tokenB) tuple.
     */
    function _sortTwoTokens(IERC20 tokenX, IERC20 tokenY) private pure returns (IERC20, IERC20) {
        return tokenX < tokenY ? (tokenX, tokenY) : (tokenY, tokenX);
    }
}

File 38 of 86 : EnumerableMap.sol
// SPDX-License-Identifier: MIT

pragma solidity ^0.7.0;

// Based on the EnumerableMap library from OpenZeppelin contracts, altered to include the following:
//  * a map from IERC20 to bytes32
//  * entries are stored in mappings instead of arrays, reducing implicit storage reads for out-of-bounds checks
//  * unchecked_at and unchecked_valueAt, which allow for more gas efficient data reads in some scenarios
//  * unchecked_indexOf and unchecked_setAt, which allow for more gas efficient data writes in some scenarios
//
// Additionally, the base private functions that work on bytes32 were removed and replaced with a native implementation
// for IERC20 keys, to reduce bytecode size and runtime costs.

// We're using non-standard casing for the unchecked functions to differentiate them, so we need to turn off that rule
// solhint-disable func-name-mixedcase

import "./IERC20.sol";

import "../helpers/BalancerErrors.sol";

/**
 * @dev Library for managing an enumerable variant of Solidity's
 * https://solidity.readthedocs.io/en/latest/types.html#mapping-types[`mapping`]
 * type.
 *
 * Maps have the following properties:
 *
 * - Entries are added, removed, and checked for existence in constant time
 * (O(1)).
 * - Entries are enumerated in O(n). No guarantees are made on the ordering.
 *
 * ```
 * contract Example {
 *     // Add the library methods
 *     using EnumerableMap for EnumerableMap.UintToAddressMap;
 *
 *     // Declare a set state variable
 *     EnumerableMap.UintToAddressMap private myMap;
 * }
 * ```
 */
library EnumerableMap {
    // The original OpenZeppelin implementation uses a generic Map type with bytes32 keys: this was replaced with
    // IERC20ToBytes32Map, which uses IERC20 keys natively, resulting in more dense bytecode.

    struct IERC20ToBytes32MapEntry {
        IERC20 _key;
        bytes32 _value;
    }

    struct IERC20ToBytes32Map {
        // Number of entries in the map
        uint256 _length;
        // Storage of map keys and values
        mapping(uint256 => IERC20ToBytes32MapEntry) _entries;
        // Position of the entry defined by a key in the `entries` array, plus 1
        // because index 0 means a key is not in the map.
        mapping(IERC20 => uint256) _indexes;
    }

    /**
     * @dev Adds a key-value pair to a map, or updates the value for an existing
     * key. O(1).
     *
     * Returns true if the key was added to the map, that is if it was not
     * already present.
     */
    function set(
        IERC20ToBytes32Map storage map,
        IERC20 key,
        bytes32 value
    ) internal returns (bool) {
        // We read and store the key's index to prevent multiple reads from the same storage slot
        uint256 keyIndex = map._indexes[key];

        // Equivalent to !contains(map, key)
        if (keyIndex == 0) {
            uint256 previousLength = map._length;
            map._entries[previousLength] = IERC20ToBytes32MapEntry({ _key: key, _value: value });
            map._length = previousLength + 1;

            // The entry is stored at previousLength, but we add 1 to all indexes
            // and use 0 as a sentinel value
            map._indexes[key] = previousLength + 1;
            return true;
        } else {
            map._entries[keyIndex - 1]._value = value;
            return false;
        }
    }

    /**
     * @dev Updates the value for an entry, given its key's index. The key index can be retrieved via
     * {unchecked_indexOf}, and it should be noted that key indices may change when calling {set} or {remove}. O(1).
     *
     * This function performs one less storage read than {set}, but it should only be used when `index` is known to be
     * within bounds.
     */
    function unchecked_setAt(
        IERC20ToBytes32Map storage map,
        uint256 index,
        bytes32 value
    ) internal {
        map._entries[index]._value = value;
    }

    /**
     * @dev Removes a key-value pair from a map. O(1).
     *
     * Returns true if the key was removed from the map, that is if it was present.
     */
    function remove(IERC20ToBytes32Map storage map, IERC20 key) internal returns (bool) {
        // We read and store the key's index to prevent multiple reads from the same storage slot
        uint256 keyIndex = map._indexes[key];

        // Equivalent to contains(map, key)
        if (keyIndex != 0) {
            // To delete a key-value pair from the _entries pseudo-array in O(1), we swap the entry to delete with the
            // one at the highest index, and then remove this last entry (sometimes called as 'swap and pop').
            // This modifies the order of the pseudo-array, as noted in {at}.

            uint256 toDeleteIndex = keyIndex - 1;
            uint256 lastIndex = map._length - 1;

            // When the entry to delete is the last one, the swap operation is unnecessary. However, since this occurs
            // so rarely, we still do the swap anyway to avoid the gas cost of adding an 'if' statement.

            IERC20ToBytes32MapEntry storage lastEntry = map._entries[lastIndex];

            // Move the last entry to the index where the entry to delete is
            map._entries[toDeleteIndex] = lastEntry;
            // Update the index for the moved entry
            map._indexes[lastEntry._key] = toDeleteIndex + 1; // All indexes are 1-based

            // Delete the slot where the moved entry was stored
            delete map._entries[lastIndex];
            map._length = lastIndex;

            // Delete the index for the deleted slot
            delete map._indexes[key];

            return true;
        } else {
            return false;
        }
    }

    /**
     * @dev Returns true if the key is in the map. O(1).
     */
    function contains(IERC20ToBytes32Map storage map, IERC20 key) internal view returns (bool) {
        return map._indexes[key] != 0;
    }

    /**
     * @dev Returns the number of key-value pairs in the map. O(1).
     */
    function length(IERC20ToBytes32Map storage map) internal view returns (uint256) {
        return map._length;
    }

    /**
     * @dev Returns the key-value pair stored at position `index` in the map. O(1).
     *
     * Note that there are no guarantees on the ordering of entries inside the
     * array, and it may change when more entries are added or removed.
     *
     * Requirements:
     *
     * - `index` must be strictly less than {length}.
     */
    function at(IERC20ToBytes32Map storage map, uint256 index) internal view returns (IERC20, bytes32) {
        _require(map._length > index, Errors.OUT_OF_BOUNDS);
        return unchecked_at(map, index);
    }

    /**
     * @dev Same as {at}, except this doesn't revert if `index` it outside of the map (i.e. if it is equal or larger
     * than {length}). O(1).
     *
     * This function performs one less storage read than {at}, but should only be used when `index` is known to be
     * within bounds.
     */
    function unchecked_at(IERC20ToBytes32Map storage map, uint256 index) internal view returns (IERC20, bytes32) {
        IERC20ToBytes32MapEntry storage entry = map._entries[index];
        return (entry._key, entry._value);
    }

    /**
     * @dev Same as {unchecked_At}, except it only returns the value and not the key (performing one less storage
     * read). O(1).
     */
    function unchecked_valueAt(IERC20ToBytes32Map storage map, uint256 index) internal view returns (bytes32) {
        return map._entries[index]._value;
    }

    /**
     * @dev Returns the value associated with `key`. O(1).
     *
     * Requirements:
     *
     * - `key` must be in the map. Reverts with `errorCode` otherwise.
     */
    function get(
        IERC20ToBytes32Map storage map,
        IERC20 key,
        uint256 errorCode
    ) internal view returns (bytes32) {
        uint256 index = map._indexes[key];
        _require(index > 0, errorCode);
        return unchecked_valueAt(map, index - 1);
    }

    /**
     * @dev Returns the index for `key` **plus one**. Does not revert if the key is not in the map, and returns 0
     * instead.
     */
    function unchecked_indexOf(IERC20ToBytes32Map storage map, IERC20 key) internal view returns (uint256) {
        return map._indexes[key];
    }
}

File 39 of 86 : EnumerableSet.sol
// SPDX-License-Identifier: MIT

pragma solidity ^0.7.0;

import "../helpers/BalancerErrors.sol";

// Based on the EnumerableSet library from OpenZeppelin contracts, altered to remove the base private functions that
// work on bytes32, replacing them with a native implementation for address values, to reduce bytecode size and runtime
// costs.
// The `unchecked_at` function was also added, which allows for more gas efficient data reads in some scenarios.

/**
 * @dev Library for managing
 * https://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/Set_(abstract_data_type)[sets] of primitive
 * types.
 *
 * Sets have the following properties:
 *
 * - Elements are added, removed, and checked for existence in constant time
 * (O(1)).
 * - Elements are enumerated in O(n). No guarantees are made on the ordering.
 *
 * ```
 * contract Example {
 *     // Add the library methods
 *     using EnumerableSet for EnumerableSet.AddressSet;
 *
 *     // Declare a set state variable
 *     EnumerableSet.AddressSet private mySet;
 * }
 * ```
 *
 * As of v3.3.0, sets of type `bytes32` (`Bytes32Set`), `address` (`AddressSet`)
 * and `uint256` (`UintSet`) are supported.
 */
library EnumerableSet {
    // The original OpenZeppelin implementation uses a generic Set type with bytes32 values: this was replaced with
    // AddressSet, which uses address keys natively, resulting in more dense bytecode.

    struct AddressSet {
        // Storage of set values
        address[] _values;
        // Position of the value in the `values` array, plus 1 because index 0
        // means a value is not in the set.
        mapping(address => uint256) _indexes;
    }

    /**
     * @dev Add a value to a set. O(1).
     *
     * Returns true if the value was added to the set, that is if it was not
     * already present.
     */
    function add(AddressSet storage set, address value) internal returns (bool) {
        if (!contains(set, value)) {
            set._values.push(value);
            // The value is stored at length-1, but we add 1 to all indexes
            // and use 0 as a sentinel value
            set._indexes[value] = set._values.length;
            return true;
        } else {
            return false;
        }
    }

    /**
     * @dev Removes a value from a set. O(1).
     *
     * Returns true if the value was removed from the set, that is if it was
     * present.
     */
    function remove(AddressSet storage set, address value) internal returns (bool) {
        // We read and store the value's index to prevent multiple reads from the same storage slot
        uint256 valueIndex = set._indexes[value];

        if (valueIndex != 0) {
            // Equivalent to contains(set, value)
            // To delete an element from the _values array in O(1), we swap the element to delete with the last one in
            // the array, and then remove the last element (sometimes called as 'swap and pop').
            // This modifies the order of the array, as noted in {at}.

            uint256 toDeleteIndex = valueIndex - 1;
            uint256 lastIndex = set._values.length - 1;

            // When the value to delete is the last one, the swap operation is unnecessary. However, since this occurs
            // so rarely, we still do the swap anyway to avoid the gas cost of adding an 'if' statement.

            address lastValue = set._values[lastIndex];

            // Move the last value to the index where the value to delete is
            set._values[toDeleteIndex] = lastValue;
            // Update the index for the moved value
            set._indexes[lastValue] = toDeleteIndex + 1; // All indexes are 1-based

            // Delete the slot where the moved value was stored
            set._values.pop();

            // Delete the index for the deleted slot
            delete set._indexes[value];

            return true;
        } else {
            return false;
        }
    }

    /**
     * @dev Returns true if the value is in the set. O(1).
     */
    function contains(AddressSet storage set, address value) internal view returns (bool) {
        return set._indexes[value] != 0;
    }

    /**
     * @dev Returns the number of values on the set. O(1).
     */
    function length(AddressSet storage set) internal view returns (uint256) {
        return set._values.length;
    }

    /**
     * @dev Returns the value stored at position `index` in the set. O(1).
     *
     * Note that there are no guarantees on the ordering of values inside the
     * array, and it may change when more values are added or removed.
     *
     * Requirements:
     *
     * - `index` must be strictly less than {length}.
     */
    function at(AddressSet storage set, uint256 index) internal view returns (address) {
        _require(set._values.length > index, Errors.OUT_OF_BOUNDS);
        return unchecked_at(set, index);
    }

    /**
     * @dev Same as {at}, except this doesn't revert if `index` it outside of the set (i.e. if it is equal or larger
     * than {length}). O(1).
     *
     * This function performs one less storage read than {at}, but should only be used when `index` is known to be
     * within bounds.
     */
    function unchecked_at(AddressSet storage set, uint256 index) internal view returns (address) {
        return set._values[index];
    }
}

File 40 of 86 : IPoolSwapStructs.sol
// SPDX-License-Identifier: GPL-3.0-or-later
// This program is free software: you can redistribute it and/or modify
// it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
// the Free Software Foundation, either version 3 of the License, or
// (at your option) any later version.

// This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
// but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
// MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE.  See the
// GNU General Public License for more details.

// You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
// along with this program.  If not, see <http://www.gnu.org/licenses/>.

pragma solidity ^0.7.0;
pragma experimental ABIEncoderV2;

import "../../lib/openzeppelin/IERC20.sol";

import "./IVault.sol";

interface IPoolSwapStructs {
    // This is not really an interface - it just defines common structs used by other interfaces: IGeneralPool and
    // IMinimalSwapInfoPool.
    //
    // This data structure represents a request for a token swap, where `kind` indicates the swap type ('given in' or
    // 'given out') which indicates whether or not the amount sent by the pool is known.
    //
    // The pool receives `tokenIn` and sends `tokenOut`. `amount` is the number of `tokenIn` tokens the pool will take
    // in, or the number of `tokenOut` tokens the Pool will send out, depending on the given swap `kind`.
    //
    // All other fields are not strictly necessary for most swaps, but are provided to support advanced scenarios in
    // some Pools.
    //
    // `poolId` is the ID of the Pool involved in the swap - this is useful for Pool contracts that implement more than
    // one Pool.
    //
    // The meaning of `lastChangeBlock` depends on the Pool specialization:
    //  - Two Token or Minimal Swap Info: the last block in which either `tokenIn` or `tokenOut` changed its total
    //    balance.
    //  - General: the last block in which *any* of the Pool's registered tokens changed its total balance.
    //
    // `from` is the origin address for the funds the Pool receives, and `to` is the destination address
    // where the Pool sends the outgoing tokens.
    //
    // `userData` is extra data provided by the caller - typically a signature from a trusted party.
    struct SwapRequest {
        IVault.SwapKind kind;
        IERC20 tokenIn;
        IERC20 tokenOut;
        uint256 amount;
        // Misc data
        bytes32 poolId;
        uint256 lastChangeBlock;
        address from;
        address to;
        bytes userData;
    }
}

File 41 of 86 : Swaps.sol
// SPDX-License-Identifier: GPL-3.0-or-later
// This program is free software: you can redistribute it and/or modify
// it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
// the Free Software Foundation, either version 3 of the License, or
// (at your option) any later version.

// This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
// but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
// MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE.  See the
// GNU General Public License for more details.

// You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
// along with this program.  If not, see <http://www.gnu.org/licenses/>.

pragma solidity ^0.7.0;
pragma experimental ABIEncoderV2;

import "../lib/math/Math.sol";
import "../lib/helpers/BalancerErrors.sol";
import "../lib/helpers/InputHelpers.sol";
import "../lib/openzeppelin/EnumerableMap.sol";
import "../lib/openzeppelin/EnumerableSet.sol";
import "../lib/openzeppelin/IERC20.sol";
import "../lib/openzeppelin/ReentrancyGuard.sol";
import "../lib/openzeppelin/SafeCast.sol";
import "../lib/openzeppelin/SafeERC20.sol";

import "./PoolBalances.sol";
import "./interfaces/IPoolSwapStructs.sol";
import "./interfaces/IGeneralPool.sol";
import "./interfaces/IMinimalSwapInfoPool.sol";
import "./balances/BalanceAllocation.sol";

/**
 * Implements the Vault's high-level swap functionality.
 *
 * Users can swap tokens with Pools by calling the `swap` and `batchSwap` functions. They need not trust the Pool
 * contracts to do this: all security checks are made by the Vault.
 *
 * The `swap` function executes a single swap, while `batchSwap` can perform multiple swaps in sequence.
 * In each individual swap, tokens of one kind are sent from the sender to the Pool (this is the 'token in'),
 * and tokens of another kind are sent from the Pool to the recipient in exchange (this is the 'token out').
 * More complex swaps, such as one 'token in' to multiple tokens out can be achieved by batching together
 * individual swaps.
 */
abstract contract Swaps is ReentrancyGuard, PoolBalances {
    using SafeERC20 for IERC20;
    using EnumerableSet for EnumerableSet.AddressSet;
    using EnumerableMap for EnumerableMap.IERC20ToBytes32Map;

    using Math for int256;
    using Math for uint256;
    using SafeCast for uint256;
    using BalanceAllocation for bytes32;

    function swap(
        SingleSwap memory singleSwap,
        FundManagement memory funds,
        uint256 limit,
        uint256 deadline
    )
        external
        payable
        override
        nonReentrant
        whenNotPaused
        authenticateFor(funds.sender)
        returns (uint256 amountCalculated)
    {
        // The deadline is timestamp-based: it should not be relied upon for sub-minute accuracy.
        // solhint-disable-next-line not-rely-on-time
        _require(block.timestamp <= deadline, Errors.SWAP_DEADLINE);

        // This revert reason is for consistency with `batchSwap`: an equivalent `swap` performed using that function
        // would result in this error.
        _require(singleSwap.amount > 0, Errors.UNKNOWN_AMOUNT_IN_FIRST_SWAP);

        IERC20 tokenIn = _translateToIERC20(singleSwap.assetIn);
        IERC20 tokenOut = _translateToIERC20(singleSwap.assetOut);
        _require(tokenIn != tokenOut, Errors.CANNOT_SWAP_SAME_TOKEN);

        // Initializing each struct field one-by-one uses less gas than setting all at once.
        IPoolSwapStructs.SwapRequest memory poolRequest;
        poolRequest.poolId = singleSwap.poolId;
        poolRequest.kind = singleSwap.kind;
        poolRequest.tokenIn = tokenIn;
        poolRequest.tokenOut = tokenOut;
        poolRequest.amount = singleSwap.amount;
        poolRequest.userData = singleSwap.userData;
        poolRequest.from = funds.sender;
        poolRequest.to = funds.recipient;
        // The lastChangeBlock field is left uninitialized.

        uint256 amountIn;
        uint256 amountOut;

        (amountCalculated, amountIn, amountOut) = _swapWithPool(poolRequest);
        _require(singleSwap.kind == SwapKind.GIVEN_IN ? amountOut >= limit : amountIn <= limit, Errors.SWAP_LIMIT);

        _receiveAsset(singleSwap.assetIn, amountIn, funds.sender, funds.fromInternalBalance);
        _sendAsset(singleSwap.assetOut, amountOut, funds.recipient, funds.toInternalBalance);

        // If the asset in is ETH, then `amountIn` ETH was wrapped into WETH.
        _handleRemainingEth(_isETH(singleSwap.assetIn) ? amountIn : 0);
    }

    function batchSwap(
        SwapKind kind,
        BatchSwapStep[] memory swaps,
        IAsset[] memory assets,
        FundManagement memory funds,
        int256[] memory limits,
        uint256 deadline
    )
        external
        payable
        override
        nonReentrant
        whenNotPaused
        authenticateFor(funds.sender)
        returns (int256[] memory assetDeltas)
    {
        // The deadline is timestamp-based: it should not be relied upon for sub-minute accuracy.
        // solhint-disable-next-line not-rely-on-time
        _require(block.timestamp <= deadline, Errors.SWAP_DEADLINE);

        InputHelpers.ensureInputLengthMatch(assets.length, limits.length);

        // Perform the swaps, updating the Pool token balances and computing the net Vault asset deltas.
        assetDeltas = _swapWithPools(swaps, assets, funds, kind);

        // Process asset deltas, by either transferring assets from the sender (for positive deltas) or to the recipient
        // (for negative deltas).
        uint256 wrappedEth = 0;
        for (uint256 i = 0; i < assets.length; ++i) {
            IAsset asset = assets[i];
            int256 delta = assetDeltas[i];
            _require(delta <= limits[i], Errors.SWAP_LIMIT);

            if (delta > 0) {
                uint256 toReceive = uint256(delta);
                _receiveAsset(asset, toReceive, funds.sender, funds.fromInternalBalance);

                if (_isETH(asset)) {
                    wrappedEth = wrappedEth.add(toReceive);
                }
            } else if (delta < 0) {
                uint256 toSend = uint256(-delta);
                _sendAsset(asset, toSend, funds.recipient, funds.toInternalBalance);
            }
        }

        // Handle any used and remaining ETH.
        _handleRemainingEth(wrappedEth);
    }

    // For `_swapWithPools` to handle both 'given in' and 'given out' swaps, it internally tracks the 'given' amount
    // (supplied by the caller), and the 'calculated' amount (returned by the Pool in response to the swap request).

    /**
     * @dev Given the two swap tokens and the swap kind, returns which one is the 'given' token (the token whose
     * amount is supplied by the caller).
     */
    function _tokenGiven(
        SwapKind kind,
        IERC20 tokenIn,
        IERC20 tokenOut
    ) private pure returns (IERC20) {
        return kind == SwapKind.GIVEN_IN ? tokenIn : tokenOut;
    }

    /**
     * @dev Given the two swap tokens and the swap kind, returns which one is the 'calculated' token (the token whose
     * amount is calculated by the Pool).
     */
    function _tokenCalculated(
        SwapKind kind,
        IERC20 tokenIn,
        IERC20 tokenOut
    ) private pure returns (IERC20) {
        return kind == SwapKind.GIVEN_IN ? tokenOut : tokenIn;
    }

    /**
     * @dev Returns an ordered pair (amountIn, amountOut) given the 'given' and 'calculated' amounts, and the swap kind.
     */
    function _getAmounts(
        SwapKind kind,
        uint256 amountGiven,
        uint256 amountCalculated
    ) private pure returns (uint256 amountIn, uint256 amountOut) {
        if (kind == SwapKind.GIVEN_IN) {
            (amountIn, amountOut) = (amountGiven, amountCalculated);
        } else {
            // SwapKind.GIVEN_OUT
            (amountIn, amountOut) = (amountCalculated, amountGiven);
        }
    }

    /**
     * @dev Performs all `swaps`, calling swap hooks on the Pool contracts and updating their balances. Does not cause
     * any transfer of tokens - instead it returns the net Vault token deltas: positive if the Vault should receive
     * tokens, and negative if it should send them.
     */
    function _swapWithPools(
        BatchSwapStep[] memory swaps,
        IAsset[] memory assets,
        FundManagement memory funds,
        SwapKind kind
    ) private returns (int256[] memory assetDeltas) {
        assetDeltas = new int256[](assets.length);

        // These variables could be declared inside the loop, but that causes the compiler to allocate memory on each
        // loop iteration, increasing gas costs.
        BatchSwapStep memory batchSwapStep;
        IPoolSwapStructs.SwapRequest memory poolRequest;

        // These store data about the previous swap here to implement multihop logic across swaps.
        IERC20 previousTokenCalculated;
        uint256 previousAmountCalculated;

        for (uint256 i = 0; i < swaps.length; ++i) {
            batchSwapStep = swaps[i];

            bool withinBounds = batchSwapStep.assetInIndex < assets.length &&
                batchSwapStep.assetOutIndex < assets.length;
            _require(withinBounds, Errors.OUT_OF_BOUNDS);

            IERC20 tokenIn = _translateToIERC20(assets[batchSwapStep.assetInIndex]);
            IERC20 tokenOut = _translateToIERC20(assets[batchSwapStep.assetOutIndex]);
            _require(tokenIn != tokenOut, Errors.CANNOT_SWAP_SAME_TOKEN);

            // Sentinel value for multihop logic
            if (batchSwapStep.amount == 0) {
                // When the amount given is zero, we use the calculated amount for the previous swap, as long as the
                // current swap's given token is the previous calculated token. This makes it possible to swap a
                // given amount of token A for token B, and then use the resulting token B amount to swap for token C.
                _require(i > 0, Errors.UNKNOWN_AMOUNT_IN_FIRST_SWAP);
                bool usingPreviousToken = previousTokenCalculated == _tokenGiven(kind, tokenIn, tokenOut);
                _require(usingPreviousToken, Errors.MALCONSTRUCTED_MULTIHOP_SWAP);
                batchSwapStep.amount = previousAmountCalculated;
            }

            // Initializing each struct field one-by-one uses less gas than setting all at once
            poolRequest.poolId = batchSwapStep.poolId;
            poolRequest.kind = kind;
            poolRequest.tokenIn = tokenIn;
            poolRequest.tokenOut = tokenOut;
            poolRequest.amount = batchSwapStep.amount;
            poolRequest.userData = batchSwapStep.userData;
            poolRequest.from = funds.sender;
            poolRequest.to = funds.recipient;
            // The lastChangeBlock field is left uninitialized

            uint256 amountIn;
            uint256 amountOut;
            (previousAmountCalculated, amountIn, amountOut) = _swapWithPool(poolRequest);

            previousTokenCalculated = _tokenCalculated(kind, tokenIn, tokenOut);

            // Accumulate Vault deltas across swaps
            assetDeltas[batchSwapStep.assetInIndex] = assetDeltas[batchSwapStep.assetInIndex].add(amountIn.toInt256());
            assetDeltas[batchSwapStep.assetOutIndex] = assetDeltas[batchSwapStep.assetOutIndex].sub(
                amountOut.toInt256()
            );
        }
    }

    /**
     * @dev Performs a swap according to the parameters specified in `request`, calling the Pool's contract hook and
     * updating the Pool's balance.
     *
     * Returns the amount of tokens going into or out of the Vault as a result of this swap, depending on the swap kind.
     */
    function _swapWithPool(IPoolSwapStructs.SwapRequest memory request)
        private
        returns (
            uint256 amountCalculated,
            uint256 amountIn,
            uint256 amountOut
        )
    {
        // Get the calculated amount from the Pool and update its balances
        address pool = _getPoolAddress(request.poolId);
        PoolSpecialization specialization = _getPoolSpecialization(request.poolId);

        if (specialization == PoolSpecialization.TWO_TOKEN) {
            amountCalculated = _processTwoTokenPoolSwapRequest(request, IMinimalSwapInfoPool(pool));
        } else if (specialization == PoolSpecialization.MINIMAL_SWAP_INFO) {
            amountCalculated = _processMinimalSwapInfoPoolSwapRequest(request, IMinimalSwapInfoPool(pool));
        } else {
            // PoolSpecialization.GENERAL
            amountCalculated = _processGeneralPoolSwapRequest(request, IGeneralPool(pool));
        }

        (amountIn, amountOut) = _getAmounts(request.kind, request.amount, amountCalculated);
        emit Swap(request.poolId, request.tokenIn, request.tokenOut, amountIn, amountOut);
    }

    function _processTwoTokenPoolSwapRequest(IPoolSwapStructs.SwapRequest memory request, IMinimalSwapInfoPool pool)
        private
        returns (uint256 amountCalculated)
    {
        // For gas efficiency reasons, this function uses low-level knowledge of how Two Token Pool balances are
        // stored internally, instead of using getters and setters for all operations.

        (
            bytes32 tokenABalance,
            bytes32 tokenBBalance,
            TwoTokenPoolBalances storage poolBalances
        ) = _getTwoTokenPoolSharedBalances(request.poolId, request.tokenIn, request.tokenOut);

        // We have the two Pool balances, but we don't know which one is 'token in' or 'token out'.
        bytes32 tokenInBalance;
        bytes32 tokenOutBalance;

        // In Two Token Pools, token A has a smaller address than token B
        if (request.tokenIn < request.tokenOut) {
            // in is A, out is B
            tokenInBalance = tokenABalance;
            tokenOutBalance = tokenBBalance;
        } else {
            // in is B, out is A
            tokenOutBalance = tokenABalance;
            tokenInBalance = tokenBBalance;
        }

        // Perform the swap request and compute the new balances for 'token in' and 'token out' after the swap
        (tokenInBalance, tokenOutBalance, amountCalculated) = _callMinimalSwapInfoPoolOnSwapHook(
            request,
            pool,
            tokenInBalance,
            tokenOutBalance
        );

        // We check the token ordering again to create the new shared cash packed struct
        poolBalances.sharedCash = request.tokenIn < request.tokenOut
            ? BalanceAllocation.toSharedCash(tokenInBalance, tokenOutBalance) // in is A, out is B
            : BalanceAllocation.toSharedCash(tokenOutBalance, tokenInBalance); // in is B, out is A
    }

    function _processMinimalSwapInfoPoolSwapRequest(
        IPoolSwapStructs.SwapRequest memory request,
        IMinimalSwapInfoPool pool
    ) private returns (uint256 amountCalculated) {
        bytes32 tokenInBalance = _getMinimalSwapInfoPoolBalance(request.poolId, request.tokenIn);
        bytes32 tokenOutBalance = _getMinimalSwapInfoPoolBalance(request.poolId, request.tokenOut);

        // Perform the swap request and compute the new balances for 'token in' and 'token out' after the swap
        (tokenInBalance, tokenOutBalance, amountCalculated) = _callMinimalSwapInfoPoolOnSwapHook(
            request,
            pool,
            tokenInBalance,
            tokenOutBalance
        );

        _minimalSwapInfoPoolsBalances[request.poolId][request.tokenIn] = tokenInBalance;
        _minimalSwapInfoPoolsBalances[request.poolId][request.tokenOut] = tokenOutBalance;
    }

    /**
     * @dev Calls the onSwap hook for a Pool that implements IMinimalSwapInfoPool: both Minimal Swap Info and Two Token
     * Pools do this.
     */
    function _callMinimalSwapInfoPoolOnSwapHook(
        IPoolSwapStructs.SwapRequest memory request,
        IMinimalSwapInfoPool pool,
        bytes32 tokenInBalance,
        bytes32 tokenOutBalance
    )
        internal
        returns (
            bytes32 newTokenInBalance,
            bytes32 newTokenOutBalance,
            uint256 amountCalculated
        )
    {
        uint256 tokenInTotal = tokenInBalance.total();
        uint256 tokenOutTotal = tokenOutBalance.total();
        request.lastChangeBlock = Math.max(tokenInBalance.lastChangeBlock(), tokenOutBalance.lastChangeBlock());

        // Perform the swap request callback, and compute the new balances for 'token in' and 'token out' after the swap
        amountCalculated = pool.onSwap(request, tokenInTotal, tokenOutTotal);
        (uint256 amountIn, uint256 amountOut) = _getAmounts(request.kind, request.amount, amountCalculated);

        newTokenInBalance = tokenInBalance.increaseCash(amountIn);
        newTokenOutBalance = tokenOutBalance.decreaseCash(amountOut);
    }

    function _processGeneralPoolSwapRequest(IPoolSwapStructs.SwapRequest memory request, IGeneralPool pool)
        private
        returns (uint256 amountCalculated)
    {
        bytes32 tokenInBalance;
        bytes32 tokenOutBalance;

        // We access both token indexes without checking existence, because we will do it manually immediately after.
        EnumerableMap.IERC20ToBytes32Map storage poolBalances = _generalPoolsBalances[request.poolId];
        uint256 indexIn = poolBalances.unchecked_indexOf(request.tokenIn);
        uint256 indexOut = poolBalances.unchecked_indexOf(request.tokenOut);

        if (indexIn == 0 || indexOut == 0) {
            // The tokens might not be registered because the Pool itself is not registered. We check this to provide a
            // more accurate revert reason.
            _ensureRegisteredPool(request.poolId);
            _revert(Errors.TOKEN_NOT_REGISTERED);
        }

        // EnumerableMap stores indices *plus one* to use the zero index as a sentinel value - because these are valid,
        // we can undo this.
        indexIn -= 1;
        indexOut -= 1;

        uint256 tokenAmount = poolBalances.length();
        uint256[] memory currentBalances = new uint256[](tokenAmount);

        request.lastChangeBlock = 0;
        for (uint256 i = 0; i < tokenAmount; i++) {
            // Because the iteration is bounded by `tokenAmount`, and no tokens are registered or deregistered here, we
            // know `i` is a valid token index and can use `unchecked_valueAt` to save storage reads.
            bytes32 balance = poolBalances.unchecked_valueAt(i);

            currentBalances[i] = balance.total();
            request.lastChangeBlock = Math.max(request.lastChangeBlock, balance.lastChangeBlock());

            if (i == indexIn) {
                tokenInBalance = balance;
            } else if (i == indexOut) {
                tokenOutBalance = balance;
            }
        }

        // Perform the swap request callback and compute the new balances for 'token in' and 'token out' after the swap
        amountCalculated = pool.onSwap(request, currentBalances, indexIn, indexOut);
        (uint256 amountIn, uint256 amountOut) = _getAmounts(request.kind, request.amount, amountCalculated);
        tokenInBalance = tokenInBalance.increaseCash(amountIn);
        tokenOutBalance = tokenOutBalance.decreaseCash(amountOut);

        // Because no tokens were registered or deregistered between now or when we retrieved the indexes for
        // 'token in' and 'token out', we can use `unchecked_setAt` to save storage reads.
        poolBalances.unchecked_setAt(indexIn, tokenInBalance);
        poolBalances.unchecked_setAt(indexOut, tokenOutBalance);
    }

    // This function is not marked as `nonReentrant` because the underlying mechanism relies on reentrancy
    function queryBatchSwap(
        SwapKind kind,
        BatchSwapStep[] memory swaps,
        IAsset[] memory assets,
        FundManagement memory funds
    ) external override returns (int256[] memory) {
        // In order to accurately 'simulate' swaps, this function actually does perform the swaps, including calling the
        // Pool hooks and updating balances in storage. However, once it computes the final Vault Deltas, it
        // reverts unconditionally, returning this array as the revert data.
        //
        // By wrapping this reverting call, we can decode the deltas 'returned' and return them as a normal Solidity
        // function would. The only caveat is the function becomes non-view, but off-chain clients can still call it
        // via eth_call to get the expected result.
        //
        // This technique was inspired by the work from the Gnosis team in the Gnosis Safe contract:
        // https://github.com/gnosis/safe-contracts/blob/v1.2.0/contracts/GnosisSafe.sol#L265
        //
        // Most of this function is implemented using inline assembly, as the actual work it needs to do is not
        // significant, and Solidity is not particularly well-suited to generate this behavior, resulting in a large
        // amount of generated bytecode.

        if (msg.sender != address(this)) {
            // We perform an external call to ourselves, forwarding the same calldata. In this call, the else clause of
            // the preceding if statement will be executed instead.

            // solhint-disable-next-line avoid-low-level-calls
            (bool success, ) = address(this).call(msg.data);

            // solhint-disable-next-line no-inline-assembly
            assembly {
                // This call should always revert to decode the actual asset deltas from the revert reason
                switch success
                    case 0 {
                        // Note we are manually writing the memory slot 0. We can safely overwrite whatever is
                        // stored there as we take full control of the execution and then immediately return.

                        // We copy the first 4 bytes to check if it matches with the expected signature, otherwise
                        // there was another revert reason and we should forward it.
                        returndatacopy(0, 0, 0x04)
                        let error := and(mload(0), 0xffffffff00000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000)

                        // If the first 4 bytes don't match with the expected signature, we forward the revert reason.
                        if eq(eq(error, 0xfa61cc1200000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000), 0) {
                            returndatacopy(0, 0, returndatasize())
                            revert(0, returndatasize())
                        }

                        // The returndata contains the signature, followed by the raw memory representation of an array:
                        // length + data. We need to return an ABI-encoded representation of this array.
                        // An ABI-encoded array contains an additional field when compared to its raw memory
                        // representation: an offset to the location of the length. The offset itself is 32 bytes long,
                        // so the smallest value we  can use is 32 for the data to be located immediately after it.
                        mstore(0, 32)

                        // We now copy the raw memory array from returndata into memory. Since the offset takes up 32
                        // bytes, we start copying at address 0x20. We also get rid of the error signature, which takes
                        // the first four bytes of returndata.
                        let size := sub(returndatasize(), 0x04)
                        returndatacopy(0x20, 0x04, size)

                        // We finally return the ABI-encoded array, which has a total length equal to that of the array
                        // (returndata), plus the 32 bytes for the offset.
                        return(0, add(size, 32))
                    }
                    default {
                        // This call should always revert, but we fail nonetheless if that didn't happen
                        invalid()
                    }
            }
        } else {
            int256[] memory deltas = _swapWithPools(swaps, assets, funds, kind);

            // solhint-disable-next-line no-inline-assembly
            assembly {
                // We will return a raw representation of the array in memory, which is composed of a 32 byte length,
                // followed by the 32 byte int256 values. Because revert expects a size in bytes, we multiply the array
                // length (stored at `deltas`) by 32.
                let size := mul(mload(deltas), 32)

                // We send one extra value for the error signature "QueryError(int256[])" which is 0xfa61cc12.
                // We store it in the previous slot to the `deltas` array. We know there will be at least one available
                // slot due to how the memory scratch space works.
                // We can safely overwrite whatever is stored in this slot as we will revert immediately after that.
                mstore(sub(deltas, 0x20), 0x00000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000fa61cc12)
                let start := sub(deltas, 0x04)

                // When copying from `deltas` into returndata, we copy an additional 36 bytes to also return the array's
                // length and the error signature.
                revert(start, add(size, 36))
            }
        }
    }
}

File 42 of 86 : IGeneralPool.sol
// SPDX-License-Identifier: GPL-3.0-or-later
// This program is free software: you can redistribute it and/or modify
// it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
// the Free Software Foundation, either version 3 of the License, or
// (at your option) any later version.

// This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
// but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
// MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE.  See the
// GNU General Public License for more details.

// You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
// along with this program.  If not, see <http://www.gnu.org/licenses/>.

pragma solidity ^0.7.0;
pragma experimental ABIEncoderV2;

import "./IBasePool.sol";

/**
 * @dev IPools with the General specialization setting should implement this interface.
 *
 * This is called by the Vault when a user calls `IVault.swap` or `IVault.batchSwap` to swap with this Pool.
 * Returns the number of tokens the Pool will grant to the user in a 'given in' swap, or that the user will
 * grant to the pool in a 'given out' swap.
 *
 * This can often be implemented by a `view` function, since many pricing algorithms don't need to track state
 * changes in swaps. However, contracts implementing this in non-view functions should check that the caller is
 * indeed the Vault.
 */
interface IGeneralPool is IBasePool {
    function onSwap(
        SwapRequest memory swapRequest,
        uint256[] memory balances,
        uint256 indexIn,
        uint256 indexOut
    ) external returns (uint256 amount);
}

File 43 of 86 : IMinimalSwapInfoPool.sol
// SPDX-License-Identifier: GPL-3.0-or-later
// This program is free software: you can redistribute it and/or modify
// it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
// the Free Software Foundation, either version 3 of the License, or
// (at your option) any later version.

// This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
// but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
// MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE.  See the
// GNU General Public License for more details.

// You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
// along with this program.  If not, see <http://www.gnu.org/licenses/>.

pragma solidity ^0.7.0;
pragma experimental ABIEncoderV2;

import "./IBasePool.sol";

/**
 * @dev Pool contracts with the MinimalSwapInfo or TwoToken specialization settings should implement this interface.
 *
 * This is called by the Vault when a user calls `IVault.swap` or `IVault.batchSwap` to swap with this Pool.
 * Returns the number of tokens the Pool will grant to the user in a 'given in' swap, or that the user will grant
 * to the pool in a 'given out' swap.
 *
 * This can often be implemented by a `view` function, since many pricing algorithms don't need to track state
 * changes in swaps. However, contracts implementing this in non-view functions should check that the caller is
 * indeed the Vault.
 */
interface IMinimalSwapInfoPool is IBasePool {
    function onSwap(
        SwapRequest memory swapRequest,
        uint256 currentBalanceTokenIn,
        uint256 currentBalanceTokenOut
    ) external returns (uint256 amount);
}

File 44 of 86 : FlashLoans.sol
// SPDX-License-Identifier: GPL-3.0-or-later
// This program is free software: you can redistribute it and/or modify
// it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
// the Free Software Foundation, either version 3 of the License, or
// (at your option) any later version.

// This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
// but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
// MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE.  See the
// GNU General Public License for more details.

// You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
// along with this program.  If not, see <http://www.gnu.org/licenses/>.

// This flash loan provider was based on the Aave protocol's open source
// implementation and terminology and interfaces are intentionally kept
// similar

pragma solidity ^0.7.0;
pragma experimental ABIEncoderV2;

import "../lib/helpers/BalancerErrors.sol";
import "../lib/openzeppelin/IERC20.sol";
import "../lib/openzeppelin/ReentrancyGuard.sol";
import "../lib/openzeppelin/SafeERC20.sol";

import "./Fees.sol";
import "./interfaces/IFlashLoanRecipient.sol";

/**
 * @dev Handles Flash Loans through the Vault. Calls the `receiveFlashLoan` hook on the flash loan recipient
 * contract, which implements the `IFlashLoanRecipient` interface.
 */
abstract contract FlashLoans is Fees, ReentrancyGuard, TemporarilyPausable {
    using SafeERC20 for IERC20;

    function flashLoan(
        IFlashLoanRecipient recipient,
        IERC20[] memory tokens,
        uint256[] memory amounts,
        bytes memory userData
    ) external override nonReentrant whenNotPaused {
        InputHelpers.ensureInputLengthMatch(tokens.length, amounts.length);

        uint256[] memory feeAmounts = new uint256[](tokens.length);
        uint256[] memory preLoanBalances = new uint256[](tokens.length);

        // Used to ensure `tokens` is sorted in ascending order, which ensures token uniqueness.
        IERC20 previousToken = IERC20(0);

        for (uint256 i = 0; i < tokens.length; ++i) {
            IERC20 token = tokens[i];
            uint256 amount = amounts[i];

            _require(token > previousToken, token == IERC20(0) ? Errors.ZERO_TOKEN : Errors.UNSORTED_TOKENS);
            previousToken = token;

            preLoanBalances[i] = token.balanceOf(address(this));
            feeAmounts[i] = _calculateFlashLoanFeeAmount(amount);

            _require(preLoanBalances[i] >= amount, Errors.INSUFFICIENT_FLASH_LOAN_BALANCE);
            token.safeTransfer(address(recipient), amount);
        }

        recipient.receiveFlashLoan(tokens, amounts, feeAmounts, userData);

        for (uint256 i = 0; i < tokens.length; ++i) {
            IERC20 token = tokens[i];
            uint256 preLoanBalance = preLoanBalances[i];

            // Checking for loan repayment first (without accounting for fees) makes for simpler debugging, and results
            // in more accurate revert reasons if the flash loan protocol fee percentage is zero.
            uint256 postLoanBalance = token.balanceOf(address(this));
            _require(postLoanBalance >= preLoanBalance, Errors.INVALID_POST_LOAN_BALANCE);

            // No need for checked arithmetic since we know the loan was fully repaid.
            uint256 receivedFeeAmount = postLoanBalance - preLoanBalance;
            _require(receivedFeeAmount >= feeAmounts[i], Errors.INSUFFICIENT_FLASH_LOAN_FEE_AMOUNT);

            _payFeeAmount(token, receivedFeeAmount);
            emit FlashLoan(recipient, token, amounts[i], receivedFeeAmount);
        }
    }
}

File 45 of 86 : MockFlashLoanRecipient.sol
// SPDX-License-Identifier: GPL-3.0-or-later
// This program is free software: you can redistribute it and/or modify
// it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
// the Free Software Foundation, either version 3 of the License, or
// (at your option) any later version.

// This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
// but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
// MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE.  See the
// GNU General Public License for more details.

// You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
// along with this program.  If not, see <http://www.gnu.org/licenses/>.

pragma solidity ^0.7.0;

import "../lib/math/Math.sol";
import "../lib/openzeppelin/IERC20.sol";
import "../lib/openzeppelin/SafeERC20.sol";

import "../vault/interfaces/IFlashLoanRecipient.sol";
import "../vault/interfaces/IVault.sol";

import "./TestToken.sol";

contract MockFlashLoanRecipient is IFlashLoanRecipient {
    using Math for uint256;
    using SafeERC20 for IERC20;

    address public immutable vault;
    bool public repayLoan;
    bool public repayInExcess;
    bool public reenter;

    constructor(address _vault) {
        vault = _vault;
        repayLoan = true;
        repayInExcess = false;
        reenter = false;
    }

    function setRepayLoan(bool _repayLoan) public {
        repayLoan = _repayLoan;
    }

    function setRepayInExcess(bool _repayInExcess) public {
        repayInExcess = _repayInExcess;
    }

    function setReenter(bool _reenter) public {
        reenter = _reenter;
    }

    // Repays loan unless setRepayLoan was called with 'false'
    function receiveFlashLoan(
        IERC20[] memory tokens,
        uint256[] memory amounts,
        uint256[] memory feeAmounts,
        bytes memory userData
    ) external override {
        for (uint256 i = 0; i < tokens.length; ++i) {
            IERC20 token = tokens[i];
            uint256 amount = amounts[i];
            uint256 feeAmount = feeAmounts[i];

            require(token.balanceOf(address(this)) == amount, "INVALID_FLASHLOAN_BALANCE");

            if (reenter) {
                IVault(msg.sender).flashLoan(IFlashLoanRecipient(address(this)), tokens, amounts, userData);
            }

            TestToken(address(token)).mint(address(this), repayInExcess ? feeAmount.add(1) : feeAmount);

            uint256 totalDebt = amount.add(feeAmount);

            if (!repayLoan) {
                totalDebt = totalDebt.sub(1);
            } else if (repayInExcess) {
                totalDebt = totalDebt.add(1);
            }

            token.safeTransfer(vault, totalDebt);
        }
    }
}

File 46 of 86 : TestToken.sol
// SPDX-License-Identifier: GPL-3.0-or-later
// This program is free software: you can redistribute it and/or modify
// it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
// the Free Software Foundation, either version 3 of the License, or
// (at your option) any later version.

// This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
// but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
// MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE.  See the
// GNU General Public License for more details.

// You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
// along with this program.  If not, see <http://www.gnu.org/licenses/>.

pragma solidity ^0.7.0;

import "../lib/openzeppelin/ERC20.sol";
import "../lib/openzeppelin/ERC20Burnable.sol";
import "../lib/openzeppelin/AccessControl.sol";

contract TestToken is AccessControl, ERC20, ERC20Burnable {
    bytes32 public constant MINTER_ROLE = keccak256("MINTER_ROLE");

    constructor(
        address admin,
        string memory name,
        string memory symbol,
        uint8 decimals
    ) ERC20(name, symbol) {
        _setupDecimals(decimals);
        _setupRole(DEFAULT_ADMIN_ROLE, admin);
        _setupRole(MINTER_ROLE, admin);
    }

    function mint(address recipient, uint256 amount) external {
        require(hasRole(MINTER_ROLE, msg.sender), "NOT_MINTER");
        _mint(recipient, amount);
    }
}

File 47 of 86 : ERC20.sol
// SPDX-License-Identifier: MIT

pragma solidity ^0.7.0;

import "../helpers/BalancerErrors.sol";

import "./IERC20.sol";
import "./SafeMath.sol";

/**
 * @dev Implementation of the {IERC20} interface.
 *
 * This implementation is agnostic to the way tokens are created. This means
 * that a supply mechanism has to be added in a derived contract using {_mint}.
 * For a generic mechanism see {ERC20PresetMinterPauser}.
 *
 * TIP: For a detailed writeup see our guide
 * https://forum.zeppelin.solutions/t/how-to-implement-erc20-supply-mechanisms/226[How
 * to implement supply mechanisms].
 *
 * We have followed general OpenZeppelin guidelines: functions revert instead
 * of returning `false` on failure. This behavior is nonetheless conventional
 * and does not conflict with the expectations of ERC20 applications.
 *
 * Additionally, an {Approval} event is emitted on calls to {transferFrom}.
 * This allows applications to reconstruct the allowance for all accounts just
 * by listening to said events. Other implementations of the EIP may not emit
 * these events, as it isn't required by the specification.
 *
 * Finally, the non-standard {decreaseAllowance} and {increaseAllowance}
 * functions have been added to mitigate the well-known issues around setting
 * allowances. See {IERC20-approve}.
 */
contract ERC20 is IERC20 {
    using SafeMath for uint256;

    mapping(address => uint256) private _balances;

    mapping(address => mapping(address => uint256)) private _allowances;

    uint256 private _totalSupply;

    string private _name;
    string private _symbol;
    uint8 private _decimals;

    /**
     * @dev Sets the values for {name} and {symbol}, initializes {decimals} with
     * a default value of 18.
     *
     * To select a different value for {decimals}, use {_setupDecimals}.
     *
     * All three of these values are immutable: they can only be set once during
     * construction.
     */
    constructor(string memory name_, string memory symbol_) {
        _name = name_;
        _symbol = symbol_;
        _decimals = 18;
    }

    /**
     * @dev Returns the name of the token.
     */
    function name() public view returns (string memory) {
        return _name;
    }

    /**
     * @dev Returns the symbol of the token, usually a shorter version of the
     * name.
     */
    function symbol() public view returns (string memory) {
        return _symbol;
    }

    /**
     * @dev Returns the number of decimals used to get its user representation.
     * For example, if `decimals` equals `2`, a balance of `505` tokens should
     * be displayed to a user as `5,05` (`505 / 10 ** 2`).
     *
     * Tokens usually opt for a value of 18, imitating the relationship between
     * Ether and Wei. This is the value {ERC20} uses, unless {_setupDecimals} is
     * called.
     *
     * NOTE: This information is only used for _display_ purposes: it in
     * no way affects any of the arithmetic of the contract, including
     * {IERC20-balanceOf} and {IERC20-transfer}.
     */
    function decimals() public view returns (uint8) {
        return _decimals;
    }

    /**
     * @dev See {IERC20-totalSupply}.
     */
    function totalSupply() public view override returns (uint256) {
        return _totalSupply;
    }

    /**
     * @dev See {IERC20-balanceOf}.
     */
    function balanceOf(address account) public view override returns (uint256) {
        return _balances[account];
    }

    /**
     * @dev See {IERC20-transfer}.
     *
     * Requirements:
     *
     * - `recipient` cannot be the zero address.
     * - the caller must have a balance of at least `amount`.
     */
    function transfer(address recipient, uint256 amount) public virtual override returns (bool) {
        _transfer(msg.sender, recipient, amount);
        return true;
    }

    /**
     * @dev See {IERC20-allowance}.
     */
    function allowance(address owner, address spender) public view virtual override returns (uint256) {
        return _allowances[owner][spender];
    }

    /**
     * @dev See {IERC20-approve}.
     *
     * Requirements:
     *
     * - `spender` cannot be the zero address.
     */
    function approve(address spender, uint256 amount) public virtual override returns (bool) {
        _approve(msg.sender, spender, amount);
        return true;
    }

    /**
     * @dev See {IERC20-transferFrom}.
     *
     * Emits an {Approval} event indicating the updated allowance. This is not
     * required by the EIP. See the note at the beginning of {ERC20}.
     *
     * Requirements:
     *
     * - `sender` and `recipient` cannot be the zero address.
     * - `sender` must have a balance of at least `amount`.
     * - the caller must have allowance for ``sender``'s tokens of at least
     * `amount`.
     */
    function transferFrom(
        address sender,
        address recipient,
        uint256 amount
    ) public virtual override returns (bool) {
        _transfer(sender, recipient, amount);
        _approve(
            sender,
            msg.sender,
            _allowances[sender][msg.sender].sub(amount, Errors.ERC20_TRANSFER_EXCEEDS_ALLOWANCE)
        );
        return true;
    }

    /**
     * @dev Atomically increases the allowance granted to `spender` by the caller.
     *
     * This is an alternative to {approve} that can be used as a mitigation for
     * problems described in {IERC20-approve}.
     *
     * Emits an {Approval} event indicating the updated allowance.
     *
     * Requirements:
     *
     * - `spender` cannot be the zero address.
     */
    function increaseAllowance(address spender, uint256 addedValue) public virtual returns (bool) {
        _approve(msg.sender, spender, _allowances[msg.sender][spender].add(addedValue));
        return true;
    }

    /**
     * @dev Atomically decreases the allowance granted to `spender` by the caller.
     *
     * This is an alternative to {approve} that can be used as a mitigation for
     * problems described in {IERC20-approve}.
     *
     * Emits an {Approval} event indicating the updated allowance.
     *
     * Requirements:
     *
     * - `spender` cannot be the zero address.
     * - `spender` must have allowance for the caller of at least
     * `subtractedValue`.
     */
    function decreaseAllowance(address spender, uint256 subtractedValue) public virtual returns (bool) {
        _approve(
            msg.sender,
            spender,
            _allowances[msg.sender][spender].sub(subtractedValue, Errors.ERC20_DECREASED_ALLOWANCE_BELOW_ZERO)
        );
        return true;
    }

    /**
     * @dev Moves tokens `amount` from `sender` to `recipient`.
     *
     * This is internal function is equivalent to {transfer}, and can be used to
     * e.g. implement automatic token fees, slashing mechanisms, etc.
     *
     * Emits a {Transfer} event.
     *
     * Requirements:
     *
     * - `sender` cannot be the zero address.
     * - `recipient` cannot be the zero address.
     * - `sender` must have a balance of at least `amount`.
     */
    function _transfer(
        address sender,
        address recipient,
        uint256 amount
    ) internal virtual {
        _require(sender != address(0), Errors.ERC20_TRANSFER_FROM_ZERO_ADDRESS);
        _require(recipient != address(0), Errors.ERC20_TRANSFER_TO_ZERO_ADDRESS);

        _beforeTokenTransfer(sender, recipient, amount);

        _balances[sender] = _balances[sender].sub(amount, Errors.ERC20_TRANSFER_EXCEEDS_BALANCE);
        _balances[recipient] = _balances[recipient].add(amount);
        emit Transfer(sender, recipient, amount);
    }

    /** @dev Creates `amount` tokens and assigns them to `account`, increasing
     * the total supply.
     *
     * Emits a {Transfer} event with `from` set to the zero address.
     *
     * Requirements:
     *
     * - `to` cannot be the zero address.
     */
    function _mint(address account, uint256 amount) internal virtual {
        _require(account != address(0), Errors.ERC20_MINT_TO_ZERO_ADDRESS);

        _beforeTokenTransfer(address(0), account, amount);

        _totalSupply = _totalSupply.add(amount);
        _balances[account] = _balances[account].add(amount);
        emit Transfer(address(0), account, amount);
    }

    /**
     * @dev Destroys `amount` tokens from `account`, reducing the
     * total supply.
     *
     * Emits a {Transfer} event with `to` set to the zero address.
     *
     * Requirements:
     *
     * - `account` cannot be the zero address.
     * - `account` must have at least `amount` tokens.
     */
    function _burn(address account, uint256 amount) internal virtual {
        _require(account != address(0), Errors.ERC20_BURN_FROM_ZERO_ADDRESS);

        _beforeTokenTransfer(account, address(0), amount);

        _balances[account] = _balances[account].sub(amount, Errors.ERC20_BURN_EXCEEDS_ALLOWANCE);
        _totalSupply = _totalSupply.sub(amount);
        emit Transfer(account, address(0), amount);
    }

    /**
     * @dev Sets `amount` as the allowance of `spender` over the `owner` s tokens.
     *
     * This internal function is equivalent to `approve`, and can be used to
     * e.g. set automatic allowances for certain subsystems, etc.
     *
     * Emits an {Approval} event.
     *
     * Requirements:
     *
     * - `owner` cannot be the zero address.
     * - `spender` cannot be the zero address.
     */
    function _approve(
        address owner,
        address spender,
        uint256 amount
    ) internal virtual {
        _require(owner != address(0), Errors.ERC20_APPROVE_FROM_ZERO_ADDRESS);
        _require(spender != address(0), Errors.ERC20_APPROVE_TO_ZERO_ADDRESS);

        _allowances[owner][spender] = amount;
        emit Approval(owner, spender, amount);
    }

    /**
     * @dev Sets {decimals} to a value other than the default one of 18.
     *
     * WARNING: This function should only be called from the constructor. Most
     * applications that interact with token contracts will not expect
     * {decimals} to ever change, and may work incorrectly if it does.
     */
    function _setupDecimals(uint8 decimals_) internal {
        _decimals = decimals_;
    }

    /**
     * @dev Hook that is called before any transfer of tokens. This includes
     * minting and burning.
     *
     * Calling conditions:
     *
     * - when `from` and `to` are both non-zero, `amount` of ``from``'s tokens
     * will be to transferred to `to`.
     * - when `from` is zero, `amount` tokens will be minted for `to`.
     * - when `to` is zero, `amount` of ``from``'s tokens will be burned.
     * - `from` and `to` are never both zero.
     *
     * To learn more about hooks, head to xref:ROOT:extending-contracts.adoc#using-hooks[Using Hooks].
     */
    function _beforeTokenTransfer(
        address from,
        address to,
        uint256 amount
    ) internal virtual {}
}

File 48 of 86 : ERC20Burnable.sol
// SPDX-License-Identifier: MIT

pragma solidity ^0.7.0;

import "./ERC20.sol";

/**
 * @dev Extension of {ERC20} that allows token holders to destroy both their own
 * tokens and those that they have an allowance for, in a way that can be
 * recognized off-chain (via event analysis).
 */
abstract contract ERC20Burnable is ERC20 {
    using SafeMath for uint256;

    /**
     * @dev Destroys `amount` tokens from the caller.
     *
     * See {ERC20-_burn}.
     */
    function burn(uint256 amount) public virtual {
        _burn(msg.sender, amount);
    }

    /**
     * @dev Destroys `amount` tokens from `account`, deducting from the caller's
     * allowance.
     *
     * See {ERC20-_burn} and {ERC20-allowance}.
     *
     * Requirements:
     *
     * - the caller must have allowance for ``accounts``'s tokens of at least
     * `amount`.
     */
    function burnFrom(address account, uint256 amount) public virtual {
        uint256 decreasedAllowance = allowance(account, msg.sender).sub(amount, Errors.ERC20_BURN_EXCEEDS_ALLOWANCE);

        _approve(account, msg.sender, decreasedAllowance);
        _burn(account, amount);
    }
}

File 49 of 86 : AccessControl.sol
// SPDX-License-Identifier: MIT

pragma solidity ^0.7.0;

import "../helpers/BalancerErrors.sol";

import "./EnumerableSet.sol";

/**
 * @dev Contract module that allows children to implement role-based access
 * control mechanisms.
 *
 * Roles are referred to by their `bytes32` identifier. These should be exposed
 * in the external API and be unique. The best way to achieve this is by
 * using `public constant` hash digests:
 *
 * ```
 * bytes32 public constant MY_ROLE = keccak256("MY_ROLE");
 * ```
 *
 * Roles can be used to represent a set of permissions. To restrict access to a
 * function call, use {hasRole}:
 *
 * ```
 * function foo() public {
 *     require(hasRole(MY_ROLE, msg.sender));
 *     ...
 * }
 * ```
 *
 * Roles can be granted and revoked dynamically via the {grantRole} and
 * {revokeRole} functions. Each role has an associated admin role, and only
 * accounts that have a role's admin role can call {grantRole} and {revokeRole}.
 *
 * By default, the admin role for all roles is `DEFAULT_ADMIN_ROLE`, which means
 * that only accounts with this role will be able to grant or revoke other
 * roles. More complex role relationships can be created by using
 * {_setRoleAdmin}.
 *
 * WARNING: The `DEFAULT_ADMIN_ROLE` is also its own admin: it has permission to
 * grant and revoke this role. Extra precautions should be taken to secure
 * accounts that have been granted it.
 */
abstract contract AccessControl {
    using EnumerableSet for EnumerableSet.AddressSet;

    struct RoleData {
        EnumerableSet.AddressSet members;
        bytes32 adminRole;
    }

    mapping(bytes32 => RoleData) private _roles;

    bytes32 public constant DEFAULT_ADMIN_ROLE = 0x00;

    /**
     * @dev Emitted when `newAdminRole` is set as ``role``'s admin role, replacing `previousAdminRole`
     *
     * `DEFAULT_ADMIN_ROLE` is the starting admin for all roles, despite
     * {RoleAdminChanged} not being emitted signaling this.
     *
     * _Available since v3.1._
     */
    event RoleAdminChanged(bytes32 indexed role, bytes32 indexed previousAdminRole, bytes32 indexed newAdminRole);

    /**
     * @dev Emitted when `account` is granted `role`.
     *
     * `sender` is the account that originated the contract call, an admin role
     * bearer except when using {_setupRole}.
     */
    event RoleGranted(bytes32 indexed role, address indexed account, address indexed sender);

    /**
     * @dev Emitted when `account` is revoked `role`.
     *
     * `sender` is the account that originated the contract call:
     *   - if using `revokeRole`, it is the admin role bearer
     *   - if using `renounceRole`, it is the role bearer (i.e. `account`)
     */
    event RoleRevoked(bytes32 indexed role, address indexed account, address indexed sender);

    /**
     * @dev Returns `true` if `account` has been granted `role`.
     */
    function hasRole(bytes32 role, address account) public view virtual returns (bool) {
        return _roles[role].members.contains(account);
    }

    /**
     * @dev Returns the number of accounts that have `role`. Can be used
     * together with {getRoleMember} to enumerate all bearers of a role.
     */
    function getRoleMemberCount(bytes32 role) public view returns (uint256) {
        return _roles[role].members.length();
    }

    /**
     * @dev Returns one of the accounts that have `role`. `index` must be a
     * value between 0 and {getRoleMemberCount}, non-inclusive.
     *
     * Role bearers are not sorted in any particular way, and their ordering may
     * change at any point.
     *
     * WARNING: When using {getRoleMember} and {getRoleMemberCount}, make sure
     * you perform all queries on the same block. See the following
     * https://forum.openzeppelin.com/t/iterating-over-elements-on-enumerableset-in-openzeppelin-contracts/2296[forum post]
     * for more information.
     */
    function getRoleMember(bytes32 role, uint256 index) public view returns (address) {
        return _roles[role].members.at(index);
    }

    /**
     * @dev Returns the admin role that controls `role`. See {grantRole} and
     * {revokeRole}.
     *
     * To change a role's admin, use {_setRoleAdmin}.
     */
    function getRoleAdmin(bytes32 role) public view returns (bytes32) {
        return _roles[role].adminRole;
    }

    /**
     * @dev Grants `role` to `account`.
     *
     * If `account` had not been already granted `role`, emits a {RoleGranted}
     * event.
     *
     * Requirements:
     *
     * - the caller must have ``role``'s admin role.
     */
    function grantRole(bytes32 role, address account) public virtual {
        _require(hasRole(_roles[role].adminRole, msg.sender), Errors.GRANT_SENDER_NOT_ADMIN);

        _grantRole(role, account);
    }

    /**
     * @dev Revokes `role` from `account`.
     *
     * If `account` had already been granted `role`, emits a {RoleRevoked} event.
     *
     * Requirements:
     *
     * - the caller must have ``role``'s admin role.
     */
    function revokeRole(bytes32 role, address account) public virtual {
        _require(hasRole(_roles[role].adminRole, msg.sender), Errors.REVOKE_SENDER_NOT_ADMIN);

        _revokeRole(role, account);
    }

    /**
     * @dev Revokes `role` from the calling account.
     *
     * Roles are often managed via {grantRole} and {revokeRole}: this function's
     * purpose is to provide a mechanism for accounts to lose their privileges
     * if they are compromised (such as when a trusted device is misplaced).
     *
     * If the calling account had been granted `role`, emits a {RoleRevoked}
     * event.
     *
     * Requirements:
     *
     * - the caller must be `account`.
     */
    function renounceRole(bytes32 role, address account) public virtual {
        _require(account == msg.sender, Errors.RENOUNCE_SENDER_NOT_ALLOWED);

        _revokeRole(role, account);
    }

    /**
     * @dev Grants `role` to `account`.
     *
     * If `account` had not been already granted `role`, emits a {RoleGranted}
     * event. Note that unlike {grantRole}, this function doesn't perform any
     * checks on the calling account.
     *
     * [WARNING]
     * ====
     * This function should only be called from the constructor when setting
     * up the initial roles for the system.
     *
     * Using this function in any other way is effectively circumventing the admin
     * system imposed by {AccessControl}.
     * ====
     */
    function _setupRole(bytes32 role, address account) internal virtual {
        _grantRole(role, account);
    }

    /**
     * @dev Sets `adminRole` as ``role``'s admin role.
     *
     * Emits a {RoleAdminChanged} event.
     */
    function _setRoleAdmin(bytes32 role, bytes32 adminRole) internal virtual {
        emit RoleAdminChanged(role, _roles[role].adminRole, adminRole);
        _roles[role].adminRole = adminRole;
    }

    function _grantRole(bytes32 role, address account) private {
        if (_roles[role].members.add(account)) {
            emit RoleGranted(role, account, msg.sender);
        }
    }

    function _revokeRole(bytes32 role, address account) private {
        if (_roles[role].members.remove(account)) {
            emit RoleRevoked(role, account, msg.sender);
        }
    }
}

File 50 of 86 : SafeMath.sol
// SPDX-License-Identifier: MIT

pragma solidity ^0.7.0;

import "../helpers/BalancerErrors.sol";

/**
 * @dev Wrappers over Solidity's arithmetic operations with added overflow
 * checks.
 *
 * Arithmetic operations in Solidity wrap on overflow. This can easily result
 * in bugs, because programmers usually assume that an overflow raises an
 * error, which is the standard behavior in high level programming languages.
 * `SafeMath` restores this intuition by reverting the transaction when an
 * operation overflows.
 *
 * Using this library instead of the unchecked operations eliminates an entire
 * class of bugs, so it's recommended to use it always.
 */
library SafeMath {
    /**
     * @dev Returns the addition of two unsigned integers, reverting on
     * overflow.
     *
     * Counterpart to Solidity's `+` operator.
     *
     * Requirements:
     *
     * - Addition cannot overflow.
     */
    function add(uint256 a, uint256 b) internal pure returns (uint256) {
        uint256 c = a + b;
        _require(c >= a, Errors.ADD_OVERFLOW);

        return c;
    }

    /**
     * @dev Returns the subtraction of two unsigned integers, reverting on
     * overflow (when the result is negative).
     *
     * Counterpart to Solidity's `-` operator.
     *
     * Requirements:
     *
     * - Subtraction cannot overflow.
     */
    function sub(uint256 a, uint256 b) internal pure returns (uint256) {
        return sub(a, b, Errors.SUB_OVERFLOW);
    }

    /**
     * @dev Returns the subtraction of two unsigned integers, reverting with custom message on
     * overflow (when the result is negative).
     *
     * Counterpart to Solidity's `-` operator.
     *
     * Requirements:
     *
     * - Subtraction cannot overflow.
     */
    function sub(uint256 a, uint256 b, uint256 errorCode) internal pure returns (uint256) {
        _require(b <= a, errorCode);
        uint256 c = a - b;

        return c;
    }
}

File 51 of 86 : TokenFactory.sol
// SPDX-License-Identifier: GPL-3.0-or-later
// This program is free software: you can redistribute it and/or modify
// it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
// the Free Software Foundation, either version 3 of the License, or
// (at your option) any later version.

// This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
// but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
// MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE.  See the
// GNU General Public License for more details.

// You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
// along with this program.  If not, see <http://www.gnu.org/licenses/>.

pragma solidity ^0.7.0;
pragma experimental ABIEncoderV2;

import "../lib/openzeppelin/Address.sol";
import "../lib/openzeppelin/Create2.sol";

import "./TestToken.sol";

contract TokenFactory {
    using Address for address;
    using EnumerableSet for EnumerableSet.AddressSet;

    EnumerableSet.AddressSet private _tokens;

    event TokenCreated(address indexed token);

    constructor() {
        // solhint-disable-previous-line no-empty-blocks
    }

    function getTotalTokens() external view returns (uint256) {
        return _tokens.length();
    }

    function getTokens(uint256 start, uint256 end) external view returns (address[] memory) {
        require((end >= start) && (end - start) <= _tokens.length(), "OUT_OF_BOUNDS");

        address[] memory token = new address[](end - start);
        for (uint256 i = 0; i < token.length; ++i) {
            token[i] = _tokens.at(i + start);
        }

        return token;
    }

    function create(
        address admin,
        string memory name,
        string memory symbol,
        uint8 decimals
    ) external returns (address) {
        bytes memory creationCode = abi.encodePacked(
            type(TestToken).creationCode,
            abi.encode(admin, name, symbol, decimals)
        );

        address expectedToken = Create2.computeAddress(0, keccak256(creationCode));

        if (expectedToken.isContract()) {
            return expectedToken;
        } else {
            address token = Create2.deploy(0, 0, creationCode);
            assert(token == expectedToken);

            _tokens.add(token);
            emit TokenCreated(token);

            return token;
        }
    }
}

File 52 of 86 : Create2.sol
// SPDX-License-Identifier: MIT

pragma solidity ^0.7.0;

import "../helpers/BalancerErrors.sol";

/**
 * @dev Helper to make usage of the `CREATE2` EVM opcode easier and safer.
 * `CREATE2` can be used to compute in advance the address where a smart
 * contract will be deployed, which allows for interesting new mechanisms known
 * as 'counterfactual interactions'.
 *
 * See the https://eips.ethereum.org/EIPS/eip-1014#motivation[EIP] for more
 * information.
 */
library Create2 {
    /**
     * @dev Deploys a contract using `CREATE2`. The address where the contract
     * will be deployed can be known in advance via {computeAddress}.
     *
     * The bytecode for a contract can be obtained from Solidity with
     * `type(contractName).creationCode`.
     *
     * Requirements:
     *
     * - `bytecode` must not be empty.
     * - `salt` must have not been used for `bytecode` already.
     * - the factory must have a balance of at least `amount`.
     * - if `amount` is non-zero, `bytecode` must have a `payable` constructor.
     */
    function deploy(uint256 amount, bytes32 salt, bytes memory bytecode) internal returns (address) {
        address addr;
        require(address(this).balance >= amount, 'CREATE2_INSUFFICIENT_BALANCE');
        require(bytecode.length != 0, 'CREATE2_BYTECODE_ZERO');
        // solhint-disable-next-line no-inline-assembly
        assembly {
            addr := create2(amount, add(bytecode, 0x20), mload(bytecode), salt)
        }
        require(addr != address(0), 'CREATE2_DEPLOY_FAILED');
        return addr;
    }

    /**
     * @dev Returns the address where a contract will be stored if deployed via {deploy}. Any change in the
     * `bytecodeHash` or `salt` will result in a new destination address.
     */
    function computeAddress(bytes32 salt, bytes32 bytecodeHash) internal view returns (address) {
        return computeAddress(salt, bytecodeHash, address(this));
    }

    /**
     * @dev Returns the address where a contract will be stored if deployed via {deploy} from a contract located at
     * `deployer`. If `deployer` is this contract's address, returns the same value as {computeAddress}.
     */
    function computeAddress(bytes32 salt, bytes32 bytecodeHash, address deployer) internal pure returns (address) {
        bytes32 _data = keccak256(
            abi.encodePacked(bytes1(0xff), deployer, salt, bytecodeHash)
        );
        return address(uint256(_data));
    }
}

File 53 of 86 : MockVault.sol
// SPDX-License-Identifier: GPL-3.0-or-later
// This program is free software: you can redistribute it and/or modify
// it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
// the Free Software Foundation, either version 3 of the License, or
// (at your option) any later version.

// This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
// but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
// MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE.  See the
// GNU General Public License for more details.

// You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
// along with this program.  If not, see <http://www.gnu.org/licenses/>.

pragma solidity ^0.7.0;
pragma experimental ABIEncoderV2;

import "../lib/openzeppelin/IERC20.sol";

import "../vault/interfaces/IVault.sol";
import "../vault/interfaces/IBasePool.sol";

contract MockVault {
    struct Pool {
        IERC20[] tokens;
        mapping(IERC20 => uint256) balances;
    }

    IAuthorizer private _authorizer;
    mapping(bytes32 => Pool) private pools;

    event PoolBalanceChanged(
        bytes32 indexed poolId,
        address indexed liquidityProvider,
        IERC20[] tokens,
        int256[] deltas,
        uint256[] protocolFees
    );

    constructor(IAuthorizer authorizer) {
        _authorizer = authorizer;
    }

    function getAuthorizer() external view returns (IAuthorizer) {
        return _authorizer;
    }

    function getPoolTokens(bytes32 poolId) external view returns (IERC20[] memory tokens, uint256[] memory balances) {
        Pool storage pool = pools[poolId];
        tokens = new IERC20[](pool.tokens.length);
        balances = new uint256[](pool.tokens.length);

        for (uint256 i = 0; i < pool.tokens.length; i++) {
            tokens[i] = pool.tokens[i];
            balances[i] = pool.balances[tokens[i]];
        }
    }

    function registerPool(IVault.PoolSpecialization) external view returns (bytes32) {
        // solhint-disable-previous-line no-empty-blocks
    }

    function registerTokens(
        bytes32 poolId,
        IERC20[] memory tokens,
        address[] memory
    ) external {
        Pool storage pool = pools[poolId];
        for (uint256 i = 0; i < tokens.length; i++) {
            pool.tokens.push(tokens[i]);
        }
    }

    function callJoinPool(
        address poolAddress,
        bytes32 poolId,
        address recipient,
        uint256[] memory currentBalances,
        uint256 lastChangeBlock,
        uint256 protocolFeePercentage,
        bytes memory userData
    ) external {
        (uint256[] memory amountsIn, uint256[] memory dueProtocolFeeAmounts) = IBasePool(poolAddress).onJoinPool(
            poolId,
            msg.sender,
            recipient,
            currentBalances,
            lastChangeBlock,
            protocolFeePercentage,
            userData
        );

        Pool storage pool = pools[poolId];
        for (uint256 i = 0; i < pool.tokens.length; i++) {
            pool.balances[pool.tokens[i]] += amountsIn[i];
        }

        IERC20[] memory tokens = new IERC20[](currentBalances.length);
        int256[] memory deltas = new int256[](amountsIn.length);
        for (uint256 i = 0; i < amountsIn.length; ++i) {
            deltas[i] = int256(amountsIn[i]);
        }

        emit PoolBalanceChanged(poolId, msg.sender, tokens, deltas, dueProtocolFeeAmounts);
    }

    function callExitPool(
        address poolAddress,
        bytes32 poolId,
        address recipient,
        uint256[] memory currentBalances,
        uint256 lastChangeBlock,
        uint256 protocolFeePercentage,
        bytes memory userData
    ) external {
        (uint256[] memory amountsOut, uint256[] memory dueProtocolFeeAmounts) = IBasePool(poolAddress).onExitPool(
            poolId,
            msg.sender,
            recipient,
            currentBalances,
            lastChangeBlock,
            protocolFeePercentage,
            userData
        );

        Pool storage pool = pools[poolId];
        for (uint256 i = 0; i < pool.tokens.length; i++) {
            pool.balances[pool.tokens[i]] -= amountsOut[i];
        }

        IERC20[] memory tokens = new IERC20[](currentBalances.length);
        int256[] memory deltas = new int256[](amountsOut.length);
        for (uint256 i = 0; i < amountsOut.length; ++i) {
            deltas[i] = int256(-amountsOut[i]);
        }

        emit PoolBalanceChanged(poolId, msg.sender, tokens, deltas, dueProtocolFeeAmounts);
    }
}

File 54 of 86 : BasePoolFactory.sol
// SPDX-License-Identifier: GPL-3.0-or-later
// This program is free software: you can redistribute it and/or modify
// it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
// the Free Software Foundation, either version 3 of the License, or
// (at your option) any later version.

// This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
// but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
// MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE.  See the
// GNU General Public License for more details.

// You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
// along with this program.  If not, see <http://www.gnu.org/licenses/>.

pragma solidity ^0.7.0;
pragma experimental ABIEncoderV2;

import "../../vault/interfaces/IVault.sol";
import "../../vault/interfaces/IBasePool.sol";

/**
 * @dev Base contract for Pool factories.
 *
 * Pools are deployed from factories to allow third parties to reason about them. Unknown Pools may have arbitrary
 * logic: being able to assert that a Pool's behavior follows certain rules (those imposed by the contracts created by
 * the factory) is very powerful.
 */
abstract contract BasePoolFactory {
    IVault private immutable _vault;
    mapping(address => bool) private _isPoolFromFactory;

    event PoolCreated(address indexed pool);

    constructor(IVault vault) {
        _vault = vault;
    }

    /**
     * @dev Returns the Vault's address.
     */
    function getVault() public view returns (IVault) {
        return _vault;
    }

    /**
     * @dev Returns true if `pool` was created by this factory.
     */
    function isPoolFromFactory(address pool) external view returns (bool) {
        return _isPoolFromFactory[pool];
    }

    /**
     * @dev Registers a new created pool.
     *
     * Emits a `PoolCreated` event.
     */
    function _register(address pool) internal {
        _isPoolFromFactory[pool] = true;
        emit PoolCreated(pool);
    }
}

File 55 of 86 : MockPoolFactory.sol
// SPDX-License-Identifier: GPL-3.0-or-later
// This program is free software: you can redistribute it and/or modify
// it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
// the Free Software Foundation, either version 3 of the License, or
// (at your option) any later version.

// This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
// but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
// MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE.  See the
// GNU General Public License for more details.

// You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
// along with this program.  If not, see <http://www.gnu.org/licenses/>.

pragma solidity ^0.7.0;
pragma experimental ABIEncoderV2;

import "../vault/interfaces/IVault.sol";

import "../pools/factories/BasePoolFactory.sol";

contract MockFactoryCreatedPool {
    function getPoolId() external view returns (bytes32) {
        return bytes32(uint256(address(this)));
    }
}

contract MockPoolFactory is BasePoolFactory {
    constructor(IVault _vault) BasePoolFactory(_vault) {
        // solhint-disable-previous-line no-empty-blocks
    }

    function create() external returns (address) {
        address pool = address(new MockFactoryCreatedPool());
        _register(pool);
        return pool;
    }
}

File 56 of 86 : WeightedPool.sol
// SPDX-License-Identifier: GPL-3.0-or-later
// This program is free software: you can redistribute it and/or modify
// it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
// the Free Software Foundation, either version 3 of the License, or
// (at your option) any later version.

// This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
// but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
// MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE.  See the
// GNU General Public License for more details.

// You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
// along with this program.  If not, see <http://www.gnu.org/licenses/>.

pragma solidity ^0.7.0;
pragma experimental ABIEncoderV2;

import "../../lib/math/FixedPoint.sol";
import "../../lib/helpers/InputHelpers.sol";

import "../BaseMinimalSwapInfoPool.sol";

import "./WeightedMath.sol";
import "./WeightedPoolUserDataHelpers.sol";

// This contract relies on tons of immutable state variables to perform efficient lookup, without resorting to storage
// reads. Because immutable arrays are not supported, we instead declare a fixed set of state variables plus total
// count, resulting in a large number of state variables.

contract WeightedPool is BaseMinimalSwapInfoPool, WeightedMath {
    using FixedPoint for uint256;
    using WeightedPoolUserDataHelpers for bytes;

    // The protocol fees will always be charged using the token associated with the max weight in the pool.
    // Since these Pools will register tokens only once, we can assume this index will be constant.
    uint256 private immutable _maxWeightTokenIndex;

    uint256 private immutable _normalizedWeight0;
    uint256 private immutable _normalizedWeight1;
    uint256 private immutable _normalizedWeight2;
    uint256 private immutable _normalizedWeight3;
    uint256 private immutable _normalizedWeight4;
    uint256 private immutable _normalizedWeight5;
    uint256 private immutable _normalizedWeight6;
    uint256 private immutable _normalizedWeight7;

    uint256 private _lastInvariant;

    enum JoinKind { INIT, EXACT_TOKENS_IN_FOR_BPT_OUT, TOKEN_IN_FOR_EXACT_BPT_OUT }
    enum ExitKind { EXACT_BPT_IN_FOR_ONE_TOKEN_OUT, EXACT_BPT_IN_FOR_TOKENS_OUT, BPT_IN_FOR_EXACT_TOKENS_OUT }

    constructor(
        IVault vault,
        string memory name,
        string memory symbol,
        IERC20[] memory tokens,
        uint256[] memory normalizedWeights,
        uint256 swapFeePercentage,
        uint256 pauseWindowDuration,
        uint256 bufferPeriodDuration,
        address owner
    )
        BaseMinimalSwapInfoPool(
            vault,
            name,
            symbol,
            tokens,
            swapFeePercentage,
            pauseWindowDuration,
            bufferPeriodDuration,
            owner
        )
    {
        uint256 numTokens = tokens.length;
        InputHelpers.ensureInputLengthMatch(numTokens, normalizedWeights.length);

        // Ensure  each normalized weight is above them minimum and find the token index of the maximum weight
        uint256 normalizedSum = 0;
        uint256 maxWeightTokenIndex = 0;
        uint256 maxNormalizedWeight = 0;
        for (uint8 i = 0; i < numTokens; i++) {
            uint256 normalizedWeight = normalizedWeights[i];
            _require(normalizedWeight >= _MIN_WEIGHT, Errors.MIN_WEIGHT);

            normalizedSum = normalizedSum.add(normalizedWeight);
            if (normalizedWeight > maxNormalizedWeight) {
                maxWeightTokenIndex = i;
                maxNormalizedWeight = normalizedWeight;
            }
        }
        // Ensure that the normalized weights sum to ONE
        _require(normalizedSum == FixedPoint.ONE, Errors.NORMALIZED_WEIGHT_INVARIANT);

        _maxWeightTokenIndex = maxWeightTokenIndex;
        _normalizedWeight0 = normalizedWeights.length > 0 ? normalizedWeights[0] : 0;
        _normalizedWeight1 = normalizedWeights.length > 1 ? normalizedWeights[1] : 0;
        _normalizedWeight2 = normalizedWeights.length > 2 ? normalizedWeights[2] : 0;
        _normalizedWeight3 = normalizedWeights.length > 3 ? normalizedWeights[3] : 0;
        _normalizedWeight4 = normalizedWeights.length > 4 ? normalizedWeights[4] : 0;
        _normalizedWeight5 = normalizedWeights.length > 5 ? normalizedWeights[5] : 0;
        _normalizedWeight6 = normalizedWeights.length > 6 ? normalizedWeights[6] : 0;
        _normalizedWeight7 = normalizedWeights.length > 7 ? normalizedWeights[7] : 0;
    }

    function _normalizedWeight(IERC20 token) internal view virtual returns (uint256) {
        // prettier-ignore
        if (token == _token0) { return _normalizedWeight0; }
        else if (token == _token1) { return _normalizedWeight1; }
        else if (token == _token2) { return _normalizedWeight2; }
        else if (token == _token3) { return _normalizedWeight3; }
        else if (token == _token4) { return _normalizedWeight4; }
        else if (token == _token5) { return _normalizedWeight5; }
        else if (token == _token6) { return _normalizedWeight6; }
        else if (token == _token7) { return _normalizedWeight7; }
        else {
            _revert(Errors.INVALID_TOKEN);
        }
    }

    function _normalizedWeights() internal view virtual returns (uint256[] memory) {
        uint256 totalTokens = _getTotalTokens();
        uint256[] memory normalizedWeights = new uint256[](totalTokens);

        // prettier-ignore
        {
            if (totalTokens > 0) { normalizedWeights[0] = _normalizedWeight0; } else { return normalizedWeights; }
            if (totalTokens > 1) { normalizedWeights[1] = _normalizedWeight1; } else { return normalizedWeights; }
            if (totalTokens > 2) { normalizedWeights[2] = _normalizedWeight2; } else { return normalizedWeights; }
            if (totalTokens > 3) { normalizedWeights[3] = _normalizedWeight3; } else { return normalizedWeights; }
            if (totalTokens > 4) { normalizedWeights[4] = _normalizedWeight4; } else { return normalizedWeights; }
            if (totalTokens > 5) { normalizedWeights[5] = _normalizedWeight5; } else { return normalizedWeights; }
            if (totalTokens > 6) { normalizedWeights[6] = _normalizedWeight6; } else { return normalizedWeights; }
            if (totalTokens > 7) { normalizedWeights[7] = _normalizedWeight7; } else { return normalizedWeights; }
        }

        return normalizedWeights;
    }

    function getLastInvariant() external view returns (uint256) {
        return _lastInvariant;
    }

    /**
     * @dev Returns the current value of the invariant.
     */
    function getInvariant() public view returns (uint256) {
        (, uint256[] memory balances, ) = getVault().getPoolTokens(getPoolId());

        // Since the Pool hooks always work with upscaled balances, we manually
        // upscale here for consistency
        _upscaleArray(balances, _scalingFactors());

        uint256[] memory normalizedWeights = _normalizedWeights();
        return WeightedMath._calculateInvariant(normalizedWeights, balances);
    }

    function getNormalizedWeights() external view returns (uint256[] memory) {
        return _normalizedWeights();
    }

    // Base Pool handlers

    // Swap

    function _onSwapGivenIn(
        SwapRequest memory swapRequest,
        uint256 currentBalanceTokenIn,
        uint256 currentBalanceTokenOut
    ) internal view virtual override whenNotPaused returns (uint256) {
        // Swaps are disabled while the contract is paused.

        return
            WeightedMath._calcOutGivenIn(
                currentBalanceTokenIn,
                _normalizedWeight(swapRequest.tokenIn),
                currentBalanceTokenOut,
                _normalizedWeight(swapRequest.tokenOut),
                swapRequest.amount
            );
    }

    function _onSwapGivenOut(
        SwapRequest memory swapRequest,
        uint256 currentBalanceTokenIn,
        uint256 currentBalanceTokenOut
    ) internal view virtual override whenNotPaused returns (uint256) {
        // Swaps are disabled while the contract is paused.

        return
            WeightedMath._calcInGivenOut(
                currentBalanceTokenIn,
                _normalizedWeight(swapRequest.tokenIn),
                currentBalanceTokenOut,
                _normalizedWeight(swapRequest.tokenOut),
                swapRequest.amount
            );
    }

    // Initialize

    function _onInitializePool(
        bytes32,
        address,
        address,
        bytes memory userData
    ) internal virtual override whenNotPaused returns (uint256, uint256[] memory) {
        // It would be strange for the Pool to be paused before it is initialized, but for consistency we prevent
        // initialization in this case.

        WeightedPool.JoinKind kind = userData.joinKind();
        _require(kind == WeightedPool.JoinKind.INIT, Errors.UNINITIALIZED);

        uint256[] memory amountsIn = userData.initialAmountsIn();
        InputHelpers.ensureInputLengthMatch(_getTotalTokens(), amountsIn.length);
        _upscaleArray(amountsIn, _scalingFactors());

        uint256[] memory normalizedWeights = _normalizedWeights();

        uint256 invariantAfterJoin = WeightedMath._calculateInvariant(normalizedWeights, amountsIn);

        // Set the initial BPT to the value of the invariant times the number of tokens. This makes BPT supply more
        // consistent in Pools with similar compositions but different number of tokens.
        uint256 bptAmountOut = Math.mul(invariantAfterJoin, _getTotalTokens());

        _lastInvariant = invariantAfterJoin;

        return (bptAmountOut, amountsIn);
    }

    // Join

    function _onJoinPool(
        bytes32,
        address,
        address,
        uint256[] memory balances,
        uint256,
        uint256 protocolSwapFeePercentage,
        bytes memory userData
    )
        internal
        virtual
        override
        whenNotPaused
        returns (
            uint256,
            uint256[] memory,
            uint256[] memory
        )
    {
        // All joins are disabled while the contract is paused.

        uint256[] memory normalizedWeights = _normalizedWeights();

        // Due protocol swap fee amounts are computed by measuring the growth of the invariant between the previous join
        // or exit event and now - the invariant's growth is due exclusively to swap fees. This avoids spending gas
        // computing them on each individual swap
        uint256 invariantBeforeJoin = WeightedMath._calculateInvariant(normalizedWeights, balances);

        uint256[] memory dueProtocolFeeAmounts = _getDueProtocolFeeAmounts(
            balances,
            normalizedWeights,
            _lastInvariant,
            invariantBeforeJoin,
            protocolSwapFeePercentage
        );

        // Update current balances by subtracting the protocol fee amounts
        _mutateAmounts(balances, dueProtocolFeeAmounts, FixedPoint.sub);
        (uint256 bptAmountOut, uint256[] memory amountsIn) = _doJoin(balances, normalizedWeights, userData);

        // Update the invariant with the balances the Pool will have after the join, in order to compute the
        // protocol swap fee amounts due in future joins and exits.
        _lastInvariant = _invariantAfterJoin(balances, amountsIn, normalizedWeights);

        return (bptAmountOut, amountsIn, dueProtocolFeeAmounts);
    }

    function _doJoin(
        uint256[] memory balances,
        uint256[] memory normalizedWeights,
        bytes memory userData
    ) private view returns (uint256, uint256[] memory) {
        JoinKind kind = userData.joinKind();

        if (kind == JoinKind.EXACT_TOKENS_IN_FOR_BPT_OUT) {
            return _joinExactTokensInForBPTOut(balances, normalizedWeights, userData);
        } else if (kind == JoinKind.TOKEN_IN_FOR_EXACT_BPT_OUT) {
            return _joinTokenInForExactBPTOut(balances, normalizedWeights, userData);
        } else {
            _revert(Errors.UNHANDLED_JOIN_KIND);
        }
    }

    function _joinExactTokensInForBPTOut(
        uint256[] memory balances,
        uint256[] memory normalizedWeights,
        bytes memory userData
    ) private view returns (uint256, uint256[] memory) {
        (uint256[] memory amountsIn, uint256 minBPTAmountOut) = userData.exactTokensInForBptOut();
        InputHelpers.ensureInputLengthMatch(_getTotalTokens(), amountsIn.length);

        _upscaleArray(amountsIn, _scalingFactors());

        uint256 bptAmountOut = WeightedMath._calcBptOutGivenExactTokensIn(
            balances,
            normalizedWeights,
            amountsIn,
            totalSupply(),
            _swapFeePercentage
        );

        _require(bptAmountOut >= minBPTAmountOut, Errors.BPT_OUT_MIN_AMOUNT);

        return (bptAmountOut, amountsIn);
    }

    function _joinTokenInForExactBPTOut(
        uint256[] memory balances,
        uint256[] memory normalizedWeights,
        bytes memory userData
    ) private view returns (uint256, uint256[] memory) {
        (uint256 bptAmountOut, uint256 tokenIndex) = userData.tokenInForExactBptOut();
        // Note that there is no maximum amountIn parameter: this is handled by `IVault.joinPool`.

        _require(tokenIndex < _getTotalTokens(), Errors.OUT_OF_BOUNDS);

        uint256[] memory amountsIn = new uint256[](_getTotalTokens());
        amountsIn[tokenIndex] = WeightedMath._calcTokenInGivenExactBptOut(
            balances[tokenIndex],
            normalizedWeights[tokenIndex],
            bptAmountOut,
            totalSupply(),
            _swapFeePercentage
        );

        return (bptAmountOut, amountsIn);
    }

    // Exit

    function _onExitPool(
        bytes32,
        address,
        address,
        uint256[] memory balances,
        uint256,
        uint256 protocolSwapFeePercentage,
        bytes memory userData
    )
        internal
        virtual
        override
        returns (
            uint256 bptAmountIn,
            uint256[] memory amountsOut,
            uint256[] memory dueProtocolFeeAmounts
        )
    {
        // Exits are not completely disabled while the contract is paused: proportional exits (exact BPT in for tokens
        // out) remain functional.

        uint256[] memory normalizedWeights = _normalizedWeights();

        if (_isNotPaused()) {
            // Due protocol swap fee amounts are computed by measuring the growth of the invariant between the previous
            // join or exit event and now - the invariant's growth is due exclusively to swap fees. This avoids
            // spending gas calculating the fees on each individual swap.
            uint256 invariantBeforeExit = WeightedMath._calculateInvariant(normalizedWeights, balances);
            dueProtocolFeeAmounts = _getDueProtocolFeeAmounts(
                balances,
                normalizedWeights,
                _lastInvariant,
                invariantBeforeExit,
                protocolSwapFeePercentage
            );

            // Update current balances by subtracting the protocol fee amounts
            _mutateAmounts(balances, dueProtocolFeeAmounts, FixedPoint.sub);
        } else {
            // If the contract is paused, swap protocol fee amounts are not charged to avoid extra calculations and
            // reduce the potential for errors.
            dueProtocolFeeAmounts = new uint256[](_getTotalTokens());
        }

        (bptAmountIn, amountsOut) = _doExit(balances, normalizedWeights, userData);

        // Update the invariant with the balances the Pool will have after the exit, in order to compute the
        // protocol swap fees due in future joins and exits.
        _lastInvariant = _invariantAfterExit(balances, amountsOut, normalizedWeights);

        return (bptAmountIn, amountsOut, dueProtocolFeeAmounts);
    }

    function _doExit(
        uint256[] memory balances,
        uint256[] memory normalizedWeights,
        bytes memory userData
    ) private view returns (uint256, uint256[] memory) {
        ExitKind kind = userData.exitKind();

        if (kind == ExitKind.EXACT_BPT_IN_FOR_ONE_TOKEN_OUT) {
            return _exitExactBPTInForTokenOut(balances, normalizedWeights, userData);
        } else if (kind == ExitKind.EXACT_BPT_IN_FOR_TOKENS_OUT) {
            return _exitExactBPTInForTokensOut(balances, userData);
        } else {
            // ExitKind.BPT_IN_FOR_EXACT_TOKENS_OUT
            return _exitBPTInForExactTokensOut(balances, normalizedWeights, userData);
        }
    }

    function _exitExactBPTInForTokenOut(
        uint256[] memory balances,
        uint256[] memory normalizedWeights,
        bytes memory userData
    ) private view whenNotPaused returns (uint256, uint256[] memory) {
        // This exit function is disabled if the contract is paused.

        (uint256 bptAmountIn, uint256 tokenIndex) = userData.exactBptInForTokenOut();
        // Note that there is no minimum amountOut parameter: this is handled by `IVault.exitPool`.

        _require(tokenIndex < _getTotalTokens(), Errors.OUT_OF_BOUNDS);

        // We exit in a single token, so we initialize amountsOut with zeros
        uint256[] memory amountsOut = new uint256[](_getTotalTokens());

        // And then assign the result to the selected token
        amountsOut[tokenIndex] = WeightedMath._calcTokenOutGivenExactBptIn(
            balances[tokenIndex],
            normalizedWeights[tokenIndex],
            bptAmountIn,
            totalSupply(),
            _swapFeePercentage
        );

        return (bptAmountIn, amountsOut);
    }

    function _exitExactBPTInForTokensOut(uint256[] memory balances, bytes memory userData)
        private
        view
        returns (uint256, uint256[] memory)
    {
        // This exit function is the only one that is not disabled if the contract is paused: it remains unrestricted
        // in an attempt to provide users with a mechanism to retrieve their tokens in case of an emergency.
        // This particular exit function is the only one that remains available because it is the simplest one, and
        // therefore the one with the lowest likelihood of errors.

        uint256 bptAmountIn = userData.exactBptInForTokensOut();
        // Note that there is no minimum amountOut parameter: this is handled by `IVault.exitPool`.

        uint256[] memory amountsOut = WeightedMath._calcTokensOutGivenExactBptIn(balances, bptAmountIn, totalSupply());
        return (bptAmountIn, amountsOut);
    }

    function _exitBPTInForExactTokensOut(
        uint256[] memory balances,
        uint256[] memory normalizedWeights,
        bytes memory userData
    ) private view whenNotPaused returns (uint256, uint256[] memory) {
        // This exit function is disabled if the contract is paused.

        (uint256[] memory amountsOut, uint256 maxBPTAmountIn) = userData.bptInForExactTokensOut();
        InputHelpers.ensureInputLengthMatch(amountsOut.length, _getTotalTokens());
        _upscaleArray(amountsOut, _scalingFactors());

        uint256 bptAmountIn = WeightedMath._calcBptInGivenExactTokensOut(
            balances,
            normalizedWeights,
            amountsOut,
            totalSupply(),
            _swapFeePercentage
        );
        _require(bptAmountIn <= maxBPTAmountIn, Errors.BPT_IN_MAX_AMOUNT);

        return (bptAmountIn, amountsOut);
    }

    // Helpers

    function _getDueProtocolFeeAmounts(
        uint256[] memory balances,
        uint256[] memory normalizedWeights,
        uint256 previousInvariant,
        uint256 currentInvariant,
        uint256 protocolSwapFeePercentage
    ) private view returns (uint256[] memory) {
        // Initialize with zeros
        uint256[] memory dueProtocolFeeAmounts = new uint256[](_getTotalTokens());

        // Early return if the protocol swap fee percentage is zero, saving gas.
        if (protocolSwapFeePercentage == 0) {
            return dueProtocolFeeAmounts;
        }

        // The protocol swap fees are always paid using the token with the largest weight in the Pool. As this is the
        // token that is expected to have the largest balance, using it to pay fees should not unbalance the Pool.
        dueProtocolFeeAmounts[_maxWeightTokenIndex] = WeightedMath._calcDueTokenProtocolSwapFeeAmount(
            balances[_maxWeightTokenIndex],
            normalizedWeights[_maxWeightTokenIndex],
            previousInvariant,
            currentInvariant,
            protocolSwapFeePercentage
        );

        return dueProtocolFeeAmounts;
    }

    /**
     * @dev Returns the value of the invariant given `balances`, assuming they are increased by `amountsIn`. All
     * amounts are expected to be upscaled.
     */
    function _invariantAfterJoin(
        uint256[] memory balances,
        uint256[] memory amountsIn,
        uint256[] memory normalizedWeights
    ) private view returns (uint256) {
        _mutateAmounts(balances, amountsIn, FixedPoint.add);
        return WeightedMath._calculateInvariant(normalizedWeights, balances);
    }

    function _invariantAfterExit(
        uint256[] memory balances,
        uint256[] memory amountsOut,
        uint256[] memory normalizedWeights
    ) private view returns (uint256) {
        _mutateAmounts(balances, amountsOut, FixedPoint.sub);
        return WeightedMath._calculateInvariant(normalizedWeights, balances);
    }

    /**
     * @dev Mutates `amounts` by applying `mutation` with each entry in `arguments`.
     *
     * Equivalent to `amounts = amounts.map(mutation)`.
     */
    function _mutateAmounts(
        uint256[] memory toMutate,
        uint256[] memory arguments,
        function(uint256, uint256) pure returns (uint256) mutation
    ) private view {
        for (uint256 i = 0; i < _getTotalTokens(); ++i) {
            toMutate[i] = mutation(toMutate[i], arguments[i]);
        }
    }

    /**
     * @dev This function returns the appreciation of one BPT relative to the
     * underlying tokens. This starts at 1 when the pool is created and grows over time
     */
    function getRate() public view returns (uint256) {
        // The initial BPT supply is equal to the invariant times the number of tokens.
        return Math.mul(getInvariant(), _getTotalTokens()).divDown(totalSupply());
    }
}

File 57 of 86 : BaseMinimalSwapInfoPool.sol
// SPDX-License-Identifier: GPL-3.0-or-later
// This program is free software: you can redistribute it and/or modify
// it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
// the Free Software Foundation, either version 3 of the License, or
// (at your option) any later version.

// This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
// but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
// MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE.  See the
// GNU General Public License for more details.

// You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
// along with this program.  If not, see <http://www.gnu.org/licenses/>.

pragma solidity ^0.7.0;
pragma experimental ABIEncoderV2;

import "./BasePool.sol";
import "../vault/interfaces/IMinimalSwapInfoPool.sol";

/**
 * @dev Extension of `BasePool`, adding a handler for `IMinimalSwapInfoPool.onSwap`.
 *
 * Derived contracts must implement `_onSwapGivenIn` and `_onSwapGivenOut` along with `BasePool`'s virtual functions.
 */
abstract contract BaseMinimalSwapInfoPool is IMinimalSwapInfoPool, BasePool {
    constructor(
        IVault vault,
        string memory name,
        string memory symbol,
        IERC20[] memory tokens,
        uint256 swapFeePercentage,
        uint256 pauseWindowDuration,
        uint256 bufferPeriodDuration,
        address owner
    )
        BasePool(
            vault,
            tokens.length == 2 ? IVault.PoolSpecialization.TWO_TOKEN : IVault.PoolSpecialization.MINIMAL_SWAP_INFO,
            name,
            symbol,
            tokens,
            swapFeePercentage,
            pauseWindowDuration,
            bufferPeriodDuration,
            owner
        )
    {
        // solhint-disable-previous-line no-empty-blocks
    }

    // Swap Hooks

    function onSwap(
        SwapRequest memory request,
        uint256 balanceTokenIn,
        uint256 balanceTokenOut
    ) external view virtual override returns (uint256) {
        uint256 scalingFactorTokenIn = _scalingFactor(request.tokenIn);
        uint256 scalingFactorTokenOut = _scalingFactor(request.tokenOut);

        if (request.kind == IVault.SwapKind.GIVEN_IN) {
            // Fees are subtracted before scaling, to reduce the complexity of the rounding direction analysis.
            request.amount = _subtractSwapFeeAmount(request.amount);

            // All token amounts are upscaled.
            balanceTokenIn = _upscale(balanceTokenIn, scalingFactorTokenIn);
            balanceTokenOut = _upscale(balanceTokenOut, scalingFactorTokenOut);
            request.amount = _upscale(request.amount, scalingFactorTokenIn);

            uint256 amountOut = _onSwapGivenIn(request, balanceTokenIn, balanceTokenOut);

            // amountOut tokens are exiting the Pool, so we round down.
            return _downscaleDown(amountOut, scalingFactorTokenOut);
        } else {
            // All token amounts are upscaled.
            balanceTokenIn = _upscale(balanceTokenIn, scalingFactorTokenIn);
            balanceTokenOut = _upscale(balanceTokenOut, scalingFactorTokenOut);
            request.amount = _upscale(request.amount, scalingFactorTokenOut);

            uint256 amountIn = _onSwapGivenOut(request, balanceTokenIn, balanceTokenOut);

            // amountIn tokens are entering the Pool, so we round up.
            amountIn = _downscaleUp(amountIn, scalingFactorTokenIn);

            // Fees are added after scaling happens, to reduce the complexity of the rounding direction analysis.
            return _addSwapFeeAmount(amountIn);
        }
    }

    /*
     * @dev Called when a swap with the Pool occurs, where the amount of tokens entering the Pool is known.
     *
     * Returns the amount of tokens that will be taken from the Pool in return.
     *
     * All amounts inside `swapRequest`, `balanceTokenIn` and `balanceTokenOut` are upscaled. The swap fee has already
     * been deducted from `swapRequest.amount`.
     *
     * The return value is also considered upscaled, and will be downscaled (rounding down) before returning it to the
     * Vault.
     */
    function _onSwapGivenIn(
        SwapRequest memory swapRequest,
        uint256 balanceTokenIn,
        uint256 balanceTokenOut
    ) internal view virtual returns (uint256);

    /*
     * @dev Called when a swap with the Pool occurs, where the amount of tokens exiting the Pool is known.
     *
     * Returns the amount of tokens that will be granted to the Pool in return.
     *
     * All amounts inside `swapRequest`, `balanceTokenIn` and `balanceTokenOut` are upscaled.
     *
     * The return value is also considered upscaled, and will be downscaled (rounding up) before applying the swap fee
     * and returning it to the Vault.
     */
    function _onSwapGivenOut(
        SwapRequest memory swapRequest,
        uint256 balanceTokenIn,
        uint256 balanceTokenOut
    ) internal view virtual returns (uint256);
}

File 58 of 86 : WeightedMath.sol
// SPDX-License-Identifier: GPL-3.0-or-later
// This program is free software: you can redistribute it and/or modify
// it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
// the Free Software Foundation, either version 3 of the License, or
// (at your option) any later version.

// This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
// but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
// MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE.  See the
// GNU General Public License for more details.

// You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
// along with this program.  If not, see <http://www.gnu.org/licenses/>.

pragma solidity ^0.7.0;

import "../../lib/math/FixedPoint.sol";
import "../../lib/math/Math.sol";
import "../../lib/helpers/InputHelpers.sol";

/* solhint-disable private-vars-leading-underscore */

contract WeightedMath {
    using FixedPoint for uint256;
    // A minimum normalized weight imposes a maximum weight ratio. We need this due to limitations in the
    // implementation of the power function, as these ratios are often exponents.
    uint256 internal constant _MIN_WEIGHT = 0.01e18;
    // Having a minimum normalized weight imposes a limit on the maximum number of tokens;
    // i.e., the largest possible pool is one where all tokens have exactly the minimum weight.
    uint256 internal constant _MAX_WEIGHTED_TOKENS = 100;

    // Pool limits that arise from limitations in the fixed point power function (and the imposed 1:100 maximum weight
    // ratio).

    // Swap limits: amounts swapped may not be larger than this percentage of total balance.
    uint256 internal constant _MAX_IN_RATIO = 0.3e18;
    uint256 internal constant _MAX_OUT_RATIO = 0.3e18;

    // Invariant growth limit: non-proportional joins cannot cause the invariant to increase by more than this ratio.
    uint256 internal constant _MAX_INVARIANT_RATIO = 3e18;
    // Invariant shrink limit: non-proportional exits cannot cause the invariant to decrease by less than this ratio.
    uint256 internal constant _MIN_INVARIANT_RATIO = 0.7e18;

    // Invariant is used to collect protocol swap fees by comparing its value between two times.
    // So we can round always to the same direction. It is also used to initiate the BPT amount
    // and, because there is a minimum BPT, we round down the invariant.
    function _calculateInvariant(uint256[] memory normalizedWeights, uint256[] memory balances)
        internal
        pure
        returns (uint256 invariant)
    {
        /**********************************************************************************************
        // invariant               _____                                                             //
        // wi = weight index i      | |      wi                                                      //
        // bi = balance index i     | |  bi ^   = i                                                  //
        // i = invariant                                                                             //
        **********************************************************************************************/

        invariant = FixedPoint.ONE;
        for (uint256 i = 0; i < normalizedWeights.length; i++) {
            invariant = invariant.mulDown(balances[i].powDown(normalizedWeights[i]));
        }

        _require(invariant > 0, Errors.ZERO_INVARIANT);
    }

    // Computes how many tokens can be taken out of a pool if `amountIn` are sent, given the
    // current balances and weights.
    function _calcOutGivenIn(
        uint256 balanceIn,
        uint256 weightIn,
        uint256 balanceOut,
        uint256 weightOut,
        uint256 amountIn
    ) internal pure returns (uint256) {
        /**********************************************************************************************
        // outGivenIn                                                                                //
        // aO = amountOut                                                                            //
        // bO = balanceOut                                                                           //
        // bI = balanceIn              /      /            bI             \    (wI / wO) \           //
        // aI = amountIn    aO = bO * |  1 - | --------------------------  | ^            |          //
        // wI = weightIn               \      \       ( bI + aI )         /              /           //
        // wO = weightOut                                                                            //
        **********************************************************************************************/

        // Amount out, so we round down overall.

        // The multiplication rounds down, and the subtrahend (power) rounds up (so the base rounds up too).
        // Because bI / (bI + aI) <= 1, the exponent rounds down.

        // Cannot exceed maximum in ratio
        _require(amountIn <= balanceIn.mulDown(_MAX_IN_RATIO), Errors.MAX_IN_RATIO);

        uint256 denominator = balanceIn.add(amountIn);
        uint256 base = balanceIn.divUp(denominator);
        uint256 exponent = weightIn.divDown(weightOut);
        uint256 power = base.powUp(exponent);

        return balanceOut.mulDown(power.complement());
    }

    // Computes how many tokens must be sent to a pool in order to take `amountOut`, given the
    // current balances and weights.
    function _calcInGivenOut(
        uint256 balanceIn,
        uint256 weightIn,
        uint256 balanceOut,
        uint256 weightOut,
        uint256 amountOut
    ) internal pure returns (uint256) {
        /**********************************************************************************************
        // inGivenOut                                                                                //
        // aO = amountOut                                                                            //
        // bO = balanceOut                                                                           //
        // bI = balanceIn              /  /            bO             \    (wO / wI)      \          //
        // aI = amountIn    aI = bI * |  | --------------------------  | ^            - 1  |         //
        // wI = weightIn               \  \       ( bO - aO )         /                   /          //
        // wO = weightOut                                                                            //
        **********************************************************************************************/

        // Amount in, so we round up overall.

        // The multiplication rounds up, and the power rounds up (so the base rounds up too).
        // Because b0 / (b0 - a0) >= 1, the exponent rounds up.

        // Cannot exceed maximum out ratio
        _require(amountOut <= balanceOut.mulDown(_MAX_OUT_RATIO), Errors.MAX_OUT_RATIO);

        uint256 base = balanceOut.divUp(balanceOut.sub(amountOut));
        uint256 exponent = weightOut.divUp(weightIn);
        uint256 power = base.powUp(exponent);

        // Because the base is larger than one (and the power rounds up), the power should always be larger than one, so
        // the following subtraction should never revert.
        uint256 ratio = power.sub(FixedPoint.ONE);

        return balanceIn.mulUp(ratio);
    }

    function _calcBptOutGivenExactTokensIn(
        uint256[] memory balances,
        uint256[] memory normalizedWeights,
        uint256[] memory amountsIn,
        uint256 bptTotalSupply,
        uint256 swapFee
    ) internal pure returns (uint256) {
        // BPT out, so we round down overall.

        uint256[] memory balanceRatiosWithFee = new uint256[](amountsIn.length);

        uint256 invariantRatioWithFees = 0;
        for (uint256 i = 0; i < balances.length; i++) {
            balanceRatiosWithFee[i] = balances[i].add(amountsIn[i]).divDown(balances[i]);
            invariantRatioWithFees = invariantRatioWithFees.add(balanceRatiosWithFee[i].mulDown(normalizedWeights[i]));
        }

        uint256 invariantRatio = FixedPoint.ONE;
        for (uint256 i = 0; i < balances.length; i++) {
            uint256 amountInWithoutFee;

            if (balanceRatiosWithFee[i] > invariantRatioWithFees) {
                uint256 nonTaxableAmount = balances[i].mulDown(invariantRatioWithFees.sub(FixedPoint.ONE));
                uint256 taxableAmount = amountsIn[i].sub(nonTaxableAmount);
                amountInWithoutFee = nonTaxableAmount.add(taxableAmount.mulDown(FixedPoint.ONE.sub(swapFee)));
            } else {
                amountInWithoutFee = amountsIn[i];
            }

            uint256 balanceRatio = balances[i].add(amountInWithoutFee).divDown(balances[i]);

            invariantRatio = invariantRatio.mulDown(balanceRatio.powDown(normalizedWeights[i]));
        }

        if (invariantRatio >= FixedPoint.ONE) {
            return bptTotalSupply.mulDown(invariantRatio.sub(FixedPoint.ONE));
        } else {
            return 0;
        }
    }

    function _calcTokenInGivenExactBptOut(
        uint256 balance,
        uint256 normalizedWeight,
        uint256 bptAmountOut,
        uint256 bptTotalSupply,
        uint256 swapFee
    ) internal pure returns (uint256) {
        /******************************************************************************************
        // tokenInForExactBPTOut                                                                 //
        // a = amountIn                                                                          //
        // b = balance                      /  /    totalBPT + bptOut      \    (1 / w)       \  //
        // bptOut = bptAmountOut   a = b * |  | --------------------------  | ^          - 1  |  //
        // bpt = totalBPT                   \  \       totalBPT            /                  /  //
        // w = weight                                                                            //
        ******************************************************************************************/

        // Token in, so we round up overall.

        // Calculate the factor by which the invariant will increase after minting BPTAmountOut
        uint256 invariantRatio = bptTotalSupply.add(bptAmountOut).divUp(bptTotalSupply);
        _require(invariantRatio <= _MAX_INVARIANT_RATIO, Errors.MAX_OUT_BPT_FOR_TOKEN_IN);

        // Calculate by how much the token balance has to increase to match the invariantRatio
        uint256 balanceRatio = invariantRatio.powUp(FixedPoint.ONE.divUp(normalizedWeight));

        uint256 amountInWithoutFee = balance.mulUp(balanceRatio.sub(FixedPoint.ONE));

        // We can now compute how much extra balance is being deposited and used in virtual swaps, and charge swap fees
        // accordingly.
        uint256 taxablePercentage = normalizedWeight.complement();
        uint256 taxableAmount = amountInWithoutFee.mulUp(taxablePercentage);
        uint256 nonTaxableAmount = amountInWithoutFee.sub(taxableAmount);

        return nonTaxableAmount.add(taxableAmount.divUp(swapFee.complement()));
    }

    function _calcBptInGivenExactTokensOut(
        uint256[] memory balances,
        uint256[] memory normalizedWeights,
        uint256[] memory amountsOut,
        uint256 bptTotalSupply,
        uint256 swapFee
    ) internal pure returns (uint256) {
        // BPT in, so we round up overall.

        uint256[] memory balanceRatiosWithoutFee = new uint256[](amountsOut.length);
        uint256 invariantRatioWithoutFees = 0;
        for (uint256 i = 0; i < balances.length; i++) {
            balanceRatiosWithoutFee[i] = balances[i].sub(amountsOut[i]).divUp(balances[i]);
            invariantRatioWithoutFees = invariantRatioWithoutFees.add(
                balanceRatiosWithoutFee[i].mulUp(normalizedWeights[i])
            );
        }

        uint256 invariantRatio = FixedPoint.ONE;
        for (uint256 i = 0; i < balances.length; i++) {
            // Swap fees are typically charged on 'token in', but there is no 'token in' here,
            // o we apply it to 'token out'.
            // This results in slightly larger price impact.

            uint256 amountOutWithFee;
            if (invariantRatioWithoutFees > balanceRatiosWithoutFee[i]) {
                uint256 nonTaxableAmount = balances[i].mulDown(invariantRatioWithoutFees.complement());
                uint256 taxableAmount = amountsOut[i].sub(nonTaxableAmount);

                amountOutWithFee = nonTaxableAmount.add(taxableAmount.divUp(swapFee.complement()));
            } else {
                amountOutWithFee = amountsOut[i];
            }

            uint256 balanceRatio = balances[i].sub(amountOutWithFee).divDown(balances[i]);

            invariantRatio = invariantRatio.mulDown(balanceRatio.powDown(normalizedWeights[i]));
        }

        return bptTotalSupply.mulUp(invariantRatio.complement());
    }

    function _calcTokenOutGivenExactBptIn(
        uint256 balance,
        uint256 normalizedWeight,
        uint256 bptAmountIn,
        uint256 bptTotalSupply,
        uint256 swapFee
    ) internal pure returns (uint256) {
        /*****************************************************************************************
        // exactBPTInForTokenOut                                                                //
        // a = amountOut                                                                        //
        // b = balance                     /      /    totalBPT - bptIn       \    (1 / w)  \   //
        // bptIn = bptAmountIn    a = b * |  1 - | --------------------------  | ^           |  //
        // bpt = totalBPT                  \      \       totalBPT            /             /   //
        // w = weight                                                                           //
        *****************************************************************************************/

        // Token out, so we round down overall. The multiplication rounds down, but the power rounds up (so the base
        // rounds up). Because (totalBPT - bptIn) / totalBPT <= 1, the exponent rounds down.

        // Calculate the factor by which the invariant will decrease after burning BPTAmountIn
        uint256 invariantRatio = bptTotalSupply.sub(bptAmountIn).divUp(bptTotalSupply);
        _require(invariantRatio >= _MIN_INVARIANT_RATIO, Errors.MIN_BPT_IN_FOR_TOKEN_OUT);

        // Calculate by how much the token balance has to decrease to match invariantRatio
        uint256 balanceRatio = invariantRatio.powUp(FixedPoint.ONE.divDown(normalizedWeight));

        // Because of rounding up, balanceRatio can be greater than one. Using complement prevents reverts.
        uint256 amountOutWithoutFee = balance.mulDown(balanceRatio.complement());

        // We can now compute how much excess balance is being withdrawn as a result of the virtual swaps, which result
        // in swap fees.
        uint256 taxablePercentage = normalizedWeight.complement();

        // Swap fees are typically charged on 'token in', but there is no 'token in' here, so we apply it
        // to 'token out'. This results in slightly larger price impact. Fees are rounded up.
        uint256 taxableAmount = amountOutWithoutFee.mulUp(taxablePercentage);
        uint256 nonTaxableAmount = amountOutWithoutFee.sub(taxableAmount);

        return nonTaxableAmount.add(taxableAmount.mulDown(swapFee.complement()));
    }

    function _calcTokensOutGivenExactBptIn(
        uint256[] memory balances,
        uint256 bptAmountIn,
        uint256 totalBPT
    ) internal pure returns (uint256[] memory) {
        /**********************************************************************************************
        // exactBPTInForTokensOut                                                                    //
        // (per token)                                                                               //
        // aO = amountOut                  /        bptIn         \                                  //
        // b = balance           a0 = b * | ---------------------  |                                 //
        // bptIn = bptAmountIn             \       totalBPT       /                                  //
        // bpt = totalBPT                                                                            //
        **********************************************************************************************/

        // Since we're computing an amount out, we round down overall. This means rounding down on both the
        // multiplication and division.

        uint256 bptRatio = bptAmountIn.divDown(totalBPT);

        uint256[] memory amountsOut = new uint256[](balances.length);
        for (uint256 i = 0; i < balances.length; i++) {
            amountsOut[i] = balances[i].mulDown(bptRatio);
        }

        return amountsOut;
    }

    function _calcDueTokenProtocolSwapFeeAmount(
        uint256 balance,
        uint256 normalizedWeight,
        uint256 previousInvariant,
        uint256 currentInvariant,
        uint256 protocolSwapFeePercentage
    ) internal pure returns (uint256) {
        /*********************************************************************************
        /*  protocolSwapFeePercentage * balanceToken * ( 1 - (previousInvariant / currentInvariant) ^ (1 / weightToken))
        *********************************************************************************/

        if (currentInvariant <= previousInvariant) {
            // This shouldn't happen outside of rounding errors, but have this safeguard nonetheless to prevent the Pool
            // from entering a locked state in which joins and exits revert while computing accumulated swap fees.
            return 0;
        }

        // We round down to prevent issues in the Pool's accounting, even if it means paying slightly less in protocol
        // fees to the Vault.

        // Fee percentage and balance multiplications round down, while the subtrahend (power) rounds up (as does the
        // base). Because previousInvariant / currentInvariant <= 1, the exponent rounds down.

        uint256 base = previousInvariant.divUp(currentInvariant);
        uint256 exponent = FixedPoint.ONE.divDown(normalizedWeight);

        // Because the exponent is larger than one, the base of the power function has a lower bound. We cap to this
        // value to avoid numeric issues, which means in the extreme case (where the invariant growth is larger than
        // 1 / min exponent) the Pool will pay less in protocol fees than it should.
        base = Math.max(base, FixedPoint.MIN_POW_BASE_FREE_EXPONENT);

        uint256 power = base.powUp(exponent);

        uint256 tokenAccruedFees = balance.mulDown(power.complement());
        return tokenAccruedFees.mulDown(protocolSwapFeePercentage);
    }
}

File 59 of 86 : WeightedPoolUserDataHelpers.sol
// SPDX-License-Identifier: GPL-3.0-or-later
// This program is free software: you can redistribute it and/or modify
// it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
// the Free Software Foundation, either version 3 of the License, or
// (at your option) any later version.

// This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
// but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
// MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE.  See the
// GNU General Public License for more details.

// You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
// along with this program.  If not, see <http://www.gnu.org/licenses/>.

pragma solidity ^0.7.0;

import "../../lib/openzeppelin/IERC20.sol";

import "./WeightedPool.sol";

library WeightedPoolUserDataHelpers {
    function joinKind(bytes memory self) internal pure returns (WeightedPool.JoinKind) {
        return abi.decode(self, (WeightedPool.JoinKind));
    }

    function exitKind(bytes memory self) internal pure returns (WeightedPool.ExitKind) {
        return abi.decode(self, (WeightedPool.ExitKind));
    }

    // Joins

    function initialAmountsIn(bytes memory self) internal pure returns (uint256[] memory amountsIn) {
        (, amountsIn) = abi.decode(self, (WeightedPool.JoinKind, uint256[]));
    }

    function exactTokensInForBptOut(bytes memory self)
        internal
        pure
        returns (uint256[] memory amountsIn, uint256 minBPTAmountOut)
    {
        (, amountsIn, minBPTAmountOut) = abi.decode(self, (WeightedPool.JoinKind, uint256[], uint256));
    }

    function tokenInForExactBptOut(bytes memory self) internal pure returns (uint256 bptAmountOut, uint256 tokenIndex) {
        (, bptAmountOut, tokenIndex) = abi.decode(self, (WeightedPool.JoinKind, uint256, uint256));
    }

    // Exits

    function exactBptInForTokenOut(bytes memory self) internal pure returns (uint256 bptAmountIn, uint256 tokenIndex) {
        (, bptAmountIn, tokenIndex) = abi.decode(self, (WeightedPool.ExitKind, uint256, uint256));
    }

    function exactBptInForTokensOut(bytes memory self) internal pure returns (uint256 bptAmountIn) {
        (, bptAmountIn) = abi.decode(self, (WeightedPool.ExitKind, uint256));
    }

    function bptInForExactTokensOut(bytes memory self)
        internal
        pure
        returns (uint256[] memory amountsOut, uint256 maxBPTAmountIn)
    {
        (, amountsOut, maxBPTAmountIn) = abi.decode(self, (WeightedPool.ExitKind, uint256[], uint256));
    }
}

File 60 of 86 : BasePool.sol
// SPDX-License-Identifier: GPL-3.0-or-later
// This program is free software: you can redistribute it and/or modify
// it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
// the Free Software Foundation, either version 3 of the License, or
// (at your option) any later version.

// This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
// but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
// MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE.  See the
// GNU General Public License for more details.

// You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
// along with this program.  If not, see <http://www.gnu.org/licenses/>.

pragma solidity ^0.7.0;
pragma experimental ABIEncoderV2;

import "../lib/math/FixedPoint.sol";
import "../lib/helpers/InputHelpers.sol";
import "../lib/helpers/TemporarilyPausable.sol";
import "../lib/openzeppelin/ERC20.sol";

import "./BalancerPoolToken.sol";
import "./BasePoolAuthorization.sol";
import "../vault/interfaces/IVault.sol";
import "../vault/interfaces/IBasePool.sol";

// This contract relies on tons of immutable state variables to perform efficient lookup, without resorting to storage
// reads. Because immutable arrays are not supported, we instead declare a fixed set of state variables plus a total
// count, resulting in a large number of state variables.

// solhint-disable max-states-count

/**
 * @dev Reference implementation for the base layer of a Pool contract that manages a single Pool with an immutable set
 * of registered tokens, no Asset Managers, an admin-controlled swap fee percentage, and an emergency pause mechanism.
 *
 * Note that neither swap fees nor the pause mechanism are used by this contract. They are passed through so that
 * derived contracts can use them via the `_addSwapFeeAmount` and `_subtractSwapFeeAmount` functions, and the
 * `whenNotPaused` modifier.
 *
 * No admin permissions are checked here: instead, this contract delegates that to the Vault's own Authorizer.
 *
 * Because this contract doesn't implement the swap hooks, derived contracts should generally inherit from
 * BaseGeneralPool or BaseMinimalSwapInfoPool. Otherwise, subclasses must inherit from the corresponding interfaces
 * and implement the swap callbacks themselves.
 */
abstract contract BasePool is IBasePool, BasePoolAuthorization, BalancerPoolToken, TemporarilyPausable {
    using FixedPoint for uint256;

    uint256 private constant _MIN_TOKENS = 2;
    uint256 private constant _MAX_TOKENS = 8;

    // 1e18 corresponds to 1.0, or a 100% fee
    uint256 private constant _MIN_SWAP_FEE_PERCENTAGE = 1e12; // 0.0001%
    uint256 private constant _MAX_SWAP_FEE_PERCENTAGE = 1e17; // 10%

    uint256 private constant _MINIMUM_BPT = 1e6;

    uint256 internal _swapFeePercentage;

    IVault private immutable _vault;
    bytes32 private immutable _poolId;
    uint256 private immutable _totalTokens;

    IERC20 internal immutable _token0;
    IERC20 internal immutable _token1;
    IERC20 internal immutable _token2;
    IERC20 internal immutable _token3;
    IERC20 internal immutable _token4;
    IERC20 internal immutable _token5;
    IERC20 internal immutable _token6;
    IERC20 internal immutable _token7;

    // All token balances are normalized to behave as if the token had 18 decimals. We assume a token's decimals will
    // not change throughout its lifetime, and store the corresponding scaling factor for each at construction time.
    // These factors are always greater than or equal to one: tokens with more than 18 decimals are not supported.

    uint256 internal immutable _scalingFactor0;
    uint256 internal immutable _scalingFactor1;
    uint256 internal immutable _scalingFactor2;
    uint256 internal immutable _scalingFactor3;
    uint256 internal immutable _scalingFactor4;
    uint256 internal immutable _scalingFactor5;
    uint256 internal immutable _scalingFactor6;
    uint256 internal immutable _scalingFactor7;

    event SwapFeePercentageChanged(uint256 swapFeePercentage);

    constructor(
        IVault vault,
        IVault.PoolSpecialization specialization,
        string memory name,
        string memory symbol,
        IERC20[] memory tokens,
        uint256 swapFeePercentage,
        uint256 pauseWindowDuration,
        uint256 bufferPeriodDuration,
        address owner
    )
        // Base Pools are expected to be deployed using factories. By using the factory address as the action
        // disambiguator, we make all Pools deployed by the same factory share action identifiers. This allows for
        // simpler management of permissions (such as being able to manage granting the 'set fee percentage' action in
        // any Pool created by the same factory), while still making action identifiers unique among different factories
        // if the selectors match, preventing accidental errors.
        Authentication(bytes32(uint256(msg.sender)))
        BalancerPoolToken(name, symbol)
        BasePoolAuthorization(owner)
        TemporarilyPausable(pauseWindowDuration, bufferPeriodDuration)
    {
        _require(tokens.length >= _MIN_TOKENS, Errors.MIN_TOKENS);
        _require(tokens.length <= _MAX_TOKENS, Errors.MAX_TOKENS);

        // The Vault only requires the token list to be ordered for the Two Token Pools specialization. However,
        // to make the developer experience consistent, we are requiring this condition for all the native pools.
        // Also, since these Pools will register tokens only once, we can ensure the Pool tokens will follow the same
        // order. We rely on this property to make Pools simpler to write, as it lets us assume that the
        // order of token-specific parameters (such as token weights) will not change.
        InputHelpers.ensureArrayIsSorted(tokens);

        _setSwapFeePercentage(swapFeePercentage);

        bytes32 poolId = vault.registerPool(specialization);

        // Pass in zero addresses for Asset Managers
        vault.registerTokens(poolId, tokens, new address[](tokens.length));

        // Set immutable state variables - these cannot be read from during construction
        _vault = vault;
        _poolId = poolId;
        _totalTokens = tokens.length;

        // Immutable variables cannot be initialized inside an if statement, so we must do conditional assignments
        _token0 = tokens.length > 0 ? tokens[0] : IERC20(0);
        _token1 = tokens.length > 1 ? tokens[1] : IERC20(0);
        _token2 = tokens.length > 2 ? tokens[2] : IERC20(0);
        _token3 = tokens.length > 3 ? tokens[3] : IERC20(0);
        _token4 = tokens.length > 4 ? tokens[4] : IERC20(0);
        _token5 = tokens.length > 5 ? tokens[5] : IERC20(0);
        _token6 = tokens.length > 6 ? tokens[6] : IERC20(0);
        _token7 = tokens.length > 7 ? tokens[7] : IERC20(0);

        _scalingFactor0 = tokens.length > 0 ? _computeScalingFactor(tokens[0]) : 0;
        _scalingFactor1 = tokens.length > 1 ? _computeScalingFactor(tokens[1]) : 0;
        _scalingFactor2 = tokens.length > 2 ? _computeScalingFactor(tokens[2]) : 0;
        _scalingFactor3 = tokens.length > 3 ? _computeScalingFactor(tokens[3]) : 0;
        _scalingFactor4 = tokens.length > 4 ? _computeScalingFactor(tokens[4]) : 0;
        _scalingFactor5 = tokens.length > 5 ? _computeScalingFactor(tokens[5]) : 0;
        _scalingFactor6 = tokens.length > 6 ? _computeScalingFactor(tokens[6]) : 0;
        _scalingFactor7 = tokens.length > 7 ? _computeScalingFactor(tokens[7]) : 0;
    }

    // Getters / Setters

    function getVault() public view returns (IVault) {
        return _vault;
    }

    function getPoolId() public view returns (bytes32) {
        return _poolId;
    }

    function _getTotalTokens() internal view returns (uint256) {
        return _totalTokens;
    }

    function getSwapFeePercentage() external view returns (uint256) {
        return _swapFeePercentage;
    }

    // Caller must be approved by the Vault's Authorizer
    function setSwapFeePercentage(uint256 swapFeePercentage) external virtual authenticate whenNotPaused {
        _setSwapFeePercentage(swapFeePercentage);
    }

    function _setSwapFeePercentage(uint256 swapFeePercentage) private {
        _require(swapFeePercentage >= _MIN_SWAP_FEE_PERCENTAGE, Errors.MIN_SWAP_FEE_PERCENTAGE);
        _require(swapFeePercentage <= _MAX_SWAP_FEE_PERCENTAGE, Errors.MAX_SWAP_FEE_PERCENTAGE);

        _swapFeePercentage = swapFeePercentage;
        emit SwapFeePercentageChanged(swapFeePercentage);
    }

    // Caller must be approved by the Vault's Authorizer
    function setPaused(bool paused) external authenticate {
        _setPaused(paused);
    }

    // Join / Exit Hooks

    modifier onlyVault(bytes32 poolId) {
        _require(msg.sender == address(getVault()), Errors.CALLER_NOT_VAULT);
        _require(poolId == getPoolId(), Errors.INVALID_POOL_ID);
        _;
    }

    function onJoinPool(
        bytes32 poolId,
        address sender,
        address recipient,
        uint256[] memory balances,
        uint256 lastChangeBlock,
        uint256 protocolSwapFeePercentage,
        bytes memory userData
    ) external virtual override onlyVault(poolId) returns (uint256[] memory, uint256[] memory) {
        uint256[] memory scalingFactors = _scalingFactors();

        if (totalSupply() == 0) {
            (uint256 bptAmountOut, uint256[] memory amountsIn) = _onInitializePool(poolId, sender, recipient, userData);

            // On initialization, we lock _MINIMUM_BPT by minting it for the zero address. This BPT acts as a minimum
            // as it will never be burned, which reduces potential issues with rounding, and also prevents the Pool from
            // ever being fully drained.
            _require(bptAmountOut >= _MINIMUM_BPT, Errors.MINIMUM_BPT);
            _mintPoolTokens(address(0), _MINIMUM_BPT);
            _mintPoolTokens(recipient, bptAmountOut - _MINIMUM_BPT);

            // amountsIn are amounts entering the Pool, so we round up.
            _downscaleUpArray(amountsIn, scalingFactors);

            return (amountsIn, new uint256[](_getTotalTokens()));
        } else {
            _upscaleArray(balances, scalingFactors);
            (uint256 bptAmountOut, uint256[] memory amountsIn, uint256[] memory dueProtocolFeeAmounts) = _onJoinPool(
                poolId,
                sender,
                recipient,
                balances,
                lastChangeBlock,
                protocolSwapFeePercentage,
                userData
            );

            // Note we no longer use `balances` after calling `_onJoinPool`, which may mutate it.

            _mintPoolTokens(recipient, bptAmountOut);

            // amountsIn are amounts entering the Pool, so we round up.
            _downscaleUpArray(amountsIn, scalingFactors);
            // dueProtocolFeeAmounts are amounts exiting the Pool, so we round down.
            _downscaleDownArray(dueProtocolFeeAmounts, scalingFactors);

            return (amountsIn, dueProtocolFeeAmounts);
        }
    }

    function onExitPool(
        bytes32 poolId,
        address sender,
        address recipient,
        uint256[] memory balances,
        uint256 lastChangeBlock,
        uint256 protocolSwapFeePercentage,
        bytes memory userData
    ) external virtual override onlyVault(poolId) returns (uint256[] memory, uint256[] memory) {
        uint256[] memory scalingFactors = _scalingFactors();
        _upscaleArray(balances, scalingFactors);

        (uint256 bptAmountIn, uint256[] memory amountsOut, uint256[] memory dueProtocolFeeAmounts) = _onExitPool(
            poolId,
            sender,
            recipient,
            balances,
            lastChangeBlock,
            protocolSwapFeePercentage,
            userData
        );

        // Note we no longer use `balances` after calling `_onExitPool`, which may mutate it.

        _burnPoolTokens(sender, bptAmountIn);

        // Both amountsOut and dueProtocolFeeAmounts are amounts exiting the Pool, so we round down.
        _downscaleDownArray(amountsOut, scalingFactors);
        _downscaleDownArray(dueProtocolFeeAmounts, scalingFactors);

        return (amountsOut, dueProtocolFeeAmounts);
    }

    // Query functions

    /**
     * @dev Returns the amount of BPT that would be granted to `recipient` if the `onJoinPool` hook were called by the
     * Vault with the same arguments, along with the number of tokens `sender` would have to supply.
     *
     * This function is not meant to be called directly, but rather from a helper contract that fetches current Vault
     * data, such as the protocol swap fee percentage and Pool balances.
     *
     * Like `IVault.queryBatchSwap`, this function is not view due to internal implementation details: the caller must
     * explicitly use eth_call instead of eth_sendTransaction.
     */
    function queryJoin(
        bytes32 poolId,
        address sender,
        address recipient,
        uint256[] memory balances,
        uint256 lastChangeBlock,
        uint256 protocolSwapFeePercentage,
        bytes memory userData
    ) external returns (uint256 bptOut, uint256[] memory amountsIn) {
        InputHelpers.ensureInputLengthMatch(balances.length, _getTotalTokens());

        _queryAction(
            poolId,
            sender,
            recipient,
            balances,
            lastChangeBlock,
            protocolSwapFeePercentage,
            userData,
            _onJoinPool,
            _downscaleUpArray
        );

        // The `return` opcode is executed directly inside `_queryAction`, so execution never reaches this statement,
        // and we don't need to return anything here - it just silences compiler warnings.
        return (bptOut, amountsIn);
    }

    /**
     * @dev Returns the amount of BPT that would be burned from `sender` if the `onExitPool` hook were called by the
     * Vault with the same arguments, along with the number of tokens `recipient` would receive.
     *
     * This function is not meant to be called directly, but rather from a helper contract that fetches current Vault
     * data, such as the protocol swap fee percentage and Pool balances.
     *
     * Like `IVault.queryBatchSwap`, this function is not view due to internal implementation details: the caller must
     * explicitly use eth_call instead of eth_sendTransaction.
     */
    function queryExit(
        bytes32 poolId,
        address sender,
        address recipient,
        uint256[] memory balances,
        uint256 lastChangeBlock,
        uint256 protocolSwapFeePercentage,
        bytes memory userData
    ) external returns (uint256 bptIn, uint256[] memory amountsOut) {
        InputHelpers.ensureInputLengthMatch(balances.length, _getTotalTokens());

        _queryAction(
            poolId,
            sender,
            recipient,
            balances,
            lastChangeBlock,
            protocolSwapFeePercentage,
            userData,
            _onExitPool,
            _downscaleDownArray
        );

        // The `return` opcode is executed directly inside `_queryAction`, so execution never reaches this statement,
        // and we don't need to return anything here - it just silences compiler warnings.
        return (bptIn, amountsOut);
    }

    // Internal hooks to be overridden by derived contracts - all token amounts (except BPT) in these interfaces are
    // upscaled.

    /**
     * @dev Called when the Pool is joined for the first time; that is, when the BPT total supply is zero.
     *
     * Returns the amount of BPT to mint, and the token amounts the Pool will receive in return.
     *
     * Minted BPT will be sent to `recipient`, except for _MINIMUM_BPT, which will be deducted from this amount and sent
     * to the zero address instead. This will cause that BPT to remain forever locked there, preventing total BTP from
     * ever dropping below that value, and ensuring `_onInitializePool` can only be called once in the entire Pool's
     * lifetime.
     *
     * The tokens granted to the Pool will be transferred from `sender`. These amounts are considered upscaled and will
     * be downscaled (rounding up) before being returned to the Vault.
     */
    function _onInitializePool(
        bytes32 poolId,
        address sender,
        address recipient,
        bytes memory userData
    ) internal virtual returns (uint256 bptAmountOut, uint256[] memory amountsIn);

    /**
     * @dev Called whenever the Pool is joined after the first initialization join (see `_onInitializePool`).
     *
     * Returns the amount of BPT to mint, the token amounts that the Pool will receive in return, and the number of
     * tokens to pay in protocol swap fees.
     *
     * Implementations of this function might choose to mutate the `balances` array to save gas (e.g. when
     * performing intermediate calculations, such as subtraction of due protocol fees). This can be done safely.
     *
     * Minted BPT will be sent to `recipient`.
     *
     * The tokens granted to the Pool will be transferred from `sender`. These amounts are considered upscaled and will
     * be downscaled (rounding up) before being returned to the Vault.
     *
     * Due protocol swap fees will be taken from the Pool's balance in the Vault (see `IBasePool.onJoinPool`). These
     * amounts are considered upscaled and will be downscaled (rounding down) before being returned to the Vault.
     */
    function _onJoinPool(
        bytes32 poolId,
        address sender,
        address recipient,
        uint256[] memory balances,
        uint256 lastChangeBlock,
        uint256 protocolSwapFeePercentage,
        bytes memory userData
    )
        internal
        virtual
        returns (
            uint256 bptAmountOut,
            uint256[] memory amountsIn,
            uint256[] memory dueProtocolFeeAmounts
        );

    /**
     * @dev Called whenever the Pool is exited.
     *
     * Returns the amount of BPT to burn, the token amounts for each Pool token that the Pool will grant in return, and
     * the number of tokens to pay in protocol swap fees.
     *
     * Implementations of this function might choose to mutate the `balances` array to save gas (e.g. when
     * performing intermediate calculations, such as subtraction of due protocol fees). This can be done safely.
     *
     * BPT will be burnt from `sender`.
     *
     * The Pool will grant tokens to `recipient`. These amounts are considered upscaled and will be downscaled
     * (rounding down) before being returned to the Vault.
     *
     * Due protocol swap fees will be taken from the Pool's balance in the Vault (see `IBasePool.onExitPool`). These
     * amounts are considered upscaled and will be downscaled (rounding down) before being returned to the Vault.
     */
    function _onExitPool(
        bytes32 poolId,
        address sender,
        address recipient,
        uint256[] memory balances,
        uint256 lastChangeBlock,
        uint256 protocolSwapFeePercentage,
        bytes memory userData
    )
        internal
        virtual
        returns (
            uint256 bptAmountIn,
            uint256[] memory amountsOut,
            uint256[] memory dueProtocolFeeAmounts
        );

    // Internal functions

    /**
     * @dev Adds swap fee amount to `amount`, returning a higher value.
     */
    function _addSwapFeeAmount(uint256 amount) internal view returns (uint256) {
        // This returns amount + fee amount, so we round up (favoring a higher fee amount).
        return amount.divUp(_swapFeePercentage.complement());
    }

    /**
     * @dev Subtracts swap fee amount from `amount`, returning a lower value.
     */
    function _subtractSwapFeeAmount(uint256 amount) internal view returns (uint256) {
        // This returns amount - fee amount, so we round up (favoring a higher fee amount).
        uint256 feeAmount = amount.mulUp(_swapFeePercentage);
        return amount.sub(feeAmount);
    }

    // Scaling

    /**
     * @dev Returns a scaling factor that, when multiplied to a token amount for `token`, normalizes its balance as if
     * it had 18 decimals.
     */
    function _computeScalingFactor(IERC20 token) private view returns (uint256) {
        // Tokens that don't implement the `decimals` method are not supported.
        uint256 tokenDecimals = ERC20(address(token)).decimals();

        // Tokens with more than 18 decimals are not supported.
        uint256 decimalsDifference = Math.sub(18, tokenDecimals);
        return 10**decimalsDifference;
    }

    /**
     * @dev Returns the scaling factor for one of the Pool's tokens. Reverts if `token` is not a token registered by the
     * Pool.
     */
    function _scalingFactor(IERC20 token) internal view returns (uint256) {
        // prettier-ignore
        if (token == _token0) { return _scalingFactor0; }
        else if (token == _token1) { return _scalingFactor1; }
        else if (token == _token2) { return _scalingFactor2; }
        else if (token == _token3) { return _scalingFactor3; }
        else if (token == _token4) { return _scalingFactor4; }
        else if (token == _token5) { return _scalingFactor5; }
        else if (token == _token6) { return _scalingFactor6; }
        else if (token == _token7) { return _scalingFactor7; }
        else {
            _revert(Errors.INVALID_TOKEN);
        }
    }

    /**
     * @dev Returns all the scaling factors in the same order as the registered tokens. The Vault will always
     * pass balances in this order when calling any of the Pool hooks
     */
    function _scalingFactors() internal view returns (uint256[] memory) {
        uint256 totalTokens = _getTotalTokens();
        uint256[] memory scalingFactors = new uint256[](totalTokens);

        // prettier-ignore
        {
            if (totalTokens > 0) { scalingFactors[0] = _scalingFactor0; } else { return scalingFactors; }
            if (totalTokens > 1) { scalingFactors[1] = _scalingFactor1; } else { return scalingFactors; }
            if (totalTokens > 2) { scalingFactors[2] = _scalingFactor2; } else { return scalingFactors; }
            if (totalTokens > 3) { scalingFactors[3] = _scalingFactor3; } else { return scalingFactors; }
            if (totalTokens > 4) { scalingFactors[4] = _scalingFactor4; } else { return scalingFactors; }
            if (totalTokens > 5) { scalingFactors[5] = _scalingFactor5; } else { return scalingFactors; }
            if (totalTokens > 6) { scalingFactors[6] = _scalingFactor6; } else { return scalingFactors; }
            if (totalTokens > 7) { scalingFactors[7] = _scalingFactor7; } else { return scalingFactors; }
        }

        return scalingFactors;
    }

    /**
     * @dev Applies `scalingFactor` to `amount`, resulting in a larger or equal value depending on whether it needed
     * scaling or not.
     */
    function _upscale(uint256 amount, uint256 scalingFactor) internal pure returns (uint256) {
        return Math.mul(amount, scalingFactor);
    }

    /**
     * @dev Same as `_upscale`, but for an entire array. This function does not return anything, but instead *mutates*
     * the `amounts` array.
     */
    function _upscaleArray(uint256[] memory amounts, uint256[] memory scalingFactors) internal view {
        for (uint256 i = 0; i < _getTotalTokens(); ++i) {
            amounts[i] = Math.mul(amounts[i], scalingFactors[i]);
        }
    }

    /**
     * @dev Reverses the `scalingFactor` applied to `amount`, resulting in a smaller or equal value depending on
     * whether it needed scaling or not. The result is rounded down.
     */
    function _downscaleDown(uint256 amount, uint256 scalingFactor) internal pure returns (uint256) {
        return Math.divDown(amount, scalingFactor);
    }

    /**
     * @dev Same as `_downscaleDown`, but for an entire array. This function does not return anything, but instead
     * *mutates* the `amounts` array.
     */
    function _downscaleDownArray(uint256[] memory amounts, uint256[] memory scalingFactors) internal view {
        for (uint256 i = 0; i < _getTotalTokens(); ++i) {
            amounts[i] = Math.divDown(amounts[i], scalingFactors[i]);
        }
    }

    /**
     * @dev Reverses the `scalingFactor` applied to `amount`, resulting in a smaller or equal value depending on
     * whether it needed scaling or not. The result is rounded up.
     */
    function _downscaleUp(uint256 amount, uint256 scalingFactor) internal pure returns (uint256) {
        return Math.divUp(amount, scalingFactor);
    }

    /**
     * @dev Same as `_downscaleUp`, but for an entire array. This function does not return anything, but instead
     * *mutates* the `amounts` array.
     */
    function _downscaleUpArray(uint256[] memory amounts, uint256[] memory scalingFactors) internal view {
        for (uint256 i = 0; i < _getTotalTokens(); ++i) {
            amounts[i] = Math.divUp(amounts[i], scalingFactors[i]);
        }
    }

    function _getAuthorizer() internal view override returns (IAuthorizer) {
        // Access control management is delegated to the Vault's Authorizer. This lets Balancer Governance manage which
        // accounts can call permissioned functions: for example, to perform emergency pauses.
        // If the owner is delegated, then *all* permissioned functions, including `setSwapFeePercentage`, will be under
        // Governance control.
        return getVault().getAuthorizer();
    }

    function _queryAction(
        bytes32 poolId,
        address sender,
        address recipient,
        uint256[] memory balances,
        uint256 lastChangeBlock,
        uint256 protocolSwapFeePercentage,
        bytes memory userData,
        function(bytes32, address, address, uint256[] memory, uint256, uint256, bytes memory)
            internal
            returns (uint256, uint256[] memory, uint256[] memory) _action,
        function(uint256[] memory, uint256[] memory) internal view _downscaleArray
    ) private {
        // This uses the same technique used by the Vault in queryBatchSwap. Refer to that function for a detailed
        // explanation.

        if (msg.sender != address(this)) {
            // We perform an external call to ourselves, forwarding the same calldata. In this call, the else clause of
            // the preceding if statement will be executed instead.

            // solhint-disable-next-line avoid-low-level-calls
            (bool success, ) = address(this).call(msg.data);

            // solhint-disable-next-line no-inline-assembly
            assembly {
                // This call should always revert to decode the bpt and token amounts from the revert reason
                switch success
                    case 0 {
                        // Note we are manually writing the memory slot 0. We can safely overwrite whatever is
                        // stored there as we take full control of the execution and then immediately return.

                        // We copy the first 4 bytes to check if it matches with the expected signature, otherwise
                        // there was another revert reason and we should forward it.
                        returndatacopy(0, 0, 0x04)
                        let error := and(mload(0), 0xffffffff00000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000)

                        // If the first 4 bytes don't match with the expected signature, we forward the revert reason.
                        if eq(eq(error, 0x43adbafb00000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000), 0) {
                            returndatacopy(0, 0, returndatasize())
                            revert(0, returndatasize())
                        }

                        // The returndata contains the signature, followed by the raw memory representation of the
                        // `bptAmount` and `tokenAmounts` (array: length + data). We need to return an ABI-encoded
                        // representation of these.
                        // An ABI-encoded response will include one additional field to indicate the starting offset of
                        // the `tokenAmounts` array. The `bptAmount` will be laid out in the first word of the
                        // returndata.
                        //
                        // In returndata:
                        // [ signature ][ bptAmount ][ tokenAmounts length ][ tokenAmounts values ]
                        // [  4 bytes  ][  32 bytes ][       32 bytes      ][ (32 * length) bytes ]
                        //
                        // We now need to return (ABI-encoded values):
                        // [ bptAmount ][ tokeAmounts offset ][ tokenAmounts length ][ tokenAmounts values ]
                        // [  32 bytes ][       32 bytes     ][       32 bytes      ][ (32 * length) bytes ]

                        // We copy 32 bytes for the `bptAmount` from returndata into memory.
                        // Note that we skip the first 4 bytes for the error signature
                        returndatacopy(0, 0x04, 32)

                        // The offsets are 32-bytes long, so the array of `tokenAmounts` will start after
                        // the initial 64 bytes.
                        mstore(0x20, 64)

                        // We now copy the raw memory array for the `tokenAmounts` from returndata into memory.
                        // Since bpt amount and offset take up 64 bytes, we start copying at address 0x40. We also
                        // skip the first 36 bytes from returndata, which correspond to the signature plus bpt amount.
                        returndatacopy(0x40, 0x24, sub(returndatasize(), 36))

                        // We finally return the ABI-encoded uint256 and the array, which has a total length equal to
                        // the size of returndata, plus the 32 bytes of the offset but without the 4 bytes of the
                        // error signature.
                        return(0, add(returndatasize(), 28))
                    }
                    default {
                        // This call should always revert, but we fail nonetheless if that didn't happen
                        invalid()
                    }
            }
        } else {
            uint256[] memory scalingFactors = _scalingFactors();
            _upscaleArray(balances, scalingFactors);

            (uint256 bptAmount, uint256[] memory tokenAmounts, ) = _action(
                poolId,
                sender,
                recipient,
                balances,
                lastChangeBlock,
                protocolSwapFeePercentage,
                userData
            );

            _downscaleArray(tokenAmounts, scalingFactors);

            // solhint-disable-next-line no-inline-assembly
            assembly {
                // We will return a raw representation of `bptAmount` and `tokenAmounts` in memory, which is composed of
                // a 32-byte uint256, followed by a 32-byte for the array length, and finally the 32-byte uint256 values
                // Because revert expects a size in bytes, we multiply the array length (stored at `tokenAmounts`) by 32
                let size := mul(mload(tokenAmounts), 32)

                // We store the `bptAmount` in the previous slot to the `tokenAmounts` array. We can make sure there
                // will be at least one available slot due to how the memory scratch space works.
                // We can safely overwrite whatever is stored in this slot as we will revert immediately after that.
                let start := sub(tokenAmounts, 0x20)
                mstore(start, bptAmount)

                // We send one extra value for the error signature "QueryError(uint256,uint256[])" which is 0x43adbafb
                // We use the previous slot to `bptAmount`.
                mstore(sub(start, 0x20), 0x0000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000043adbafb)
                start := sub(start, 0x04)

                // When copying from `tokenAmounts` into returndata, we copy the additional 68 bytes to also return
                // the `bptAmount`, the array 's length, and the error signature.
                revert(start, add(size, 68))
            }
        }
    }
}

File 61 of 86 : BalancerPoolToken.sol
// SPDX-License-Identifier: GPL-3.0-or-later
// This program is free software: you can redistribute it and/or modify
// it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
// the Free Software Foundation, either version 3 of the License, or
// (at your option) any later version.

// This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
// but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
// MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE.  See the
// GNU General Public License for more details.

// You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
// along with this program.  If not, see <http://www.gnu.org/licenses/>.

pragma solidity ^0.7.0;

import "../lib/math/Math.sol";
import "../lib/openzeppelin/IERC20.sol";
import "../lib/openzeppelin/IERC20Permit.sol";
import "../lib/openzeppelin/EIP712.sol";

/**
 * @title Highly opinionated token implementation
 * @author Balancer Labs
 * @dev
 * - Includes functions to increase and decrease allowance as a workaround
 *   for the well-known issue with `approve`:
 *   https://github.com/ethereum/EIPs/issues/20#issuecomment-263524729
 * - Allows for 'infinite allowance', where an allowance of 0xff..ff is not
 *   decreased by calls to transferFrom
 * - Lets a token holder use `transferFrom` to send their own tokens,
 *   without first setting allowance
 * - Emits 'Approval' events whenever allowance is changed by `transferFrom`
 */
contract BalancerPoolToken is IERC20, IERC20Permit, EIP712 {
    using Math for uint256;

    // State variables

    uint8 private constant _DECIMALS = 18;

    mapping(address => uint256) private _balance;
    mapping(address => mapping(address => uint256)) private _allowance;
    uint256 private _totalSupply;

    string private _name;
    string private _symbol;

    mapping(address => uint256) private _nonces;

    // solhint-disable-next-line var-name-mixedcase
    bytes32 private immutable _PERMIT_TYPE_HASH = keccak256(
        "Permit(address owner,address spender,uint256 value,uint256 nonce,uint256 deadline)"
    );

    // Function declarations

    constructor(string memory tokenName, string memory tokenSymbol) EIP712(tokenName, "1") {
        _name = tokenName;
        _symbol = tokenSymbol;
    }

    // External functions

    function allowance(address owner, address spender) external view override returns (uint256) {
        return _allowance[owner][spender];
    }

    function balanceOf(address account) external view override returns (uint256) {
        return _balance[account];
    }

    function approve(address spender, uint256 amount) external override returns (bool) {
        _setAllowance(msg.sender, spender, amount);

        return true;
    }

    function increaseApproval(address spender, uint256 amount) external returns (bool) {
        _setAllowance(msg.sender, spender, _allowance[msg.sender][spender].add(amount));

        return true;
    }

    function decreaseApproval(address spender, uint256 amount) external returns (bool) {
        uint256 currentAllowance = _allowance[msg.sender][spender];

        if (amount >= currentAllowance) {
            _setAllowance(msg.sender, spender, 0);
        } else {
            _setAllowance(msg.sender, spender, currentAllowance.sub(amount));
        }

        return true;
    }

    function transfer(address recipient, uint256 amount) external override returns (bool) {
        _move(msg.sender, recipient, amount);

        return true;
    }

    function transferFrom(
        address sender,
        address recipient,
        uint256 amount
    ) external override returns (bool) {
        uint256 currentAllowance = _allowance[sender][msg.sender];
        _require(msg.sender == sender || currentAllowance >= amount, Errors.INSUFFICIENT_ALLOWANCE);

        _move(sender, recipient, amount);

        if (msg.sender != sender && currentAllowance != uint256(-1)) {
            // Because of the previous require, we know that if msg.sender != sender then currentAllowance >= amount
            _setAllowance(sender, msg.sender, currentAllowance - amount);
        }

        return true;
    }

    function permit(
        address owner,
        address spender,
        uint256 value,
        uint256 deadline,
        uint8 v,
        bytes32 r,
        bytes32 s
    ) public virtual override {
        // solhint-disable-next-line not-rely-on-time
        _require(block.timestamp <= deadline, Errors.EXPIRED_PERMIT);

        uint256 nonce = _nonces[owner];

        bytes32 structHash = keccak256(abi.encode(_PERMIT_TYPE_HASH, owner, spender, value, nonce, deadline));

        bytes32 hash = _hashTypedDataV4(structHash);

        address signer = ecrecover(hash, v, r, s);
        _require((signer != address(0)) && (signer == owner), Errors.INVALID_SIGNATURE);

        _nonces[owner] = nonce + 1;
        _setAllowance(owner, spender, value);
    }

    // Public functions

    function name() public view returns (string memory) {
        return _name;
    }

    function symbol() public view returns (string memory) {
        return _symbol;
    }

    function decimals() public pure returns (uint8) {
        return _DECIMALS;
    }

    function totalSupply() public view override returns (uint256) {
        return _totalSupply;
    }

    function nonces(address owner) external view override returns (uint256) {
        return _nonces[owner];
    }

    // solhint-disable-next-line func-name-mixedcase
    function DOMAIN_SEPARATOR() external view override returns (bytes32) {
        return _domainSeparatorV4();
    }

    // Internal functions

    function _mintPoolTokens(address recipient, uint256 amount) internal {
        _balance[recipient] = _balance[recipient].add(amount);
        _totalSupply = _totalSupply.add(amount);
        emit Transfer(address(0), recipient, amount);
    }

    function _burnPoolTokens(address sender, uint256 amount) internal {
        uint256 currentBalance = _balance[sender];
        _require(currentBalance >= amount, Errors.INSUFFICIENT_BALANCE);

        _balance[sender] = currentBalance - amount;
        _totalSupply = _totalSupply.sub(amount);
        emit Transfer(sender, address(0), amount);
    }

    function _move(
        address sender,
        address recipient,
        uint256 amount
    ) internal {
        uint256 currentBalance = _balance[sender];
        _require(currentBalance >= amount, Errors.INSUFFICIENT_BALANCE);
        // Prohibit transfers to the zero address to avoid confusion with the
        // Transfer event emitted by `_burnPoolTokens`
        _require(recipient != address(0), Errors.ERC20_TRANSFER_TO_ZERO_ADDRESS);

        _balance[sender] = currentBalance - amount;
        _balance[recipient] = _balance[recipient].add(amount);

        emit Transfer(sender, recipient, amount);
    }

    // Private functions

    function _setAllowance(
        address owner,
        address spender,
        uint256 amount
    ) private {
        _allowance[owner][spender] = amount;
        emit Approval(owner, spender, amount);
    }
}

File 62 of 86 : BasePoolAuthorization.sol
// SPDX-License-Identifier: GPL-3.0-or-later
// This program is free software: you can redistribute it and/or modify
// it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
// the Free Software Foundation, either version 3 of the License, or
// (at your option) any later version.

// This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
// but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
// MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE.  See the
// GNU General Public License for more details.

// You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
// along with this program.  If not, see <http://www.gnu.org/licenses/>.

pragma solidity ^0.7.0;

import "../lib/helpers/Authentication.sol";
import "../vault/interfaces/IAuthorizer.sol";

import "./BasePool.sol";

/**
 * @dev Base authorization layer implementation for Pools.
 *
 * The owner account can call some of the permissioned functions - access control of the rest is delegated to the
 * Authorizer. Note that this owner is immutable: more sophisticated permission schemes, such as multiple ownership,
 * granular roles, etc., could be built on top of this by making the owner a smart contract.
 *
 * Access control of all other permissioned functions is delegated to an Authorizer. It is also possible to delegate
 * control of *all* permissioned functions to the Authorizer by setting the owner address to `_DELEGATE_OWNER`.
 */
abstract contract BasePoolAuthorization is Authentication {
    address private immutable _owner;

    address private constant _DELEGATE_OWNER = 0xBA1BA1ba1BA1bA1bA1Ba1BA1ba1BA1bA1ba1ba1B;

    constructor(address owner) {
        _owner = owner;
    }

    function getOwner() public view returns (address) {
        return _owner;
    }

    function getAuthorizer() external view returns (IAuthorizer) {
        return _getAuthorizer();
    }

    function _canPerform(bytes32 actionId, address account) internal view override returns (bool) {
        if ((getOwner() != _DELEGATE_OWNER) && _isOwnerOnlyAction(actionId)) {
            // Only the owner can perform "owner only" actions, unless the owner is delegated.
            return msg.sender == getOwner();
        } else {
            // Non-owner actions are always processed via the Authorizer, as "owner only" ones are when delegated.
            return _getAuthorizer().canPerform(actionId, account, address(this));
        }
    }

    function _isOwnerOnlyAction(bytes32 actionId) private view returns (bool) {
        // This implementation hardcodes the setSwapFeePercentage action identifier.
        return actionId == getActionId(BasePool.setSwapFeePercentage.selector);
    }

    function _getAuthorizer() internal view virtual returns (IAuthorizer);
}

File 63 of 86 : IERC20Permit.sol
// SPDX-License-Identifier: MIT

pragma solidity ^0.7.0;

/**
 * @dev Interface of the ERC20 Permit extension allowing approvals to be made via signatures, as defined in
 * https://eips.ethereum.org/EIPS/eip-2612[EIP-2612].
 *
 * Adds the {permit} method, which can be used to change an account's ERC20 allowance (see {IERC20-allowance}) by
 * presenting a message signed by the account. By not relying on `{IERC20-approve}`, the token holder account doesn't
 * need to send a transaction, and thus is not required to hold Ether at all.
 */
interface IERC20Permit {
    /**
     * @dev Sets `value` as the allowance of `spender` over `owner`'s tokens,
     * given `owner`'s signed approval.
     *
     * IMPORTANT: The same issues {IERC20-approve} has related to transaction
     * ordering also apply here.
     *
     * Emits an {Approval} event.
     *
     * Requirements:
     *
     * - `spender` cannot be the zero address.
     * - `deadline` must be a timestamp in the future.
     * - `v`, `r` and `s` must be a valid `secp256k1` signature from `owner`
     * over the EIP712-formatted function arguments.
     * - the signature must use ``owner``'s current nonce (see {nonces}).
     *
     * For more information on the signature format, see the
     * https://eips.ethereum.org/EIPS/eip-2612#specification[relevant EIP
     * section].
     */
    function permit(
        address owner,
        address spender,
        uint256 value,
        uint256 deadline,
        uint8 v,
        bytes32 r,
        bytes32 s
    ) external;

    /**
     * @dev Returns the current nonce for `owner`. This value must be
     * included whenever a signature is generated for {permit}.
     *
     * Every successful call to {permit} increases ``owner``'s nonce by one. This
     * prevents a signature from being used multiple times.
     */
    function nonces(address owner) external view returns (uint256);

    /**
     * @dev Returns the domain separator used in the encoding of the signature for `permit`, as defined by {EIP712}.
     */
    // solhint-disable-next-line func-name-mixedcase
    function DOMAIN_SEPARATOR() external view returns (bytes32);
}

File 64 of 86 : Authorizer.sol
// SPDX-License-Identifier: GPL-3.0-or-later
// This program is free software: you can redistribute it and/or modify
// it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
// the Free Software Foundation, either version 3 of the License, or
// (at your option) any later version.

// This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
// but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
// MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE.  See the
// GNU General Public License for more details.

// You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
// along with this program.  If not, see <http://www.gnu.org/licenses/>.

pragma solidity ^0.7.0;

import "./interfaces/IAuthorizer.sol";
import "../lib/openzeppelin/AccessControl.sol";
import "../lib/helpers/InputHelpers.sol";

/**
 * @dev Basic Authorizer implementation, based on OpenZeppelin's Access Control.
 *
 * Users are allowed to perform actions if they have the role with the same identifier. In this sense, roles are not
 * being truly used as such, since they each map to a single action identifier.
 *
 * This temporary implementation is expected to be replaced soon after launch by a more sophisticated one, able to
 * manage permissions across multiple contracts and to natively handle timelocks.
 */
contract Authorizer is AccessControl, IAuthorizer {
    constructor(address admin) {
        _setupRole(DEFAULT_ADMIN_ROLE, admin);
    }

    function canPerform(
        bytes32 actionId,
        address account,
        address
    ) public view override returns (bool) {
        // This Authorizer ignores the 'where' field completely.
        return AccessControl.hasRole(actionId, account);
    }

    /**
     * @dev Grants multiple roles to a single account.
     */
    function grantRoles(bytes32[] memory roles, address account) external {
        for (uint256 i = 0; i < roles.length; i++) {
            grantRole(roles[i], account);
        }
    }

    /**
     * @dev Grants roles to a list of accounts.
     */
    function grantRolesToMany(bytes32[] memory roles, address[] memory accounts) external {
        InputHelpers.ensureInputLengthMatch(roles.length, accounts.length);
        for (uint256 i = 0; i < roles.length; i++) {
            grantRole(roles[i], accounts[i]);
        }
    }

    /**
     * @dev Revokes multiple roles from a single account.
     */
    function revokeRoles(bytes32[] memory roles, address account) external {
        for (uint256 i = 0; i < roles.length; i++) {
            revokeRole(roles[i], account);
        }
    }

    /**
     * @dev Revokes roles from a list of accounts.
     */
    function revokeRolesFromMany(bytes32[] memory roles, address[] memory accounts) external {
        InputHelpers.ensureInputLengthMatch(roles.length, accounts.length);
        for (uint256 i = 0; i < roles.length; i++) {
            revokeRole(roles[i], accounts[i]);
        }
    }
}

File 65 of 86 : EnumerableMapMock.sol
// SPDX-License-Identifier: MIT

pragma solidity ^0.7.0;

import "../../lib/openzeppelin/EnumerableMap.sol";
import "../../lib/openzeppelin/IERC20.sol";

// solhint-disable func-name-mixedcase

contract EnumerableIERC20ToBytes32MapMock {
    using EnumerableMap for EnumerableMap.IERC20ToBytes32Map;

    event OperationResult(bool result);

    EnumerableMap.IERC20ToBytes32Map private _map;

    function contains(IERC20 key) public view returns (bool) {
        return _map.contains(key);
    }

    function set(IERC20 key, bytes32 value) public {
        bool result = _map.set(key, value);
        emit OperationResult(result);
    }

    function unchecked_indexOf(IERC20 key) public view returns (uint256) {
        return _map.unchecked_indexOf(key);
    }

    function unchecked_setAt(uint256 index, bytes32 value) public {
        _map.unchecked_setAt(index, value);
    }

    function remove(IERC20 key) public {
        bool result = _map.remove(key);
        emit OperationResult(result);
    }

    function length() public view returns (uint256) {
        return _map.length();
    }

    function at(uint256 index) public view returns (IERC20 key, bytes32 value) {
        return _map.at(index);
    }

    function unchecked_at(uint256 index) public view returns (IERC20 key, bytes32 value) {
        return _map.unchecked_at(index);
    }

    function unchecked_valueAt(uint256 index) public view returns (bytes32 value) {
        return _map.unchecked_valueAt(index);
    }

    function get(IERC20 key, uint256 errorCode) public view returns (bytes32) {
        return _map.get(key, errorCode);
    }
}

File 66 of 86 : ReentrancyMock.sol
// SPDX-License-Identifier: MIT

pragma solidity ^0.7.0;

import "../../lib/openzeppelin/ReentrancyGuard.sol";
import "./ReentrancyAttack.sol";

contract ReentrancyMock is ReentrancyGuard {
    uint256 public counter;

    constructor() {
        counter = 0;
    }

    function callback() external nonReentrant {
        _count();
    }

    function countLocalRecursive(uint256 n) public nonReentrant {
        if (n > 0) {
            _count();
            countLocalRecursive(n - 1);
        }
    }

    function countThisRecursive(uint256 n) public nonReentrant {
        if (n > 0) {
            _count();
            // solhint-disable-next-line avoid-low-level-calls
            (bool success, ) = address(this).call(abi.encodeWithSignature("countThisRecursive(uint256)", n - 1));
            require(success, "REENTRANCY_MOCK");
        }
    }

    function countAndCall(ReentrancyAttack attacker) public nonReentrant {
        _count();
        bytes4 func = bytes4(keccak256("callback()"));
        attacker.callSender(func);
    }

    function _count() private {
        counter += 1;
    }
}

File 67 of 86 : ReentrancyAttack.sol
// SPDX-License-Identifier: MIT

pragma solidity >=0.6.0 <0.8.0;

contract ReentrancyAttack {
    function callSender(bytes4 data) public {
        // solhint-disable-next-line avoid-low-level-calls
        (bool success, ) = msg.sender.call(abi.encodeWithSelector(data));
        require(success, "REENTRANCY_ATTACK");
    }
}

File 68 of 86 : MockBasePool.sol
// SPDX-License-Identifier: GPL-3.0-or-later
// This program is free software: you can redistribute it and/or modify
// it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
// the Free Software Foundation, either version 3 of the License, or
// (at your option) any later version.

// This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
// but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
// MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE.  See the
// GNU General Public License for more details.

// You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
// along with this program.  If not, see <http://www.gnu.org/licenses/>.

pragma solidity ^0.7.0;
pragma experimental ABIEncoderV2;

import "../pools/BasePool.sol";

contract MockBasePool is BasePool {
    constructor(
        IVault vault,
        IVault.PoolSpecialization specialization,
        string memory name,
        string memory symbol,
        IERC20[] memory tokens,
        uint256 swapFeePercentage,
        uint256 pauseWindowDuration,
        uint256 bufferPeriodDuration,
        address owner
    )
        BasePool(
            vault,
            specialization,
            name,
            symbol,
            tokens,
            swapFeePercentage,
            pauseWindowDuration,
            bufferPeriodDuration,
            owner
        )
    {}

    function _onInitializePool(
        bytes32 poolId,
        address sender,
        address recipient,
        bytes memory userData
    ) internal override returns (uint256, uint256[] memory) {}

    function _onJoinPool(
        bytes32 poolId,
        address sender,
        address recipient,
        uint256[] memory currentBalances,
        uint256 lastChangeBlock,
        uint256 protocolSwapFeePercentage,
        bytes memory userData
    )
        internal
        override
        returns (
            uint256,
            uint256[] memory,
            uint256[] memory
        )
    {}

    function _onExitPool(
        bytes32 poolId,
        address sender,
        address recipient,
        uint256[] memory currentBalances,
        uint256 lastChangeBlock,
        uint256 protocolSwapFeePercentage,
        bytes memory userData
    )
        internal
        override
        returns (
            uint256,
            uint256[] memory,
            uint256[] memory
        )
    {}

}

File 69 of 86 : MockPool.sol
// SPDX-License-Identifier: GPL-3.0-or-later
// This program is free software: you can redistribute it and/or modify
// it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
// the Free Software Foundation, either version 3 of the License, or
// (at your option) any later version.

// This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
// but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
// MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE.  See the
// GNU General Public License for more details.

// You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
// along with this program.  If not, see <http://www.gnu.org/licenses/>.

pragma solidity ^0.7.0;
pragma experimental ABIEncoderV2;

import "../lib/math/FixedPoint.sol";
import "../lib/openzeppelin/IERC20.sol";

import "../vault/interfaces/IVault.sol";
import "../vault/interfaces/IGeneralPool.sol";
import "../vault/interfaces/IMinimalSwapInfoPool.sol";

contract MockPool is IGeneralPool, IMinimalSwapInfoPool {
    using FixedPoint for uint256;

    IVault private immutable _vault;
    bytes32 private immutable _poolId;

    constructor(IVault vault, IVault.PoolSpecialization specialization) {
        _poolId = vault.registerPool(specialization);
        _vault = vault;
    }

    function getVault() external view returns (IVault) {
        return _vault;
    }

    function getPoolId() external view returns (bytes32) {
        return _poolId;
    }

    function registerTokens(IERC20[] memory tokens, address[] memory assetManagers) external {
        _vault.registerTokens(_poolId, tokens, assetManagers);
    }

    function deregisterTokens(IERC20[] memory tokens) external {
        _vault.deregisterTokens(_poolId, tokens);
    }

    event OnJoinPoolCalled(
        bytes32 poolId,
        address sender,
        address recipient,
        uint256[] currentBalances,
        uint256 lastChangeBlock,
        uint256 protocolSwapFeePercentage,
        bytes userData
    );

    event OnExitPoolCalled(
        bytes32 poolId,
        address sender,
        address recipient,
        uint256[] currentBalances,
        uint256 lastChangeBlock,
        uint256 protocolSwapFeePercentage,
        bytes userData
    );

    function onJoinPool(
        bytes32 poolId,
        address sender,
        address recipient,
        uint256[] memory currentBalances,
        uint256 lastChangeBlock,
        uint256 protocolSwapFeePercentage,
        bytes memory userData
    ) external override returns (uint256[] memory amountsIn, uint256[] memory dueProtocolFeeAmounts) {
        emit OnJoinPoolCalled(
            poolId,
            sender,
            recipient,
            currentBalances,
            lastChangeBlock,
            protocolSwapFeePercentage,
            userData
        );

        (amountsIn, dueProtocolFeeAmounts) = abi.decode(userData, (uint256[], uint256[]));
    }

    function onExitPool(
        bytes32 poolId,
        address sender,
        address recipient,
        uint256[] memory currentBalances,
        uint256 lastChangeBlock,
        uint256 protocolSwapFeePercentage,
        bytes memory userData
    ) external override returns (uint256[] memory amountsOut, uint256[] memory dueProtocolFeeAmounts) {
        emit OnExitPoolCalled(
            poolId,
            sender,
            recipient,
            currentBalances,
            lastChangeBlock,
            protocolSwapFeePercentage,
            userData
        );

        (amountsOut, dueProtocolFeeAmounts) = abi.decode(userData, (uint256[], uint256[]));
    }

    // Amounts in are multiplied by the multiplier, amounts out are divided by it
    uint256 private _multiplier = FixedPoint.ONE;

    function setMultiplier(uint256 newMultiplier) external {
        _multiplier = newMultiplier;
    }

    // IGeneralPool
    function onSwap(
        SwapRequest memory swapRequest,
        uint256[] memory,
        uint256,
        uint256
    ) external view override returns (uint256 amount) {
        return
            swapRequest.kind == IVault.SwapKind.GIVEN_IN
                ? swapRequest.amount.mulDown(_multiplier)
                : swapRequest.amount.divDown(_multiplier);
    }

    // IMinimalSwapInfoPool
    function onSwap(
        SwapRequest memory swapRequest,
        uint256,
        uint256
    ) external view override returns (uint256) {
        return
            swapRequest.kind == IVault.SwapKind.GIVEN_IN
                ? swapRequest.amount.mulDown(_multiplier)
                : swapRequest.amount.divDown(_multiplier);
    }

}

File 70 of 86 : BaseGeneralPool.sol
// SPDX-License-Identifier: GPL-3.0-or-later
// This program is free software: you can redistribute it and/or modify
// it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
// the Free Software Foundation, either version 3 of the License, or
// (at your option) any later version.

// This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
// but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
// MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE.  See the
// GNU General Public License for more details.

// You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
// along with this program.  If not, see <http://www.gnu.org/licenses/>.

pragma solidity ^0.7.0;
pragma experimental ABIEncoderV2;

import "./BasePool.sol";
import "../vault/interfaces/IGeneralPool.sol";

/**
 * @dev Extension of `BasePool`, adding a handler for `IGeneralPool.onSwap`.
 *
 * Derived contracts must implement `_onSwapGivenIn` and `_onSwapGivenOut` along with `BasePool`'s virtual functions.
 */
abstract contract BaseGeneralPool is IGeneralPool, BasePool {
    constructor(
        IVault vault,
        string memory name,
        string memory symbol,
        IERC20[] memory tokens,
        uint256 swapFeePercentage,
        uint256 pauseWindowDuration,
        uint256 bufferPeriodDuration,
        address owner
    )
        BasePool(
            vault,
            IVault.PoolSpecialization.GENERAL,
            name,
            symbol,
            tokens,
            swapFeePercentage,
            pauseWindowDuration,
            bufferPeriodDuration,
            owner
        )
    {
        // solhint-disable-previous-line no-empty-blocks
    }

    // Swap Hooks

    function onSwap(
        SwapRequest memory swapRequest,
        uint256[] memory balances,
        uint256 indexIn,
        uint256 indexOut
    ) external view virtual override returns (uint256) {
        _validateIndexes(indexIn, indexOut, _getTotalTokens());
        uint256[] memory scalingFactors = _scalingFactors();

        return
            swapRequest.kind == IVault.SwapKind.GIVEN_IN
                ? _swapGivenIn(swapRequest, balances, indexIn, indexOut, scalingFactors)
                : _swapGivenOut(swapRequest, balances, indexIn, indexOut, scalingFactors);
    }

    function _swapGivenIn(
        SwapRequest memory swapRequest,
        uint256[] memory balances,
        uint256 indexIn,
        uint256 indexOut,
        uint256[] memory scalingFactors
    ) internal view returns (uint256) {
        // Fees are subtracted before scaling, to reduce the complexity of the rounding direction analysis.
        swapRequest.amount = _subtractSwapFeeAmount(swapRequest.amount);

        _upscaleArray(balances, scalingFactors);
        swapRequest.amount = _upscale(swapRequest.amount, scalingFactors[indexIn]);

        uint256 amountOut = _onSwapGivenIn(swapRequest, balances, indexIn, indexOut);

        // amountOut tokens are exiting the Pool, so we round down.
        return _downscaleDown(amountOut, scalingFactors[indexOut]);
    }

    function _swapGivenOut(
        SwapRequest memory swapRequest,
        uint256[] memory balances,
        uint256 indexIn,
        uint256 indexOut,
        uint256[] memory scalingFactors
    ) internal view returns (uint256) {
        _upscaleArray(balances, scalingFactors);
        swapRequest.amount = _upscale(swapRequest.amount, scalingFactors[indexOut]);

        uint256 amountIn = _onSwapGivenOut(swapRequest, balances, indexIn, indexOut);

        // amountIn tokens are entering the Pool, so we round up.
        amountIn = _downscaleUp(amountIn, scalingFactors[indexIn]);

        // Fees are added after scaling happens, to reduce the complexity of the rounding direction analysis.
        return _addSwapFeeAmount(amountIn);
    }

    /*
     * @dev Called when a swap with the Pool occurs, where the amount of tokens entering the Pool is known.
     *
     * Returns the amount of tokens that will be taken from the Pool in return.
     *
     * All amounts inside `swapRequest` and `balances` are upscaled. The swap fee has already been deducted from
     * `swapRequest.amount`.
     *
     * The return value is also considered upscaled, and will be downscaled (rounding down) before returning it to the
     * Vault.
     */
    function _onSwapGivenIn(
        SwapRequest memory swapRequest,
        uint256[] memory balances,
        uint256 indexIn,
        uint256 indexOut
    ) internal view virtual returns (uint256);

    /*
     * @dev Called when a swap with the Pool occurs, where the amount of tokens exiting the Pool is known.
     *
     * Returns the amount of tokens that will be granted to the Pool in return.
     *
     * All amounts inside `swapRequest` and `balances` are upscaled.
     *
     * The return value is also considered upscaled, and will be downscaled (rounding up) before applying the swap fee
     * and returning it to the Vault.
     */
    function _onSwapGivenOut(
        SwapRequest memory swapRequest,
        uint256[] memory balances,
        uint256 indexIn,
        uint256 indexOut
    ) internal view virtual returns (uint256);

    function _validateIndexes(
        uint256 indexIn,
        uint256 indexOut,
        uint256 limit
    ) private pure {
        _require(indexIn < limit && indexOut < limit, Errors.OUT_OF_BOUNDS);
    }
}

File 71 of 86 : StablePool.sol
// SPDX-License-Identifier: GPL-3.0-or-later
// This program is free software: you can redistribute it and/or modify
// it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
// the Free Software Foundation, either version 3 of the License, or
// (at your option) any later version.

// This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
// but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
// MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE.  See the
// GNU General Public License for more details.

// You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
// along with this program.  If not, see <http://www.gnu.org/licenses/>.

pragma solidity ^0.7.0;
pragma experimental ABIEncoderV2;

import "../../lib/math/FixedPoint.sol";
import "../../lib/helpers/InputHelpers.sol";

import "../BaseGeneralPool.sol";

import "./StableMath.sol";
import "./StablePoolUserDataHelpers.sol";

contract StablePool is BaseGeneralPool, StableMath {
    using FixedPoint for uint256;
    using StablePoolUserDataHelpers for bytes;

    uint256 private immutable _amplificationParameter;

    uint256 private _lastInvariant;

    enum JoinKind { INIT, EXACT_TOKENS_IN_FOR_BPT_OUT, TOKEN_IN_FOR_EXACT_BPT_OUT }
    enum ExitKind { EXACT_BPT_IN_FOR_ONE_TOKEN_OUT, EXACT_BPT_IN_FOR_TOKENS_OUT, BPT_IN_FOR_EXACT_TOKENS_OUT }

    constructor(
        IVault vault,
        string memory name,
        string memory symbol,
        IERC20[] memory tokens,
        uint256 amplificationParameter,
        uint256 swapFeePercentage,
        uint256 pauseWindowDuration,
        uint256 bufferPeriodDuration,
        address owner
    )
        BaseGeneralPool(
            vault,
            name,
            symbol,
            tokens,
            swapFeePercentage,
            pauseWindowDuration,
            bufferPeriodDuration,
            owner
        )
    {
        _require(amplificationParameter >= _MIN_AMP, Errors.MIN_AMP);
        _require(amplificationParameter <= _MAX_AMP, Errors.MAX_AMP);

        _require(tokens.length <= _MAX_STABLE_TOKENS, Errors.MAX_STABLE_TOKENS);

        _amplificationParameter = amplificationParameter;
    }

    function getAmplificationParameter() external view returns (uint256) {
        return _amplificationParameter;
    }

    // Base Pool handlers

    // Swap

    function _onSwapGivenIn(
        SwapRequest memory swapRequest,
        uint256[] memory balances,
        uint256 indexIn,
        uint256 indexOut
    ) internal view virtual override whenNotPaused returns (uint256) {
        uint256 amountOut = StableMath._calcOutGivenIn(
            _amplificationParameter,
            balances,
            indexIn,
            indexOut,
            swapRequest.amount
        );

        return amountOut;
    }

    function _onSwapGivenOut(
        SwapRequest memory swapRequest,
        uint256[] memory balances,
        uint256 indexIn,
        uint256 indexOut
    ) internal view virtual override whenNotPaused returns (uint256) {
        uint256 amountIn = StableMath._calcInGivenOut(
            _amplificationParameter,
            balances,
            indexIn,
            indexOut,
            swapRequest.amount
        );

        return amountIn;
    }

    // Initialize

    function _onInitializePool(
        bytes32,
        address,
        address,
        bytes memory userData
    ) internal virtual override whenNotPaused returns (uint256, uint256[] memory) {
        StablePool.JoinKind kind = userData.joinKind();
        _require(kind == StablePool.JoinKind.INIT, Errors.UNINITIALIZED);

        uint256[] memory amountsIn = userData.initialAmountsIn();
        InputHelpers.ensureInputLengthMatch(amountsIn.length, _getTotalTokens());
        _upscaleArray(amountsIn, _scalingFactors());

        uint256 invariantAfterJoin = StableMath._calculateInvariant(_amplificationParameter, amountsIn);
        uint256 bptAmountOut = invariantAfterJoin;

        _lastInvariant = invariantAfterJoin;

        return (bptAmountOut, amountsIn);
    }

    // Join

    function _onJoinPool(
        bytes32,
        address,
        address,
        uint256[] memory balances,
        uint256,
        uint256 protocolSwapFeePercentage,
        bytes memory userData
    )
        internal
        virtual
        override
        whenNotPaused
        returns (
            uint256,
            uint256[] memory,
            uint256[] memory
        )
    {
        // Due protocol swap fee amounts are computed by measuring the growth of the invariant between the previous join
        // or exit event and now - the invariant's growth is due exclusively to swap fees. This avoids spending gas to
        // calculate the fee amounts during each individual swap.
        uint256[] memory dueProtocolFeeAmounts = _getDueProtocolFeeAmounts(
            balances,
            _lastInvariant,
            protocolSwapFeePercentage
        );

        // Update the balances by subtracting the protocol fee amounts that will be charged by the Vault once this
        // function returns.
        for (uint256 i = 0; i < _getTotalTokens(); ++i) {
            balances[i] = balances[i].sub(dueProtocolFeeAmounts[i]);
        }

        (uint256 bptAmountOut, uint256[] memory amountsIn) = _doJoin(balances, userData);

        // Update the invariant with the balances the Pool will have after the join, in order to compute the
        // protocol swap fee amounts due in future joins and exits.
        _lastInvariant = _invariantAfterJoin(balances, amountsIn);

        return (bptAmountOut, amountsIn, dueProtocolFeeAmounts);
    }

    function _doJoin(uint256[] memory balances, bytes memory userData)
        private
        view
        returns (uint256, uint256[] memory)
    {
        JoinKind kind = userData.joinKind();

        if (kind == JoinKind.EXACT_TOKENS_IN_FOR_BPT_OUT) {
            return _joinExactTokensInForBPTOut(balances, userData);
        } else if (kind == JoinKind.TOKEN_IN_FOR_EXACT_BPT_OUT) {
            return _joinTokenInForExactBPTOut(balances, userData);
        } else {
            _revert(Errors.UNHANDLED_JOIN_KIND);
        }
    }

    function _joinExactTokensInForBPTOut(uint256[] memory balances, bytes memory userData)
        private
        view
        returns (uint256, uint256[] memory)
    {
        (uint256[] memory amountsIn, uint256 minBPTAmountOut) = userData.exactTokensInForBptOut();
        InputHelpers.ensureInputLengthMatch(_getTotalTokens(), amountsIn.length);
        _upscaleArray(amountsIn, _scalingFactors());

        uint256 bptAmountOut = StableMath._calcBptOutGivenExactTokensIn(
            _amplificationParameter,
            balances,
            amountsIn,
            totalSupply(),
            _swapFeePercentage
        );

        _require(bptAmountOut >= minBPTAmountOut, Errors.BPT_OUT_MIN_AMOUNT);

        return (bptAmountOut, amountsIn);
    }

    function _joinTokenInForExactBPTOut(uint256[] memory balances, bytes memory userData)
        private
        view
        returns (uint256, uint256[] memory)
    {
        (uint256 bptAmountOut, uint256 tokenIndex) = userData.tokenInForExactBptOut();

        uint256 amountIn = StableMath._calcTokenInGivenExactBptOut(
            _amplificationParameter,
            balances,
            tokenIndex,
            bptAmountOut,
            totalSupply(),
            _swapFeePercentage
        );

        // We are joining with a single token, so initialize downscaledAmountsIn with zeros, and
        // only set downscaledAmountsIn[tokenIndex]
        uint256[] memory downscaledAmountsIn = new uint256[](_getTotalTokens());
        downscaledAmountsIn[tokenIndex] = amountIn;

        return (bptAmountOut, downscaledAmountsIn);
    }

    // Exit

    function _onExitPool(
        bytes32,
        address,
        address,
        uint256[] memory balances,
        uint256,
        uint256 protocolSwapFeePercentage,
        bytes memory userData
    )
        internal
        virtual
        override
        returns (
            uint256 bptAmountIn,
            uint256[] memory amountsOut,
            uint256[] memory dueProtocolFeeAmounts
        )
    {
        if (_isNotPaused()) {
            // Due protocol swap fee amounts are computed by measuring the growth of the invariant between the previous
            // join or exit event and now - the invariant's growth is due exclusively to swap fees. This avoids
            // spending gas calculating fee amounts during each individual swap
            dueProtocolFeeAmounts = _getDueProtocolFeeAmounts(balances, _lastInvariant, protocolSwapFeePercentage);

            // Update the balances by subtracting the protocol fee amounts that will be charged by the Vault once this
            // function returns.
            for (uint256 i = 0; i < _getTotalTokens(); ++i) {
                balances[i] = balances[i].sub(dueProtocolFeeAmounts[i]);
            }
        } else {
            // To avoid extra calculations, swap protocol fee amounts are not charged when the contract is paused.
            dueProtocolFeeAmounts = new uint256[](_getTotalTokens());
        }

        (bptAmountIn, amountsOut) = _doExit(balances, userData);

        // Update the invariant with the balances the Pool will have after the exit, in order to compute the
        // protocol swap fee amounts due in future joins and exits.
        _lastInvariant = _invariantAfterExit(balances, amountsOut);

        return (bptAmountIn, amountsOut, dueProtocolFeeAmounts);
    }

    function _doExit(uint256[] memory balances, bytes memory userData)
        private
        view
        returns (uint256, uint256[] memory)
    {
        ExitKind kind = userData.exitKind();

        if (kind == ExitKind.EXACT_BPT_IN_FOR_ONE_TOKEN_OUT) {
            return _exitExactBPTInForTokenOut(balances, userData);
        } else if (kind == ExitKind.EXACT_BPT_IN_FOR_TOKENS_OUT) {
            return _exitExactBPTInForTokensOut(balances, userData);
        } else {
            // ExitKind.BPT_IN_FOR_EXACT_TOKENS_OUT
            return _exitBPTInForExactTokensOut(balances, userData);
        }
    }

    function _exitExactBPTInForTokenOut(uint256[] memory balances, bytes memory userData)
        private
        view
        whenNotPaused
        returns (uint256, uint256[] memory)
    {
        // This exit function is disabled if the contract is paused.
        uint256 totalTokens = _getTotalTokens();
        (uint256 bptAmountIn, uint256 tokenIndex) = userData.exactBptInForTokenOut();
        _require(tokenIndex < totalTokens, Errors.OUT_OF_BOUNDS);

        // We exit in a single token, so initialize amountsOut with zeros and only set amountsOut[tokenIndex]
        uint256[] memory amountsOut = new uint256[](totalTokens);

        amountsOut[tokenIndex] = StableMath._calcTokenOutGivenExactBptIn(
            _amplificationParameter,
            balances,
            tokenIndex,
            bptAmountIn,
            totalSupply(),
            _swapFeePercentage
        );

        return (bptAmountIn, amountsOut);
    }

    function _exitExactBPTInForTokensOut(uint256[] memory balances, bytes memory userData)
        private
        view
        returns (uint256, uint256[] memory)
    {
        // This exit function is the only one that is not disabled if the contract is paused: it remains unrestricted
        // in an attempt to provide users with a mechanism to retrieve their tokens in case of an emergency.
        // This particular exit function is the only one that remains available because it is the simplest one, and
        // therefore the one with the lowest likelihood of errors.
        uint256 bptAmountIn = userData.exactBptInForTokensOut();

        uint256[] memory amountsOut = StableMath._calcTokensOutGivenExactBptIn(balances, bptAmountIn, totalSupply());

        return (bptAmountIn, amountsOut);
    }

    function _exitBPTInForExactTokensOut(uint256[] memory balances, bytes memory userData)
        private
        view
        whenNotPaused
        returns (uint256, uint256[] memory)
    {
        // This exit function is disabled if the contract is paused.

        (uint256[] memory amountsOut, uint256 maxBPTAmountIn) = userData.bptInForExactTokensOut();
        InputHelpers.ensureInputLengthMatch(amountsOut.length, _getTotalTokens());

        _upscaleArray(amountsOut, _scalingFactors());

        uint256 bptAmountIn = StableMath._calcBptInGivenExactTokensOut(
            _amplificationParameter,
            balances,
            amountsOut,
            totalSupply(),
            _swapFeePercentage
        );

        _require(bptAmountIn <= maxBPTAmountIn, Errors.BPT_IN_MAX_AMOUNT);

        return (bptAmountIn, amountsOut);
    }

    // Helpers

    function _getDueProtocolFeeAmounts(
        uint256[] memory balances,
        uint256 previousInvariant,
        uint256 protocolSwapFeePercentage
    ) private view returns (uint256[] memory) {
        // Initialize with zeros
        uint256[] memory dueProtocolFeeAmounts = new uint256[](_getTotalTokens());

        // Early exit if there is no protocol swap fee
        if (protocolSwapFeePercentage == 0) {
            return dueProtocolFeeAmounts;
        }

        // Instead of paying the protocol swap fee in all tokens proportionally, we will pay it in a single one. This
        // will reduce gas costs for single asset joins and exits, as at most only two Pool balances will change (the
        // token joined/exited, and the token in which fees will be paid).

        // The protocol fee is charged using the token with the highest balance in the pool.
        uint256 chosenTokenIndex = 0;
        uint256 maxBalance = balances[0];
        for (uint256 i = 1; i < _getTotalTokens(); ++i) {
            uint256 currentBalance = balances[i];
            if (currentBalance > maxBalance) {
                chosenTokenIndex = i;
                maxBalance = currentBalance;
            }
        }

        // Set the fee amount to pay in the selected token
        dueProtocolFeeAmounts[chosenTokenIndex] = StableMath._calcDueTokenProtocolSwapFeeAmount(
            _amplificationParameter,
            balances,
            previousInvariant,
            chosenTokenIndex,
            protocolSwapFeePercentage
        );

        return dueProtocolFeeAmounts;
    }

    function _invariantAfterJoin(uint256[] memory balances, uint256[] memory amountsIn) private view returns (uint256) {
        for (uint256 i = 0; i < _getTotalTokens(); ++i) {
            balances[i] = balances[i].add(amountsIn[i]);
        }

        return StableMath._calculateInvariant(_amplificationParameter, balances);
    }

    function _invariantAfterExit(uint256[] memory balances, uint256[] memory amountsOut)
        private
        view
        returns (uint256)
    {
        for (uint256 i = 0; i < _getTotalTokens(); ++i) {
            balances[i] = balances[i].sub(amountsOut[i]);
        }

        return StableMath._calculateInvariant(_amplificationParameter, balances);
    }

    /**
     * @dev This function returns the appreciation of one BPT relative to the
     * underlying tokens. This starts at 1 when the pool is created and grows over time
     */
    function getRate() public view returns (uint256) {
        (, uint256[] memory balances, ) = getVault().getPoolTokens(getPoolId());
        return StableMath._calculateInvariant(_amplificationParameter, balances).divDown(totalSupply());
    }
}

File 72 of 86 : StableMath.sol
// SPDX-License-Identifier: GPL-3.0-or-later
// This program is free software: you can redistribute it and/or modify
// it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
// the Free Software Foundation, either version 3 of the License, or
// (at your option) any later version.

// This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
// but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
// MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE.  See the
// GNU General Public License for more details.

// You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
// along with this program.  If not, see <http://www.gnu.org/licenses/>.

pragma solidity ^0.7.0;

import "../../lib/math/Math.sol";
import "../../lib/math/FixedPoint.sol";

// This is a contract to emulate file-level functions. Convert to a library
// after the migration to solc v0.7.1.

// solhint-disable private-vars-leading-underscore
// solhint-disable var-name-mixedcase

contract StableMath {
    using FixedPoint for uint256;

    uint256 internal constant _MIN_AMP = 1e18;
    uint256 internal constant _MAX_AMP = 5000 * (1e18);

    uint256 internal constant _MAX_STABLE_TOKENS = 5;

    // Computes the invariant given the current balances, using the Newton-Raphson approximation.
    // The amplification parameter equals: A n^(n-1)
    function _calculateInvariant(uint256 amplificationParameter, uint256[] memory balances)
        internal
        pure
        returns (uint256)
    {
        /**********************************************************************************************
        // invariant                                                                                 //
        // D = invariant                                                  D^(n+1)                    //
        // A = amplification coefficient      A  n^n S + D = A D n^n + -----------                   //
        // S = sum of balances                                             n^n P                     //
        // P = product of balances                                                                   //
        // n = number of tokens                                                                      //
        *********x************************************************************************************/

        // We round up the invariant.

        uint256 sum = 0;
        uint256 numTokens = balances.length;
        for (uint256 i = 0; i < numTokens; i++) {
            sum = sum.add(balances[i]);
        }
        if (sum == 0) {
            return 0;
        }
        uint256 prevInvariant = 0;
        uint256 invariant = sum;
        uint256 ampTimesTotal = Math.mul(amplificationParameter, numTokens);

        for (uint256 i = 0; i < 255; i++) {
            uint256 P_D = Math.mul(numTokens, balances[0]);
            for (uint256 j = 1; j < numTokens; j++) {
                P_D = Math.divUp(Math.mul(Math.mul(P_D, balances[j]), numTokens), invariant);
            }
            prevInvariant = invariant;
            invariant = Math.divUp(
                Math.mul(Math.mul(numTokens, invariant), invariant).add(Math.mul(Math.mul(ampTimesTotal, sum), P_D)),
                Math.mul(numTokens.add(1), invariant).add(Math.mul(ampTimesTotal.sub(1), P_D))
            );

            if (invariant > prevInvariant) {
                if (invariant.sub(prevInvariant) <= 1) {
                    break;
                }
            } else if (prevInvariant.sub(invariant) <= 1) {
                break;
            }
        }
        return invariant;
    }

    // Computes how many tokens can be taken out of a pool if `tokenAmountIn` are sent, given the current balances.
    // The amplification parameter equals: A n^(n-1)
    function _calcOutGivenIn(
        uint256 amplificationParameter,
        uint256[] memory balances,
        uint256 tokenIndexIn,
        uint256 tokenIndexOut,
        uint256 tokenAmountIn
    ) internal pure returns (uint256) {
        /**************************************************************************************************************
        // outGivenIn token x for y - polynomial equation to solve                                                   //
        // ay = amount out to calculate                                                                              //
        // by = balance token out                                                                                    //
        // y = by - ay (finalBalanceOut)                                                                             //
        // D = invariant                                               D                     D^(n+1)                 //
        // A = amplification coefficient               y^2 + ( S - ----------  - D) * y -  ------------- = 0         //
        // n = number of tokens                                    (A * n^n)               A * n^2n * P              //
        // S = sum of final balances but y                                                                           //
        // P = product of final balances but y                                                                       //
        **************************************************************************************************************/

        // Amount out, so we round down overall.

        uint256 invariant = _calculateInvariant(amplificationParameter, balances);

        balances[tokenIndexIn] = balances[tokenIndexIn].add(tokenAmountIn);

        uint256 finalBalanceOut = _getTokenBalanceGivenInvariantAndAllOtherBalances(
            amplificationParameter,
            balances,
            invariant,
            tokenIndexOut
        );

        balances[tokenIndexIn] = balances[tokenIndexIn].sub(tokenAmountIn);

        return balances[tokenIndexOut].sub(finalBalanceOut).sub(1);
    }

    // Computes how many tokens must be sent to a pool if `tokenAmountOut` are sent given the
    // current balances, using the Newton-Raphson approximation.
    // The amplification parameter equals: A n^(n-1)
    function _calcInGivenOut(
        uint256 amplificationParameter,
        uint256[] memory balances,
        uint256 tokenIndexIn,
        uint256 tokenIndexOut,
        uint256 tokenAmountOut
    ) internal pure returns (uint256) {
        /**************************************************************************************************************
        // inGivenOut token x for y - polynomial equation to solve                                                   //
        // ax = amount in to calculate                                                                               //
        // bx = balance token in                                                                                     //
        // x = bx + ax (finalBalanceIn)                                                                              //
        // D = invariant                                                D                     D^(n+1)                //
        // A = amplification coefficient               x^2 + ( S - ----------  - D) * x -  ------------- = 0         //
        // n = number of tokens                                     (A * n^n)               A * n^2n * P             //
        // S = sum of final balances but x                                                                           //
        // P = product of final balances but x                                                                       //
        **************************************************************************************************************/

        // Amount in, so we round up overall.

        uint256 invariant = _calculateInvariant(amplificationParameter, balances);

        balances[tokenIndexOut] = balances[tokenIndexOut].sub(tokenAmountOut);

        uint256 finalBalanceIn = _getTokenBalanceGivenInvariantAndAllOtherBalances(
            amplificationParameter,
            balances,
            invariant,
            tokenIndexIn
        );

        balances[tokenIndexOut] = balances[tokenIndexOut].add(tokenAmountOut);

        return finalBalanceIn.sub(balances[tokenIndexIn]).add(1);
    }

    /*
    TODO: document it correctly
    Flow of calculations:
    amountsTokenIn -> amountsInProportional ->
    amountsInPercentageExcess -> amountsInAfterFee -> newInvariant -> amountBPTOut
    TODO: remove equations below and save them to Notion documentation
    amountInPercentageExcess = 1 - amountInProportional/amountIn (if amountIn>amountInProportional)
    amountInAfterFee = amountIn * (1 - swapFeePercentage * amountInPercentageExcess)
    amountInAfterFee = amountIn - fee amount
    fee amount = (amountIn - amountInProportional) * swapFeePercentage
    amountInAfterFee = amountIn - (amountIn - amountInProportional) * swapFeePercentage
    amountInAfterFee = amountIn * (1 - (1 - amountInProportional/amountIn) * swapFeePercentage)
    amountInAfterFee = amountIn * (1 - amountInPercentageExcess * swapFeePercentage)
    */
    function _calcBptOutGivenExactTokensIn(
        uint256 amp,
        uint256[] memory balances,
        uint256[] memory amountsIn,
        uint256 bptTotalSupply,
        uint256 swapFeePercentage
    ) internal pure returns (uint256) {
        // BPT out, so we round down overall.

        // Get current invariant
        uint256 currentInvariant = _calculateInvariant(amp, balances);

        // First loop calculates the sum of all token balances, which will be used to calculate
        // the current weights of each token, relative to this sum
        uint256 sumBalances = 0;
        for (uint256 i = 0; i < balances.length; i++) {
            sumBalances = sumBalances.add(balances[i]);
        }

        // Calculate the weighted balance ratio without considering fees
        uint256[] memory tokenBalanceRatiosWithoutFee = new uint256[](amountsIn.length);
        // The weighted sum of token balance ratios without fee
        uint256 weightedBalanceRatio = 0;
        for (uint256 i = 0; i < balances.length; i++) {
            uint256 currentWeight = balances[i].divDown(sumBalances);
            tokenBalanceRatiosWithoutFee[i] = balances[i].add(amountsIn[i]).divDown(balances[i]);
            weightedBalanceRatio = weightedBalanceRatio.add(tokenBalanceRatiosWithoutFee[i].mulDown(currentWeight));
        }

        // Second loop calculates new amounts in, taking into account the fee on the percentage excess
        uint256[] memory newBalances = new uint256[](balances.length);
        for (uint256 i = 0; i < balances.length; i++) {
            // Percentage of the amount supplied that will be implicitly swapped for other tokens in the pool
            uint256 tokenBalancePercentageExcess;
            // Some tokens might have amounts supplied in excess of a 'balanced' join: these are identified if
            // the token's balance ratio without fee is larger than the weighted balance ratio, and swap fees are
            // charged on the swap amount
            if (weightedBalanceRatio >= tokenBalanceRatiosWithoutFee[i]) {
                tokenBalancePercentageExcess = 0;
            } else {
                tokenBalancePercentageExcess = tokenBalanceRatiosWithoutFee[i].sub(weightedBalanceRatio).divUp(
                    tokenBalanceRatiosWithoutFee[i].sub(FixedPoint.ONE)
                );
            }

            uint256 swapFeeExcess = swapFeePercentage.mulUp(tokenBalancePercentageExcess);

            uint256 amountInAfterFee = amountsIn[i].mulDown(swapFeeExcess.complement());

            newBalances[i] = balances[i].add(amountInAfterFee);
        }

        // get the new invariant, taking swap fees into account
        uint256 newInvariant = _calculateInvariant(amp, newBalances);

        // return amountBPTOut
        return bptTotalSupply.mulDown(newInvariant.divDown(currentInvariant).sub(FixedPoint.ONE));
    }

    /*
    TODO: document it correctly
    Flow of calculations:
    amountBPTOut -> newInvariant -> (amountInProportional, amountInAfterFee) ->
    amountInPercentageExcess -> amountIn
    */
    function _calcTokenInGivenExactBptOut(
        uint256 amp,
        uint256[] memory balances,
        uint256 tokenIndex,
        uint256 bptAmountOut,
        uint256 bptTotalSupply,
        uint256 swapFeePercentage
    ) internal pure returns (uint256) {
        // Token in, so we round up overall.

        // Get the current invariant
        uint256 currentInvariant = _calculateInvariant(amp, balances);

        // Calculate new invariant
        uint256 newInvariant = bptTotalSupply.add(bptAmountOut).divUp(bptTotalSupply).mulUp(currentInvariant);

        // First calculate the sum of all token balances, which will be used to calculate
        // the current weight of each token
        uint256 sumBalances = 0;
        for (uint256 i = 0; i < balances.length; i++) {
            sumBalances = sumBalances.add(balances[i]);
        }

        // get amountInAfterFee
        uint256 newBalanceTokenIndex = _getTokenBalanceGivenInvariantAndAllOtherBalances(
            amp,
            balances,
            newInvariant,
            tokenIndex
        );
        uint256 amountInAfterFee = newBalanceTokenIndex.sub(balances[tokenIndex]);

        // Get tokenBalancePercentageExcess
        uint256 currentWeight = balances[tokenIndex].divDown(sumBalances);
        uint256 tokenBalancePercentageExcess = currentWeight.complement();

        uint256 swapFeeExcess = swapFeePercentage.mulUp(tokenBalancePercentageExcess);

        return amountInAfterFee.divUp(swapFeeExcess.complement());
    }

    /*
    Flow of calculations:
    amountsTokenOut -> amountsOutProportional ->
    amountOutPercentageExcess -> amountOutBeforeFee -> newInvariant -> amountBPTIn
    */
    function _calcBptInGivenExactTokensOut(
        uint256 amp,
        uint256[] memory balances,
        uint256[] memory amountsOut,
        uint256 bptTotalSupply,
        uint256 swapFee
    ) internal pure returns (uint256) {
        // BPT in, so we round up overall.

        // Get the current invariant
        uint256 currentInvariant = _calculateInvariant(amp, balances);

        // First loop calculates the sum of all token balances, which will be used to calculate
        // the current weights of each token relative to this sum
        uint256 sumBalances = 0;
        for (uint256 i = 0; i < balances.length; i++) {
            sumBalances = sumBalances.add(balances[i]);
        }

        // Calculate the weighted balance ratio without considering fees
        uint256[] memory tokenBalanceRatiosWithoutFee = new uint256[](amountsOut.length);
        uint256 weightedBalanceRatio = 0;
        for (uint256 i = 0; i < balances.length; i++) {
            uint256 currentWeight = balances[i].divUp(sumBalances);
            tokenBalanceRatiosWithoutFee[i] = balances[i].sub(amountsOut[i]).divUp(balances[i]);
            weightedBalanceRatio = weightedBalanceRatio.add(tokenBalanceRatiosWithoutFee[i].mulUp(currentWeight));
        }

        // Second loop calculates new amounts in, taking into account the fee on the percentage excess
        uint256[] memory newBalances = new uint256[](balances.length);
        for (uint256 i = 0; i < balances.length; i++) {
            uint256 tokenBalancePercentageExcess;
            // Compare each tokenBalanceRatioWithoutFee to the total weighted ratio (weightedBalanceRatio), and
            // decrease the fee by the excess amount
            if (weightedBalanceRatio <= tokenBalanceRatiosWithoutFee[i]) {
                tokenBalancePercentageExcess = 0;
            } else {
                tokenBalancePercentageExcess = weightedBalanceRatio.sub(tokenBalanceRatiosWithoutFee[i]).divUp(
                    tokenBalanceRatiosWithoutFee[i].complement()
                );
            }

            uint256 swapFeeExcess = swapFee.mulUp(tokenBalancePercentageExcess);

            uint256 amountOutBeforeFee = amountsOut[i].divUp(swapFeeExcess.complement());

            newBalances[i] = balances[i].sub(amountOutBeforeFee);
        }

        // get the new invariant, taking into account swap fees
        uint256 newInvariant = _calculateInvariant(amp, newBalances);

        // return amountBPTIn
        return bptTotalSupply.mulUp(newInvariant.divUp(currentInvariant).complement());
    }

    /*
    TODO: document it correctly
    Flow of calculations:
    amountBPTin -> newInvariant -> (amountOutProportional, amountOutBeforeFee) ->
    amountOutPercentageExcess -> amountOut
    */
    function _calcTokenOutGivenExactBptIn(
        uint256 amp,
        uint256[] memory balances,
        uint256 tokenIndex,
        uint256 bptAmountIn,
        uint256 bptTotalSupply,
        uint256 swapFeePercentage
    ) internal pure returns (uint256) {
        // Get the current invariant
        uint256 currentInvariant = _calculateInvariant(amp, balances);
        // Calculate the new invariant
        uint256 newInvariant = bptTotalSupply.sub(bptAmountIn).divUp(bptTotalSupply).mulUp(currentInvariant);

        // First calculate the sum of all token balances, which will be used to calculate
        // the current weight of each token
        uint256 sumBalances = 0;
        for (uint256 i = 0; i < balances.length; i++) {
            sumBalances = sumBalances.add(balances[i]);
        }

        // get amountOutBeforeFee
        uint256 newBalanceTokenIndex = _getTokenBalanceGivenInvariantAndAllOtherBalances(
            amp,
            balances,
            newInvariant,
            tokenIndex
        );
        uint256 amountOutBeforeFee = balances[tokenIndex].sub(newBalanceTokenIndex);

        // Calculate tokenBalancePercentageExcess
        uint256 currentWeight = balances[tokenIndex].divDown(sumBalances);
        uint256 tokenBalancePercentageExcess = currentWeight.complement();

        uint256 swapFeeExcess = swapFeePercentage.mulUp(tokenBalancePercentageExcess);

        return amountOutBeforeFee.mulDown(swapFeeExcess.complement());
    }

    function _calcTokensOutGivenExactBptIn(
        uint256[] memory balances,
        uint256 bptAmountIn,
        uint256 bptTotalSupply
    ) internal pure returns (uint256[] memory) {
        /**********************************************************************************************
        // exactBPTInForTokensOut                                                                    //
        // (per token)                                                                               //
        // aO = tokenAmountOut             /        bptIn         \                                  //
        // b = tokenBalance      a0 = b * | ---------------------  |                                 //
        // bptIn = bptAmountIn             \     bptTotalSupply    /                                 //
        // bpt = bptTotalSupply                                                                      //
        **********************************************************************************************/

        // Since we're computing an amount out, we round down overall. This means rounding down on both the
        // multiplication and division.

        uint256 bptRatio = bptAmountIn.divDown(bptTotalSupply);

        uint256[] memory amountsOut = new uint256[](balances.length);
        for (uint256 i = 0; i < balances.length; i++) {
            amountsOut[i] = balances[i].mulDown(bptRatio);
        }

        return amountsOut;
    }

    // The amplification parameter equals: A n^(n-1)
    function _calcDueTokenProtocolSwapFeeAmount(
        uint256 amplificationParameter,
        uint256[] memory balances,
        uint256 lastInvariant,
        uint256 tokenIndex,
        uint256 protocolSwapFeePercentage
    ) internal pure returns (uint256) {
        /**************************************************************************************************************
        // oneTokenSwapFee - polynomial equation to solve                                                            //
        // af = fee amount to calculate in one token                                                                 //
        // bf = balance of fee token                                                                                 //
        // f = bf - af (finalBalanceFeeToken)                                                                        //
        // D = old invariant                                            D                     D^(n+1)                //
        // A = amplification coefficient               f^2 + ( S - ----------  - D) * f -  ------------- = 0         //
        // n = number of tokens                                    (A * n^n)               A * n^2n * P              //
        // S = sum of final balances but f                                                                           //
        // P = product of final balances but f                                                                       //
        **************************************************************************************************************/

        // Protocol swap fee amount, so we round down overall.

        uint256 finalBalanceFeeToken = _getTokenBalanceGivenInvariantAndAllOtherBalances(
            amplificationParameter,
            balances,
            lastInvariant,
            tokenIndex
        );

        // Result is rounded down
        uint256 accumulatedTokenSwapFees = balances[tokenIndex] > finalBalanceFeeToken
            ? balances[tokenIndex].sub(finalBalanceFeeToken)
            : 0;
        return accumulatedTokenSwapFees.mulDown(protocolSwapFeePercentage).divDown(FixedPoint.ONE);
    }

    // Private functions

    // This function calculates the balance of a given token (tokenIndex)
    // given all the other balances and the invariant
    function _getTokenBalanceGivenInvariantAndAllOtherBalances(
        uint256 amplificationParameter,
        uint256[] memory balances,
        uint256 invariant,
        uint256 tokenIndex
    ) private pure returns (uint256) {
        // Rounds result up overall

        uint256 ampTimesTotal = Math.mul(amplificationParameter, balances.length);
        uint256 sum = balances[0];
        uint256 P_D = Math.mul(balances.length, balances[0]);
        for (uint256 j = 1; j < balances.length; j++) {
            P_D = Math.divDown(Math.mul(Math.mul(P_D, balances[j]), balances.length), invariant);
            sum = sum.add(balances[j]);
        }
        sum = sum.sub(balances[tokenIndex]);

        uint256 c = Math.divUp(Math.mul(invariant, invariant), ampTimesTotal);
        // We remove the balance fromm c by multiplying it
        c = c.mulUp(balances[tokenIndex]).divUp(P_D);

        uint256 b = sum.add(invariant.divDown(ampTimesTotal));

        // We iterate to find the balance
        uint256 prevTokenBalance = 0;
        // We multiply the first iteration outside the loop with the invariant to set the value of the
        // initial approximation.
        uint256 tokenBalance = invariant.mulUp(invariant).add(c).divUp(invariant.add(b));

        for (uint256 i = 0; i < 255; i++) {
            prevTokenBalance = tokenBalance;

            tokenBalance = tokenBalance.mulUp(tokenBalance).add(c).divUp(
                Math.mul(tokenBalance, 2).add(b).sub(invariant)
            );

            if (tokenBalance > prevTokenBalance) {
                if (tokenBalance.sub(prevTokenBalance) <= 1) {
                    break;
                }
            } else if (prevTokenBalance.sub(tokenBalance) <= 1) {
                break;
            }
        }
        return tokenBalance;
    }
}

File 73 of 86 : StablePoolUserDataHelpers.sol
// SPDX-License-Identifier: GPL-3.0-or-later
// This program is free software: you can redistribute it and/or modify
// it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
// the Free Software Foundation, either version 3 of the License, or
// (at your option) any later version.

// This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
// but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
// MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE.  See the
// GNU General Public License for more details.

// You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
// along with this program.  If not, see <http://www.gnu.org/licenses/>.

pragma solidity ^0.7.0;

import "../../lib/openzeppelin/IERC20.sol";

import "./StablePool.sol";

library StablePoolUserDataHelpers {
    function joinKind(bytes memory self) internal pure returns (StablePool.JoinKind) {
        return abi.decode(self, (StablePool.JoinKind));
    }

    function exitKind(bytes memory self) internal pure returns (StablePool.ExitKind) {
        return abi.decode(self, (StablePool.ExitKind));
    }

    function initialAmountsIn(bytes memory self) internal pure returns (uint256[] memory amountsIn) {
        (, amountsIn) = abi.decode(self, (StablePool.JoinKind, uint256[]));
    }

    function exactTokensInForBptOut(bytes memory self)
        internal
        pure
        returns (uint256[] memory amountsIn, uint256 minBPTAmountIn)
    {
        (, amountsIn, minBPTAmountIn) = abi.decode(self, (StablePool.JoinKind, uint256[], uint256));
    }

    function tokenInForExactBptOut(bytes memory self) internal pure returns (uint256 bptAmountOut, uint256 tokenIndex) {
        (, bptAmountOut, tokenIndex) = abi.decode(self, (StablePool.JoinKind, uint256, uint256));
    }

    function exactBptInForTokenOut(bytes memory self) internal pure returns (uint256 bptAmountIn, uint256 tokenIndex) {
        (, bptAmountIn, tokenIndex) = abi.decode(self, (StablePool.ExitKind, uint256, uint256));
    }

    function exactBptInForTokensOut(bytes memory self) internal pure returns (uint256 bptAmountIn) {
        (, bptAmountIn) = abi.decode(self, (StablePool.ExitKind, uint256));
    }

    function bptInForExactTokensOut(bytes memory self)
        internal
        pure
        returns (uint256[] memory amountsOut, uint256 maxBPTAmountIn)
    {
        (, amountsOut, maxBPTAmountIn) = abi.decode(self, (StablePool.ExitKind, uint256[], uint256));
    }
}

File 74 of 86 : StablePoolFactory.sol
// SPDX-License-Identifier: GPL-3.0-or-later
// This program is free software: you can redistribute it and/or modify
// it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
// the Free Software Foundation, either version 3 of the License, or
// (at your option) any later version.

// This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
// but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
// MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE.  See the
// GNU General Public License for more details.

// You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
// along with this program.  If not, see <http://www.gnu.org/licenses/>.

pragma solidity ^0.7.0;
pragma experimental ABIEncoderV2;

import "../../vault/interfaces/IVault.sol";

import "../factories/BasePoolFactory.sol";
import "../factories/FactoryWidePauseWindow.sol";

import "./StablePool.sol";

contract StablePoolFactory is BasePoolFactory, FactoryWidePauseWindow {
    constructor(IVault vault) BasePoolFactory(vault) {
        // solhint-disable-previous-line no-empty-blocks
    }

    /**
     * @dev Deploys a new `StablePool`.
     */
    function create(
        string memory name,
        string memory symbol,
        IERC20[] memory tokens,
        uint256 amplificationParameter,
        uint256 swapFeePercentage,
        address owner
    ) external returns (address) {
        (uint256 pauseWindowDuration, uint256 bufferPeriodDuration) = getPauseConfiguration();

        address pool = address(
            new StablePool(
                getVault(),
                name,
                symbol,
                tokens,
                amplificationParameter,
                swapFeePercentage,
                pauseWindowDuration,
                bufferPeriodDuration,
                owner
            )
        );
        _register(pool);
        return pool;
    }
}

File 75 of 86 : FactoryWidePauseWindow.sol
// SPDX-License-Identifier: GPL-3.0-or-later
// This program is free software: you can redistribute it and/or modify
// it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
// the Free Software Foundation, either version 3 of the License, or
// (at your option) any later version.

// This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
// but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
// MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE.  See the
// GNU General Public License for more details.

// You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
// along with this program.  If not, see <http://www.gnu.org/licenses/>.

pragma solidity ^0.7.0;
pragma experimental ABIEncoderV2;

/**
 * @dev Utility to create Pool factories for Pools that use the `TemporarilyPausable` contract.
 *
 * By calling `TemporarilyPausable`'s constructor with the result of `getPauseConfiguration`, all Pools created by this
 * factory will share the same Pause Window end time, after which both old and new Pools will not be pausable.
 */
contract FactoryWidePauseWindow {
    // This contract relies on timestamps in a similar way as `TemporarilyPausable` does - the same caveats apply.
    // solhint-disable not-rely-on-time

    uint256 private constant _INITIAL_PAUSE_WINDOW_DURATION = 90 days;
    uint256 private constant _BUFFER_PERIOD_DURATION = 30 days;

    // Time when the pause window for all created Pools expires, and the pause window duration of new Pools becomes
    // zero.
    uint256 private immutable _poolsPauseWindowEndTime;

    constructor() {
        _poolsPauseWindowEndTime = block.timestamp + _INITIAL_PAUSE_WINDOW_DURATION;
    }

    /**
     * @dev Returns the current `TemporarilyPausable` configuration that will be applied to Pools created by this
     * factory.
     *
     * `pauseWindowDuration` will decrease over time until it reaches zero, at which point both it and
     * `bufferPeriodDuration` will be zero forever, meaning deployed Pools will not be pausable.
     */
    function getPauseConfiguration() public view returns (uint256 pauseWindowDuration, uint256 bufferPeriodDuration) {
        uint256 currentTime = block.timestamp;
        if (currentTime < _poolsPauseWindowEndTime) {
            // The buffer period is always the same since its duration is related to how much time is needed to respond
            // to a potential emergency. The Pause Window duration however decreases as the end time approaches.

            pauseWindowDuration = _poolsPauseWindowEndTime - currentTime; // No need for checked arithmetic.
            bufferPeriodDuration = _BUFFER_PERIOD_DURATION;
        } else {
            // After the end time, newly created Pools have no Pause Window, nor Buffer Period (since they are not
            // pausable in the first place).

            pauseWindowDuration = 0;
            bufferPeriodDuration = 0;
        }
    }
}

File 76 of 86 : MockStableMath.sol
// SPDX-License-Identifier: GPL-3.0-or-later
// This program is free software: you can redistribute it and/or modify
// it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
// the Free Software Foundation, either version 3 of the License, or
// (at your option) any later version.

// This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
// but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
// MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE.  See the
// GNU General Public License for more details.

// You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
// along with this program.  If not, see <http://www.gnu.org/licenses/>.

pragma solidity ^0.7.0;

import "../pools/stable/StableMath.sol";

contract MockStableMath is StableMath {
    function invariant(uint256 amp, uint256[] memory balances) external pure returns (uint256) {
        return _calculateInvariant(amp, balances);
    }

    function outGivenIn(
        uint256 amp,
        uint256[] memory balances,
        uint256 tokenIndexIn,
        uint256 tokenIndexOut,
        uint256 tokenAmountIn
    ) external pure returns (uint256) {
        return _calcOutGivenIn(amp, balances, tokenIndexIn, tokenIndexOut, tokenAmountIn);
    }

    function inGivenOut(
        uint256 amp,
        uint256[] memory balances,
        uint256 tokenIndexIn,
        uint256 tokenIndexOut,
        uint256 tokenAmountOut
    ) external pure returns (uint256) {
        return _calcInGivenOut(amp, balances, tokenIndexIn, tokenIndexOut, tokenAmountOut);
    }

    function exactTokensInForBPTOut(
        uint256 amp,
        uint256[] memory balances,
        uint256[] memory amountsIn,
        uint256 bptTotalSupply,
        uint256 swapFee
    ) external pure returns (uint256) {
        return _calcBptOutGivenExactTokensIn(amp, balances, amountsIn, bptTotalSupply, swapFee);
    }

    function tokenInForExactBPTOut(
        uint256 amp,
        uint256[] memory balances,
        uint256 tokenIndex,
        uint256 bptAmountOut,
        uint256 bptTotalSupply,
        uint256 swapFee
    ) external pure returns (uint256) {
        return _calcTokenInGivenExactBptOut(amp, balances, tokenIndex, bptAmountOut, bptTotalSupply, swapFee);
    }

    function exactBPTInForTokenOut(
        uint256 amp,
        uint256[] memory balances,
        uint256 tokenIndex,
        uint256 bptAmountIn,
        uint256 bptTotalSupply,
        uint256 swapFee
    ) external pure returns (uint256) {
        return _calcTokenOutGivenExactBptIn(amp, balances, tokenIndex, bptAmountIn, bptTotalSupply, swapFee);
    }

    function exactBPTInForTokensOut(
        uint256[] memory balances,
        uint256 bptAmountIn,
        uint256 bptTotalSupply
    ) external pure returns (uint256[] memory) {
        return _calcTokensOutGivenExactBptIn(balances, bptAmountIn, bptTotalSupply);
    }

    function bptInForExactTokensOut(
        uint256 amp,
        uint256[] memory balances,
        uint256[] memory amountsOut,
        uint256 bptTotalSupply,
        uint256 swapFee
    ) external pure returns (uint256) {
        return _calcBptInGivenExactTokensOut(amp, balances, amountsOut, bptTotalSupply, swapFee);
    }

    function calculateDueTokenProtocolSwapFeeAmount(
        uint256 amp,
        uint256[] memory balances,
        uint256 lastInvariant,
        uint256 tokenIndex,
        uint256 protocolSwapFeePercentage
    ) external pure returns (uint256) {
        return _calcDueTokenProtocolSwapFeeAmount(amp, balances, lastInvariant, tokenIndex, protocolSwapFeePercentage);
    }
}

File 77 of 86 : MockAssetTransfersHandler.sol
// SPDX-License-Identifier: GPL-3.0-or-later
// This program is free software: you can redistribute it and/or modify
// it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
// the Free Software Foundation, either version 3 of the License, or
// (at your option) any later version.

// This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
// but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
// MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE.  See the
// GNU General Public License for more details.

// You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
// along with this program.  If not, see <http://www.gnu.org/licenses/>.

pragma solidity ^0.7.0;
pragma experimental ABIEncoderV2;

import "../lib/math/Math.sol";
import "../lib/math/FixedPoint.sol";
import "../lib/openzeppelin/SafeERC20.sol";

import "../vault/AssetTransfersHandler.sol";

contract MockAssetTransfersHandler is AssetTransfersHandler {
    using Math for uint256;
    using SafeERC20 for IERC20;

    mapping(address => mapping(IERC20 => uint256)) private _internalTokenBalance;

    constructor(IWETH weth) AssetHelpers(weth) {}

    function receiveAsset(
        IAsset asset,
        uint256 amount,
        address sender,
        bool fromInternalBalance
    ) external payable {
        _receiveAsset(asset, amount, sender, fromInternalBalance);
    }

    function sendAsset(
        IAsset asset,
        uint256 amount,
        address payable recipient,
        bool toInternalBalance
    ) external {
        _sendAsset(asset, amount, recipient, toInternalBalance);
    }

    function getInternalBalance(address account, IERC20 token) external view returns (uint256) {
        return _internalTokenBalance[account][token];
    }

    function depositToInternalBalance(
        address account,
        IERC20 token,
        uint256 amount
    ) external {
        token.safeTransferFrom(account, address(this), amount);
        _increaseInternalBalance(account, token, amount);
    }

    function _increaseInternalBalance(
        address account,
        IERC20 token,
        uint256 amount
    ) internal override {
        _internalTokenBalance[account][token] += amount;
    }

    function _decreaseInternalBalance(
        address account,
        IERC20 token,
        uint256 amount,
        bool capped
    ) internal override returns (uint256 deducted) {
        uint256 currentBalance = _internalTokenBalance[account][token];
        deducted = capped ? Math.min(currentBalance, amount) : amount;
        _internalTokenBalance[account][token] = currentBalance.sub(deducted);
    }
}

File 78 of 86 : MockWeightedMath.sol
// SPDX-License-Identifier: GPL-3.0-or-later
// This program is free software: you can redistribute it and/or modify
// it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
// the Free Software Foundation, either version 3 of the License, or
// (at your option) any later version.

// This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
// but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
// MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE.  See the
// GNU General Public License for more details.

// You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
// along with this program.  If not, see <http://www.gnu.org/licenses/>.

pragma solidity ^0.7.0;

import "../pools/weighted/WeightedMath.sol";

contract MockWeightedMath is WeightedMath {
    function invariant(uint256[] memory normalizedWeights, uint256[] memory balances) external pure returns (uint256) {
        return _calculateInvariant(normalizedWeights, balances);
    }

    function outGivenIn(
        uint256 tokenBalanceIn,
        uint256 tokenWeightIn,
        uint256 tokenBalanceOut,
        uint256 tokenWeightOut,
        uint256 tokenAmountIn
    ) external pure returns (uint256) {
        return _calcOutGivenIn(tokenBalanceIn, tokenWeightIn, tokenBalanceOut, tokenWeightOut, tokenAmountIn);
    }

    function inGivenOut(
        uint256 tokenBalanceIn,
        uint256 tokenWeightIn,
        uint256 tokenBalanceOut,
        uint256 tokenWeightOut,
        uint256 tokenAmountOut
    ) external pure returns (uint256) {
        return _calcInGivenOut(tokenBalanceIn, tokenWeightIn, tokenBalanceOut, tokenWeightOut, tokenAmountOut);
    }

    function exactTokensInForBPTOut(
        uint256[] memory balances,
        uint256[] memory normalizedWeights,
        uint256[] memory amountsIn,
        uint256 bptTotalSupply,
        uint256 swapFee
    ) external pure returns (uint256) {
        return _calcBptOutGivenExactTokensIn(balances, normalizedWeights, amountsIn, bptTotalSupply, swapFee);
    }

    function tokenInForExactBPTOut(
        uint256 tokenBalance,
        uint256 tokenNormalizedWeight,
        uint256 bptAmountOut,
        uint256 bptTotalSupply,
        uint256 swapFee
    ) external pure returns (uint256) {
        return _calcTokenInGivenExactBptOut(tokenBalance, tokenNormalizedWeight, bptAmountOut, bptTotalSupply, swapFee);
    }

    function exactBPTInForTokenOut(
        uint256 tokenBalance,
        uint256 tokenNormalizedWeight,
        uint256 bptAmountIn,
        uint256 bptTotalSupply,
        uint256 swapFee
    ) external pure returns (uint256) {
        return _calcTokenOutGivenExactBptIn(tokenBalance, tokenNormalizedWeight, bptAmountIn, bptTotalSupply, swapFee);
    }

    function exactBPTInForTokensOut(
        uint256[] memory currentBalances,
        uint256 bptAmountIn,
        uint256 totalBPT
    ) external pure returns (uint256[] memory) {
        return _calcTokensOutGivenExactBptIn(currentBalances, bptAmountIn, totalBPT);
    }

    function bptInForExactTokensOut(
        uint256[] memory balances,
        uint256[] memory normalizedWeights,
        uint256[] memory amountsOut,
        uint256 bptTotalSupply,
        uint256 swapFee
    ) external pure returns (uint256) {
        return _calcBptInGivenExactTokensOut(balances, normalizedWeights, amountsOut, bptTotalSupply, swapFee);
    }

    function calculateDueTokenProtocolSwapFeeAmount(
        uint256 balance,
        uint256 normalizedWeight,
        uint256 previousInvariant,
        uint256 currentInvariant,
        uint256 protocolSwapFeePercentage
    ) external pure returns (uint256) {
        return
            _calcDueTokenProtocolSwapFeeAmount(
                balance,
                normalizedWeight,
                previousInvariant,
                currentInvariant,
                protocolSwapFeePercentage
            );
    }
}

File 79 of 86 : MockBalancerPoolToken.sol
// SPDX-License-Identifier: GPL-3.0-or-later
// This program is free software: you can redistribute it and/or modify
// it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
// the Free Software Foundation, either version 3 of the License, or
// (at your option) any later version.

// This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
// but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
// MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE.  See the
// GNU General Public License for more details.

// You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
// along with this program.  If not, see <http://www.gnu.org/licenses/>.

pragma solidity ^0.7.0;

import "../pools/BalancerPoolToken.sol";

contract MockBalancerPoolToken is BalancerPoolToken {
    constructor(string memory name, string memory symbol) BalancerPoolToken(name, symbol) {}

    function mint(address recipient, uint256 amount) external {
        _mintPoolTokens(recipient, amount);
    }

    function burn(address sender, uint256 amount) external {
        _burnPoolTokens(sender, amount);
    }
}

File 80 of 86 : SignaturesValidatorMock.sol
// SPDX-License-Identifier: MIT

pragma solidity ^0.7.0;

import "../../lib/helpers/SignaturesValidator.sol";

contract SignaturesValidatorMock is SignaturesValidator {
    bytes32 internal immutable AUTH_TYPE_HASH = keccak256(
        "Authorization(bytes calldata,address sender,uint256 nonce,uint256 deadline)"
    );

    event Authenticated(address user, address sender);
    event CalldataDecoded(bytes data, uint256 deadline, uint8 v, bytes32 r, bytes32 s);

    constructor() SignaturesValidator("Balancer V2 Vault") {
        // solhint-disable-previous-line no-empty-blocks
    }

    function decodeCalldata() external {
        _decodeCalldata();
    }

    function authenticateCall(address user) external {
        _validateSignature(user, Errors.INVALID_SIGNATURE);
        _decodeCalldata();
        emit Authenticated(user, msg.sender);
    }

    function anotherFunction(address user) external {
        // do nothing
    }

    function increaseNonce(address user) external {
        _nextNonce[user]++;
    }

    function _decodeCalldata() internal {
        (uint8 v, bytes32 r, bytes32 s) = _signature();
        emit CalldataDecoded(_calldata(), _deadline(), v, r, s);
    }

    function _typeHash() internal view override returns (bytes32) {
        return AUTH_TYPE_HASH;
    }
}

File 81 of 86 : BalancerHelpers.sol
// SPDX-License-Identifier: GPL-3.0-or-later
// This program is free software: you can redistribute it and/or modify
// it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
// the Free Software Foundation, either version 3 of the License, or
// (at your option) any later version.

// This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
// but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
// MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE.  See the
// GNU General Public License for more details.

// You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
// along with this program.  If not, see <http://www.gnu.org/licenses/>.

pragma solidity ^0.7.0;
pragma experimental ABIEncoderV2;

import "../math/Math.sol";
import "../math/FixedPoint.sol";

import "./InputHelpers.sol";
import "./AssetHelpers.sol";
import "./BalancerErrors.sol";

import "../../pools/BasePool.sol";
import "../../vault/ProtocolFeesCollector.sol";
import "../../vault/interfaces/IWETH.sol";
import "../../vault/interfaces/IVault.sol";
import "../../vault/balances/BalanceAllocation.sol";

/**
 * @dev This contract simply builds on top of the Balancer V2 architecture to provide useful helpers to users.
 * It connects different functionalities of the protocol components to allow accessing information that would
 * have required a more cumbersome setup if we wanted to provide these already built-in.
 */
contract BalancerHelpers is AssetHelpers {
    using Math for uint256;
    using BalanceAllocation for bytes32;
    using BalanceAllocation for bytes32[];

    IVault public immutable vault;

    constructor(IVault _vault) AssetHelpers(_vault.WETH()) {
        vault = _vault;
    }

    function queryJoin(
        bytes32 poolId,
        address sender,
        address recipient,
        IVault.JoinPoolRequest memory request
    ) external returns (uint256 bptOut, uint256[] memory amountsIn) {
        (address pool, ) = vault.getPool(poolId);
        (uint256[] memory balances, uint256 lastChangeBlock) = _validateAssetsAndGetBalances(poolId, request.assets);
        ProtocolFeesCollector feesCollector = vault.getProtocolFeesCollector();

        (bptOut, amountsIn) = BasePool(pool).queryJoin(
            poolId,
            sender,
            recipient,
            balances,
            lastChangeBlock,
            feesCollector.getSwapFeePercentage(),
            request.userData
        );
    }

    function queryExit(
        bytes32 poolId,
        address sender,
        address recipient,
        IVault.ExitPoolRequest memory request
    ) external returns (uint256 bptIn, uint256[] memory amountsOut) {
        (address pool, ) = vault.getPool(poolId);
        (uint256[] memory balances, uint256 lastChangeBlock) = _validateAssetsAndGetBalances(poolId, request.assets);
        ProtocolFeesCollector feesCollector = vault.getProtocolFeesCollector();

        (bptIn, amountsOut) = BasePool(pool).queryExit(
            poolId,
            sender,
            recipient,
            balances,
            lastChangeBlock,
            feesCollector.getSwapFeePercentage(),
            request.userData
        );
    }

    function _validateAssetsAndGetBalances(bytes32 poolId, IAsset[] memory expectedAssets)
        internal
        view
        returns (uint256[] memory balances, uint256 lastChangeBlock)
    {
        IERC20[] memory actualTokens;
        IERC20[] memory expectedTokens = _translateToIERC20(expectedAssets);

        (actualTokens, balances, lastChangeBlock) = vault.getPoolTokens(poolId);
        InputHelpers.ensureInputLengthMatch(actualTokens.length, expectedTokens.length);

        for (uint256 i = 0; i < actualTokens.length; ++i) {
            IERC20 token = actualTokens[i];
            _require(token == expectedTokens[i], Errors.TOKENS_MISMATCH);
        }
    }
}

File 82 of 86 : WETH.sol
// SPDX-License-Identifier: GPL-3.0-or-later
// Copyright (C) 2015, 2016, 2017 Dapphub

// This program is free software: you can redistribute it and/or modify
// it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
// the Free Software Foundation, either version 3 of the License, or
// (at your option) any later version.

// This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
// but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
// MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE.  See the
// GNU General Public License for more details.

// You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
// along with this program.  If not, see <http://www.gnu.org/licenses/>.

pragma solidity ^0.7.0;

import "../lib/openzeppelin/AccessControl.sol";

import "../vault/interfaces/IWETH.sol";

contract WETH is AccessControl, IWETH {
    bytes32 public constant MINTER_ROLE = keccak256("MINTER_ROLE");

    string public name = "Wrapped Ether";
    string public symbol = "WETH";
    uint8 public decimals = 18;

    event Deposit(address indexed dst, uint256 wad);
    event Withdrawal(address indexed src, uint256 wad);

    mapping(address => uint256) public override balanceOf;
    mapping(address => mapping(address => uint256)) public override allowance;

    constructor(address minter) {
        _setupRole(DEFAULT_ADMIN_ROLE, minter);
        _setupRole(MINTER_ROLE, minter);
    }

    receive() external payable {
        deposit();
    }

    function deposit() public payable override {
        balanceOf[msg.sender] += msg.value;
        emit Deposit(msg.sender, msg.value);
    }

    function withdraw(uint256 wad) public override {
        require(balanceOf[msg.sender] >= wad, "INSUFFICIENT_BALANCE");
        balanceOf[msg.sender] -= wad;
        msg.sender.transfer(wad);
        emit Withdrawal(msg.sender, wad);
    }

    // For testing purposes - this creates WETH that cannot be redeemed for ETH via 'withdraw'
    function mint(address destinatary, uint256 amount) external {
        require(hasRole(MINTER_ROLE, msg.sender), "NOT_MINTER");
        balanceOf[destinatary] += amount;
        emit Deposit(destinatary, amount);
    }

    function totalSupply() public view override returns (uint256) {
        return address(this).balance;
    }

    function approve(address guy, uint256 wad) public override returns (bool) {
        allowance[msg.sender][guy] = wad;
        emit Approval(msg.sender, guy, wad);
        return true;
    }

    function transfer(address dst, uint256 wad) public override returns (bool) {
        return transferFrom(msg.sender, dst, wad);
    }

    function transferFrom(
        address src,
        address dst,
        uint256 wad
    ) public override returns (bool) {
        require(balanceOf[src] >= wad, "INSUFFICIENT_BALANCE");

        if (src != msg.sender && allowance[src][msg.sender] != uint256(-1)) {
            require(allowance[src][msg.sender] >= wad, "INSUFFICIENT_ALLOWANCE");
            allowance[src][msg.sender] -= wad;
        }

        balanceOf[src] -= wad;
        balanceOf[dst] += wad;

        emit Transfer(src, dst, wad);

        return true;
    }
}

File 83 of 86 : TemporarilyPausableMock.sol
// SPDX-License-Identifier: GPL-3.0-or-later
// This program is free software: you can redistribute it and/or modify
// it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
// the Free Software Foundation, either version 3 of the License, or
// (at your option) any later version.

// This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
// but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
// MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE.  See the
// GNU General Public License for more details.

// You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
// along with this program.  If not, see <http://www.gnu.org/licenses/>.

pragma solidity ^0.7.0;

import "../../lib/helpers/TemporarilyPausable.sol";

contract TemporarilyPausableMock is TemporarilyPausable {
    constructor(uint256 pauseWindowDuration, uint256 bufferPeriodDuration)
        TemporarilyPausable(pauseWindowDuration, bufferPeriodDuration)
    {}

    function setPaused(bool paused) external {
        _setPaused(paused);
    }
}

File 84 of 86 : MockInternalBalanceRelayer.sol
// SPDX-License-Identifier: GPL-3.0-or-later
// This program is free software: you can redistribute it and/or modify
// it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
// the Free Software Foundation, either version 3 of the License, or
// (at your option) any later version.

// This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
// but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
// MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE.  See the
// GNU General Public License for more details.

// You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
// along with this program.  If not, see <http://www.gnu.org/licenses/>.

pragma solidity ^0.7.0;
pragma experimental ABIEncoderV2;

import "../lib/openzeppelin/IERC20.sol";

import "../vault/interfaces/IVault.sol";
import "../lib/helpers/InputHelpers.sol";

contract MockInternalBalanceRelayer {
    IVault public vault;

    constructor(IVault _vault) {
        vault = _vault;
    }

    function depositAndWithdraw(
        address payable sender,
        IAsset asset,
        uint256[] memory depositAmounts,
        uint256[] memory withdrawAmounts
    ) public {
        InputHelpers.ensureInputLengthMatch(depositAmounts.length, withdrawAmounts.length);
        for (uint256 i = 0; i < depositAmounts.length; i++) {
            IVault.UserBalanceOp[] memory deposit = _buildUserBalanceOp(
                IVault.UserBalanceOpKind.DEPOSIT_INTERNAL,
                sender,
                asset,
                depositAmounts[i]
            );
            vault.manageUserBalance(deposit);

            IVault.UserBalanceOp[] memory withdraw = _buildUserBalanceOp(
                IVault.UserBalanceOpKind.WITHDRAW_INTERNAL,
                sender,
                asset,
                withdrawAmounts[i]
            );
            vault.manageUserBalance(withdraw);
        }
    }

    function _buildUserBalanceOp(
        IVault.UserBalanceOpKind kind,
        address payable sender,
        IAsset asset,
        uint256 amount
    ) internal pure returns (IVault.UserBalanceOp[] memory ops) {
        ops = new IVault.UserBalanceOp[](1);
        ops[0] = IVault.UserBalanceOp({ asset: asset, amount: amount, sender: sender, recipient: sender, kind: kind });
    }
}

File 85 of 86 : BalanceAllocationMock.sol
// SPDX-License-Identifier: GPL-3.0-or-later
// This program is free software: you can redistribute it and/or modify
// it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
// the Free Software Foundation, either version 3 of the License, or
// (at your option) any later version.

// This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
// but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
// MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE.  See the
// GNU General Public License for more details.

// You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
// along with this program.  If not, see <http://www.gnu.org/licenses/>.

pragma solidity ^0.7.0;

import "../vault/balances/BalanceAllocation.sol";

contract BalanceAllocationMock {
    using BalanceAllocation for bytes32;

    function total(bytes32 balance) public pure returns (uint256) {
        return balance.total();
    }

    function totals(bytes32[] memory balances) public pure returns (uint256[] memory result) {
        (result, ) = BalanceAllocation.totalsAndLastChangeBlock(balances);
    }

    function cash(bytes32 balance) public pure returns (uint256) {
        return balance.cash();
    }

    function managed(bytes32 balance) public pure returns (uint256) {
        return balance.managed();
    }

    function lastChangeBlock(bytes32 balance) public pure returns (uint256) {
        return balance.lastChangeBlock();
    }

    function isNotZero(bytes32 balance) public pure returns (bool) {
        return balance.isNotZero();
    }

    function isZero(bytes32 balance) public pure returns (bool) {
        return balance.isZero();
    }

    function toBalance(
        uint256 _cash,
        uint256 _managed,
        uint256 _lastChangeBlock
    ) public pure returns (bytes32) {
        return BalanceAllocation.toBalance(_cash, _managed, _lastChangeBlock);
    }

    function increaseCash(bytes32 balance, uint256 amount) public view returns (bytes32) {
        return balance.increaseCash(amount);
    }

    function decreaseCash(bytes32 balance, uint256 amount) public view returns (bytes32) {
        return balance.decreaseCash(amount);
    }

    function cashToManaged(bytes32 balance, uint256 amount) public pure returns (bytes32) {
        return balance.cashToManaged(amount);
    }

    function managedToCash(bytes32 balance, uint256 amount) public pure returns (bytes32) {
        return balance.managedToCash(amount);
    }

    function setManaged(bytes32 balance, uint256 newManaged) public view returns (bytes32) {
        return balance.setManaged(newManaged);
    }

    function fromSharedToBalanceA(bytes32 sharedCash, bytes32 sharedManaged) public pure returns (bytes32) {
        return BalanceAllocation.fromSharedToBalanceA(sharedCash, sharedManaged);
    }

    function fromSharedToBalanceB(bytes32 sharedCash, bytes32 sharedManaged) public pure returns (bytes32) {
        return BalanceAllocation.fromSharedToBalanceB(sharedCash, sharedManaged);
    }

    function toSharedCash(bytes32 tokenABalance, bytes32 tokenBBalance) public pure returns (bytes32) {
        return BalanceAllocation.toSharedCash(tokenABalance, tokenBBalance);
    }

    function toSharedManaged(bytes32 tokenABalance, bytes32 tokenBBalance) public pure returns (bytes32) {
        return BalanceAllocation.toSharedManaged(tokenABalance, tokenBBalance);
    }
}

File 86 of 86 : BalancerErrorsMock.sol
// SPDX-License-Identifier: GPL-3.0-or-later
// This program is free software: you can redistribute it and/or modify
// it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
// the Free Software Foundation, either version 3 of the License, or
// (at your option) any later version.

// This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
// but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
// MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE.  See the
// GNU General Public License for more details.

// You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
// along with this program.  If not, see <http://www.gnu.org/licenses/>.

pragma solidity ^0.7.0;

import "../../lib/helpers/BalancerErrors.sol";

contract BalancerErrorsMock {
    function fail(uint256 code) external pure {
        _revert(code);
    }
}

Settings
{
  "optimizer": {
    "enabled": true,
    "runs": 9999
  },
  "outputSelection": {
    "*": {
      "*": [
        "evm.bytecode",
        "evm.deployedBytecode",
        "abi"
      ]
    }
  },
  "metadata": {
    "useLiteralContent": true
  }
}

Contract Security Audit

Contract ABI

[{"inputs":[{"internalType":"contract IVault","name":"_vault","type":"address"}],"stateMutability":"nonpayable","type":"constructor"},{"inputs":[{"internalType":"bytes32","name":"poolId","type":"bytes32"},{"internalType":"address","name":"sender","type":"address"},{"internalType":"address","name":"recipient","type":"address"},{"components":[{"internalType":"contract IAsset[]","name":"assets","type":"address[]"},{"internalType":"uint256[]","name":"minAmountsOut","type":"uint256[]"},{"internalType":"bytes","name":"userData","type":"bytes"},{"internalType":"bool","name":"toInternalBalance","type":"bool"}],"internalType":"struct IVault.ExitPoolRequest","name":"request","type":"tuple"}],"name":"queryExit","outputs":[{"internalType":"uint256","name":"bptIn","type":"uint256"},{"internalType":"uint256[]","name":"amountsOut","type":"uint256[]"}],"stateMutability":"nonpayable","type":"function"},{"inputs":[{"internalType":"bytes32","name":"poolId","type":"bytes32"},{"internalType":"address","name":"sender","type":"address"},{"internalType":"address","name":"recipient","type":"address"},{"components":[{"internalType":"contract IAsset[]","name":"assets","type":"address[]"},{"internalType":"uint256[]","name":"maxAmountsIn","type":"uint256[]"},{"internalType":"bytes","name":"userData","type":"bytes"},{"internalType":"bool","name":"fromInternalBalance","type":"bool"}],"internalType":"struct IVault.JoinPoolRequest","name":"request","type":"tuple"}],"name":"queryJoin","outputs":[{"internalType":"uint256","name":"bptOut","type":"uint256"},{"internalType":"uint256[]","name":"amountsIn","type":"uint256[]"}],"stateMutability":"nonpayable","type":"function"},{"inputs":[],"name":"vault","outputs":[{"internalType":"contract IVault","name":"","type":"address"}],"stateMutability":"view","type":"function"}]

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

Constructor Arguments (ABI-Encoded and is the last bytes of the Contract Creation Code above)

000000000000000000000000a82f327bbbf0667356d2935c6532d164b06ceced

-----Decoded View---------------
Arg [0] : _vault (address): 0xa82f327bbbf0667356d2935c6532d164b06ceced

-----Encoded View---------------
1 Constructor Arguments found :
Arg [0] : 000000000000000000000000a82f327bbbf0667356d2935c6532d164b06ceced


Deployed ByteCode Sourcemap

1440:2424:3:-:0;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;1728:725;;;;;;:::i;:::-;;:::i;:::-;;;;;;;;:::i;:::-;;;;;;;;2459;;;;;;:::i;:::-;;:::i;1600:29::-;;;:::i;:::-;;;;;;;:::i;1728:725::-;1893:14;1909:26;1948:12;1966:5;:13;;;1980:6;1966:21;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;:::i;:::-;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;:::i;:::-;1947:40;;;1998:25;2025:23;2052:53;2082:6;2090:7;:14;;;2052:29;:53::i;:::-;1997:108;;;;2115:35;2153:5;:30;;;:32;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;:::i;:::-;2115:70;;2227:4;2218:24;;;2256:6;2276;2296:9;2319:8;2341:15;2370:13;:34;;;:36;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;:::i;:::-;2420:7;:16;;;2218:228;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;:::i;:::-;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;:::i;:::-;2196:250;;;;-1:-1:-1;1728:725:3;-1:-1:-1;;;;;;;;;1728:725:3:o;2459:::-;2624:13;2639:27;2679:12;2697:5;:13;;;2711:6;2697:21;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;:::i;:::-;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;:::i;:::-;2678:40;;;2729:25;2756:23;2783:53;2813:6;2821:7;:14;;;2783:29;:53::i;:::-;2728:108;;;;2846:35;2884:5;:30;;;:32;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;:::i;:::-;2846:70;;2958:4;2949:24;;;2987:6;3007;3027:9;3050:8;3072:15;3101:13;:34;;;:36;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;1600:29;;;:::o;3190:672::-;3324:25;3351:23;3390:28;3428:30;3461:34;3480:14;3461:18;:34::i;:::-;3550:27;;;;;3428:67;;-1:-1:-1;3550:19:3;:5;:19;;;;:27;;3570:6;;3550:27;;;:::i;:::-;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;:::i;:::-;3623:19;;3644:21;;3506:71;;-1:-1:-1;3506:71:3;;-1:-1:-1;3506:71:3;;-1:-1:-1;3587:79:3;;3623:19;3587:35;:79::i;:::-;3682:9;3677:179;3701:12;:19;3697:1;:23;3677:179;;;3741:12;3756;3769:1;3756:15;;;;;;;;;;;;;;3741:30;;3785:60;3803:14;3818:1;3803:17;;;;;;;;;;;;;;3794:26;;:5;:26;;;9136:3:2;3785:8:3;:60::i;:::-;-1:-1:-1;3722:3:3;;3677:179;;;;3190:672;;;;;;;:::o;2110:303:0:-;2185:15;2212:22;2250:6;:13;2237:27;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;-1:-1:-1;2237:27:0;;2212:52;;2279:9;2274:110;2298:6;:13;2294:1;:17;2274:110;;;2344:29;2363:6;2370:1;2363:9;;;;;;;;;;;;;;2344:18;:29::i;:::-;2332:6;2339:1;2332:9;;;;;;;;:41;;;;:9;;;;;;;;;;;:41;2313:3;;2274:110;;;-1:-1:-1;2400:6:0;2110:303;-1:-1:-1;;2110:303:0:o;855:131:7:-;933:46;947:1;942;:6;5002:3:2;933:8:7;:46::i;:::-;855:131;;:::o;866:101:2:-;935:9;930:34;;946:18;954:9;946:7;:18::i;1874:139:0:-;1939:6;1964:13;1971:5;1964:6;:13::i;:::-;:42;;1990:16;2000:5;1990:9;:16::i;:::-;1964:42;;;1980:7;:5;:7::i;:::-;1957:49;1874:139;-1:-1:-1;;1874:139:0:o;1074:3172:2:-;3593:66;3588:3;3581:79;;;3799:66;3793:4;3786:80;3941:1;3935:4;3928:15;2999:73;2210:2;2243:18;;;2288;;;2215:4;2284:29;;;3040:1;3036:14;2195:18;;;;3025:26;;;;2336:18;;;;2383;;;2379:29;;;3057:2;3053:17;3021:50;;;;2999:73;2994:3;2990:83;4008:4;4001:26;4234:3;;4224:14;1597:105:0;1673:22;;;;1597:105::o;2654:110::-;2750:5;2654:110::o;1420:76::-;1484:5;1420:76;:::o;309:755:-1:-;;442:3;435:4;427:6;423:17;419:27;409:2;;-1:-1;;450:12;409:2;497:6;484:20;519:96;534:80;607:6;534:80;:::i;:::-;519:96;:::i;:::-;643:21;;;510:105;-1:-1;687:4;700:14;;;;675:17;;;789;;;780:27;;;;777:36;-1:-1;774:2;;;826:1;;816:12;774:2;851:1;836:222;861:6;858:1;855:13;836:222;;;4167:6;4154:20;4179:49;4222:5;4179:49;:::i;:::-;929:66;;1009:14;;;;1037;;;;883:1;876:9;836:222;;;840:14;;;;;402:662;;;;:::o;1891:707::-;;2008:3;2001:4;1993:6;1989:17;1985:27;1975:2;;-1:-1;;2016:12;1975:2;2063:6;2050:20;2085:80;2100:64;2157:6;2100:64;:::i;2085:80::-;2193:21;;;2076:89;-1:-1;2237:4;2250:14;;;;2225:17;;;2339;;;2330:27;;;;2327:36;-1:-1;2324:2;;;2376:1;;2366:12;2324:2;2401:1;2386:206;2411:6;2408:1;2405:13;2386:206;;;7201:20;;2479:50;;2543:14;;;;2571;;;;2433:1;2426:9;2386:206;;2624:722;;2752:3;2745:4;2737:6;2733:17;2729:27;2719:2;;-1:-1;;2760:12;2719:2;2800:6;2794:13;2822:80;2837:64;2894:6;2837:64;:::i;2822:80::-;2930:21;;;2813:89;-1:-1;2974:4;2987:14;;;;2962:17;;;3076;;;3067:27;;;;3064:36;-1:-1;3061:2;;;3113:1;;3103:12;3061:2;3138:1;3123:217;3148:6;3145:1;3142:13;3123:217;;;7349:13;;3216:61;;3291:14;;;;3319;;;;3170:1;3163:9;3123:217;;3354:124;3418:20;;18016:13;;18009:21;19691:32;;19681:2;;19737:1;;19727:12;3623:440;;3724:3;3717:4;3709:6;3705:17;3701:27;3691:2;;-1:-1;;3732:12;3691:2;3779:6;3766:20;16764:18;16756:6;16753:30;16750:2;;;-1:-1;;16786:12;16750:2;3801:64;16927:4;16859:9;3717:4;16844:6;16840:17;16836:33;16917:15;3801:64;:::i;:::-;3792:73;;3885:6;3878:5;3871:21;3989:3;16927:4;3980:6;3913;3971:16;;3968:25;3965:2;;;4006:1;;3996:12;3965:2;19057:6;16927:4;3913:6;3909:17;16927:4;3947:5;3943:16;19034:30;19113:1;19095:16;;;16927:4;19095:16;19088:27;3947:5;3684:379;-1:-1;;3684:379::o;4839:1122::-;;4962:4;4950:9;4945:3;4941:19;4937:30;4934:2;;;-1:-1;;4970:12;4934:2;4998:20;4962:4;4998:20;:::i;:::-;4989:29;;5083:17;5070:31;5121:18;;5113:6;5110:30;5107:2;;;5098:1;;5143:12;5107:2;5188:90;5274:3;5265:6;5254:9;5250:22;5188:90;:::i;:::-;5170:16;5163:116;5377:2;5366:9;5362:18;5349:32;5335:46;;5121:18;5393:6;5390:30;5387:2;;;5098:1;;5423:12;5387:2;5468:74;5538:3;5529:6;5518:9;5514:22;5468:74;:::i;:::-;5377:2;5454:5;5450:16;5443:100;5636:2;5625:9;5621:18;5608:32;5594:46;;5121:18;5652:6;5649:30;5646:2;;;5098:1;;5682:12;5646:2;;5727:58;5781:3;5772:6;5761:9;5757:22;5727:58;:::i;:::-;5636:2;5713:5;5709:16;5702:84;;5893:46;5935:3;5860:2;5915:9;5911:22;5893:46;:::i;:::-;5860:2;5879:5;5875:16;5868:72;4928:1033;;;;:::o;7412:447::-;;;7568:2;7556:9;7547:7;7543:23;7539:32;7536:2;;;-1:-1;;7574:12;7536:2;226:6;220:13;238:33;265:5;238:33;:::i;:::-;7737:2;7811:22;;4716:13;7626:74;;-1:-1;20466:1;20456:12;;20446:2;;-1:-1;;20472:12;20446:2;7745:98;;;;7530:329;;;;;:::o;7866:823::-;;;;8080:2;8068:9;8059:7;8055:23;8051:32;8048:2;;;-1:-1;;8086:12;8048:2;8137:17;8131:24;8175:18;;8167:6;8164:30;8161:2;;;-1:-1;;8197:12;8161:2;8314:6;8303:9;8299:22;;;1241:3;1234:4;1226:6;1222:17;1218:27;1208:2;;-1:-1;;1249:12;1208:2;1289:6;1283:13;1311:95;1326:79;1398:6;1326:79;:::i;1311:95::-;1412:16;1448:6;1441:5;1434:21;1478:4;;1495:3;1491:14;1484:21;;1478:4;1470:6;1466:17;1600:3;1478:4;;1584:6;1580:17;1470:6;1571:27;;1568:36;1565:2;;;-1:-1;;1607:12;1565:2;-1:-1;1633:10;;1627:232;1652:6;1649:1;1646:13;1627:232;;;4339:6;4333:13;4351:48;4393:5;4351:48;:::i;:::-;1720:76;;1674:1;1667:9;;;;;1810:14;;;;1838;;1627:232;;;-1:-1;8374:18;;8368:25;8217:114;;-1:-1;8368:25;-1:-1;;;8402:30;;;8399:2;;;-1:-1;;8435:12;8399:2;;8465:89;8546:7;8537:6;8526:9;8522:22;8465:89;:::i;:::-;8455:99;;;8591:2;8645:9;8641:22;7349:13;8599:74;;8042:647;;;;;:::o;8696:771::-;;;;;8885:3;8873:9;8864:7;8860:23;8856:33;8853:2;;;-1:-1;;8892:12;8853:2;3565:6;3552:20;8944:63;;9044:2;9087:9;9083:22;72:20;97:33;124:5;97:33;:::i;:::-;9052:63;-1:-1;9152:2;9191:22;;72:20;97:33;72:20;97:33;:::i;:::-;9160:63;-1:-1;9288:2;9273:18;;9260:32;9312:18;9301:30;;9298:2;;;-1:-1;;9334:12;9298:2;9364:87;9443:7;9434:6;9423:9;9419:22;9364:87;:::i;:::-;9354:97;;;8847:620;;;;;;;:::o;9474:771::-;;;;;9663:3;9651:9;9642:7;9638:23;9634:33;9631:2;;;-1:-1;;9670:12;10252:325;;10398:2;10386:9;10377:7;10373:23;10369:32;10366:2;;;-1:-1;;10404:12;10366:2;4526:6;4520:13;4538:64;4596:5;4538:64;:::i;:::-;10456:105;10360:217;-1:-1;;;10360:217::o;10584:263::-;;10699:2;10687:9;10678:7;10674:23;10670:32;10667:2;;;-1:-1;;10705:12;10667:2;-1:-1;7349:13;;10661:186;-1:-1;10661:186::o;10854:528::-;;;11011:2;10999:9;10990:7;10986:23;10982:32;10979:2;;;-1:-1;;11017:12;10979:2;7355:6;7349:13;11069:74;;11201:2;11190:9;11186:18;11180:25;11225:18;11217:6;11214:30;11211:2;;;-1:-1;;11247:12;11211:2;11277:89;11358:7;11349:6;11338:9;11334:22;11277:89;:::i;:::-;11267:99;;;10973:409;;;;;:::o;11722:690::-;;11915:5;17210:12;17625:6;17620:3;17613:19;17662:4;;17657:3;17653:14;11927:93;;17662:4;12091:5;17064:14;-1:-1;12130:260;12155:6;12152:1;12149:13;12130:260;;;12216:13;;12491:37;;11543:14;;;;17468;;;;12177:1;12170:9;12130:260;;;-1:-1;12396:10;;11846:566;-1:-1;;;;;11846:566::o;13285:222::-;12491:37;;;13412:2;13397:18;;13383:124::o;13514:1124::-;;12521:5;12498:3;12491:37;14042:2;18550:42;;17932:5;18539:54;14042:2;14031:9;14027:18;11642:37;18550:42;17932:5;18539:54;14125:2;14114:9;14110:18;11642:37;;13877:3;14162:2;14151:9;14147:18;14140:48;14202:108;13877:3;13866:9;13862:19;14296:6;14202:108;:::i;:::-;12521:5;14389:3;14378:9;14374:19;12491:37;12521:5;14473:3;14462:9;14458:19;12491:37;14527:9;14521:4;14517:20;14511:3;14500:9;14496:19;14489:49;12682:5;17210:12;17625:6;17620:3;17613:19;-1:-1;19202:101;19216:6;19213:1;19210:13;19202:101;;;19283:11;;;;;19277:18;19264:11;;;;;19257:39;19231:10;;19202:101;;;19318:6;19315:1;19312:13;19309:2;;;-1:-1;14042:2;19374:6;17657:3;19365:16;;19358:27;19309:2;-1:-1;19494:2;19474:14;19490:7;19470:28;12839:39;;;13848:790;-1:-1;;;;;;;;;13848:790::o;14645:254::-;18550:42;18539:54;;;;12977:66;;14788:2;14773:18;;14759:140::o;14906:481::-;;12521:5;12498:3;12491:37;15111:2;15229;15218:9;15214:18;15207:48;15269:108;15111:2;15100:9;15096:18;15363:6;15269:108;:::i;:::-;15261:116;15082:305;-1:-1;;;;15082:305::o;15394:256::-;15456:2;15450:9;15482:17;;;15557:18;15542:34;;15578:22;;;15539:62;15536:2;;;15614:1;;15604:12;15536:2;15456;15623:22;15434:216;;-1:-1;15434:216::o;15657:320::-;;15832:18;15824:6;15821:30;15818:2;;;-1:-1;;15854:12;15818:2;-1:-1;15899:4;15887:17;;;15952:15;;15755:222::o;19511:117::-;18550:42;19598:5;18539:54;19573:5;19570:35;19560:2;;19619:1;;19609:12;19560:2;19554:74;:::o

Swarm Source

ipfs://2c73b5978a67e397fc9cfd493e858b7f5860760cb31c1f827e6638c411b55943
Block Transaction Gas Used Reward
Age Block Fee Address BC Fee Address Voting Power Jailed Incoming
Block Uncle Number Difficulty Gas Used Reward
Loading
Loading
Make sure to use the "Vote Down" button for any spammy posts, and the "Vote Up" for interesting conversations.